summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/8664.txt
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '8664.txt')
-rw-r--r--8664.txt10419
1 files changed, 10419 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/8664.txt b/8664.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f154e84
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8664.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,10419 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Glory Of The Conquered, by Susan Glaspell
+
+Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the
+copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing
+this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook.
+
+This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project
+Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the
+header without written permission.
+
+Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the
+eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is
+important information about your specific rights and restrictions in
+how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a
+donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved.
+
+
+**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
+
+**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
+
+*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!*****
+
+
+Title: The Glory Of The Conquered
+
+Author: Susan Glaspell
+
+Release Date: August, 2005 [EBook #8664]
+[This file was first posted on July 30, 2003]
+
+Edition: 10
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: US-ASCII
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, THE GLORY OF THE CONQUERED ***
+
+
+
+
+E-text prepared by Suzanne Shell, Mary Meehan, Charles Franks, and the
+Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+
+
+
+THE GLORY OF THE CONQUERED
+
+THE STORY OF A GREAT LOVE
+
+BY
+
+SUSAN GLASPELL
+
+1909
+
+
+
+
+
+
+To DR. A. L. HAGEBOECK,
+
+Who Made This Book Possible
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+PART ONE
+
+ I. ERNESTINE
+ II. THE LETTER
+ III. KARL
+ IV. JACK AND "HIGHER TRUTH"
+ V. THE HOME-COMING
+ VI. "GLORIA VICTIS"
+ VII. ERNESTINE IN HER STUDIO
+ VIII. SCIENCE, ART AND LOVE
+ IX. As THE SURGEON SAW IT
+ X. KARL IN HIS LABORATORY
+ XI. PICTURES IN THE EMBERS
+ XII. A WARNING AND A PREMONITION
+ XIII. AN UNCROSSED BRIDGE
+ XIV. "TO THE GREAT UNWHIMPERING!"
+ XV. THE VERDICT
+ XVI. "GOOD LUCK, BEASON!"
+ XVII. DISTANT STRAINS OF TRIUMPH
+ XVIII. TELLING ERNESTINE
+ XIX. INTO THE DARK
+
+PART TWO
+
+ XX. MARRIAGE AND PAPER BAGS
+ XXI. FACTORY-MADE OPTIMISM
+ XXII. A BLIND MAN'S TWILIGHT
+ XXIII. HER VISION
+ XXIV. LOVE CHALLENGES FATE
+ XXV. DR. PARKMAN'S WAY
+ XXVI. OLD-FASHIONED LOVE
+ XXVII. LEARNING TO BE KARL'S EYES
+ XXVIII. WITH BROKEN SWORD
+ XXIX. UNPAINTED MASTERPIECES
+ XXX. EYES FOR TWO
+ XXXI. SCIENCE AND SUPER-SCIENCE
+ XXXII. THE DOCTOR HAS HIS WAY
+ XXXIII. LOVE'S OWN HOUR
+ XXXIV. ALMOST DAWN
+ XXXV. "OH, HURRY--HURRY!"
+ XXXVI. WITH THE OUTGOING TIDE
+
+PART THREE
+
+ XXXVII. BENEATH DEAD LEAVES
+XXXVIII. PATCHWORK QUILTS
+ XXXIX. ASH HEAP AND ROSE JAR
+ XL. "LET THERE BE LIGHT"
+ XLI. WHEN THE TIDE CAME IN
+ XLII. WORK, THE SAVIOUR
+ XLIII. "AND THERE WAS LIGHT"
+
+
+
+
+THE GLORY OF THE CONQUERED
+
+
+
+
+PART ONE
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+
+ERNESTINE
+
+She had promised to marry a scientist! It was too overwhelming a thought
+to entertain standing there by the window. She sought the room's most
+comfortable chair and braced herself to the situation.
+
+If, one month before, a gossiping daughter of Fate had come to her
+with--"Shall I tell you something?--_You_ are going to marry a man of
+science!"--she would have smiled serenely at Fate's amusing mistake and
+responded--"My good friend, it is quite true that great uncertainty
+attends this subject. So much to be expected is the unexpected, that I am
+quite willing to admit I _may_ marry the hurdy-gurdy man who plays
+beneath my window. I know life well enough to appreciate that I _may_
+marry a pawnbroker or the Sultan of Turkey. I assert but one thing. I
+shall _not_ marry a 'man of science.'"
+
+And now, not only had she promised to marry a man of science, but she had
+quite overlooked the fact of his being one! And the thing which stripped
+her of the last shred of consistency was that she was to marry, not the
+every-day, average "man of science," but one of the foremost scientists
+of all the world! The powers in charge of things matrimonial must be
+smiling a quiet little smile to-night.
+
+But ah--here was the vindication! He had not _asked_ her to marry him. He
+had simply come and told her she _was_ to marry him. And he was a great,
+strong man--far more powerful than she. She had had positively nothing to
+do with it! Was it _her_ fault that he chanced to be engaged in
+scientific pursuits? And when he took her face so tenderly in his two
+hands--looked so far down into her eyes--and told her in a voice she
+would follow to the ends of the earth that he _loved_ her--was there any
+time then to think of paltry non-essentials like art and science?
+
+But she thought of them a little now. How could she get away from them
+when each year of her past marched slowly in front of her, paused for an
+instant that she might get a full view, and then passed grinningly back
+to the abyss of things gone, from over the shoulder tossing straight into
+her consciousness a jeering, deep sinking "_You too?_"
+
+Ernestine Stanley--that was the name she read in one of her books open
+beside her. Why her very _name_ stood for that quarrel which had rent all
+the years!
+
+Until she was ten years old she had been nameless. She had been You--and
+Baby--and Dear--and Mother's Girl--and Father's Girl, but her mother and
+father had been unable to agree upon a name for her. Each discussion
+served to send them a little farther apart. Finally they spoke of
+Ernestine and reached the point of agreement through separate channels.
+Her father approved it for what it meant in the dictionary;--her mother
+for the music of its sound. That told the whole story; their attitudes
+toward her name spoke for the things of themselves bestowed upon her.
+
+Her father had been a disciple of exact science,--a professor of biology.
+He believed only in that which could be reduced to a formula. The
+knowable was to him the only real. He viewed life microscopically and
+spent his portion of emotion in an aggressive hatred of all those things
+which he consigned to the rubbish heap labeled non-scientific.
+
+And her mother--she never thought of her mother without that sad little
+shake of her head--was a dreamer, a lover of things beautiful, a hater of
+all she felt to be at war with her gods. Ernestine's loyalty did not
+permit the analysis to go further, except to deplore her mother's
+unhappiness as unnecessary. Even when a very little girl she wondered
+why her father could not have his bottles and things, and her mother have
+her poems and the things she liked, and just let each other alone about
+it. She wondered that long before she appreciated its significance.
+
+As she grew a little older she used to wonder if something inside her
+would not some day be pulled in two. It seemed the desire of each of her
+parents to guide her from what they saw as the rocks surrounding her.
+Elementary science was all mixed up with Keats and Heine and Byron.
+Another one of her early speculations was as to whether or not poetry and
+science really meant to make so much trouble.
+
+Of course from the very first there had been the blackboard--the
+blackboard and all its logical successors. As perversity would have it,
+it was her father bought her that blackboard. It was to help turn her in
+the way she should go, for upon this blackboard she was to do her sums.
+But the sums executed thereon were all performed when some one was
+standing at her shoulder, while many were the hours spent in the drawing
+of cats and dogs and fish and birds, of lakes and trees and other little
+girls and boys. She never had that being-pulled-in-two feeling when she
+and the blackboard were alone together. The blackboard seemed the only
+thing which made her all one, and she often wished her father and mother
+loved their things as she did hers, for if they were only _sure_, as she
+was, then what some one else said would not matter at all.
+
+They lived in a university town, her father being a professor in the
+school. In the later years of her college life he forced her into the
+scientific courses which she hated. She sighed even now at the memory of
+those weary hours in the laboratory, though while hating the detail of
+it, she responded, as her father had never done, to the glimpses she
+caught of the thing as a whole. It was ironical enough that the only
+thing she seemed to get from her scientific studies was an enthusiasm for
+the poetry of science. In those days many thoughts beat hard against the
+door of Ernestine's loyalty. Why did not her mother see all this--and
+make her father see it? Was there not a point at which they could have
+met--and did they not fail in meeting because neither of them went far
+enough?
+
+It was when she was in her senior year that her father died. She finished
+out her laboratory work with lavish conscientiousness, feeling a new
+tenderness of him in the consciousness that his ideas for her had failed.
+That hour before his funeral, when she sat beside him alone, stood out as
+among the very vivid moments of her life. The tragedy of his life seemed
+that he had failed in impressing himself. His keenness of mind had not
+made for bigness. Life had left an aggressiveness, a certain sullenness
+in the lines of his face. His mind and his soul had never found one
+another--was it because his heart had closed the channel between the two?
+
+And then they went to New York and Ernestine began her study of art.
+
+A great light seemed turned back over it all tonight. She understood much
+now which she had lived through wonderingly. She seemed now really to
+know that girl who went to New York with all the dreams of all her years
+calling upon her for fulfillment. She knew what that girl had dreamed
+when she dreamed she knew not what; knew what she thought when she thought
+the undefined. She smiled understandingly, tenderly, at thought of it
+all--the bounding joy and the stubborn determination, the fearing and the
+demanding and the resolving with which she began her work. She was a
+great deal like a child on the long-promised holiday, and much like the
+pilgrim at the shrine. Somewhere between those two was Ernestine that
+first winter in New York.
+
+It was after the second year, after that strange mixture of things within
+her had unified to fixed purpose, and after it had become quite certain
+her dreams had not played her false, that the other big change had come.
+Her mother slipped away from the life which had never held her in the big
+grip of reality. She had been so long a longing looker-on from the outer
+circle that the slipping away was the less hard. Ernestine stopped work
+in order to care for her, reproaching herself with never having been able
+to give to her mother with the unrestraint and bounteousness she had
+given to her work. During those last weeks she often found her mother's
+eyes--sombre, brooding eyes--following her about the room like the spirit
+of unrest.
+
+"Try to be happy, Ernestine," she said, when about to leave the house in
+which she had ever been a stranger. "Life is so awful if you are not
+happy."
+
+She took her back to the little town and put her away beside the man with
+whom her soul had never been at peace. That first night she awakened in
+the dark hours and fancied she heard them quarreling. The hideous fancy
+would not let her go to sleep, though she told herself over and over that
+surely death would bring them the peace life had so long withheld.
+
+She went back to her work then with a new steadiness; loneliness feeding
+the fire of consecration. Often when alone in her room at night she felt
+those disappointed eyes following her about, heard again that plaintive:
+"Try to be happy, Ernestine. Life is so awful if you are not happy." She
+had many times opened the book in which her mother copied the poems
+written at intervals during the years, but always would come the feeling
+of their holding something at which it would be hard to look. To-night,
+with her new understanding, this wondrous new touchstone, she took them
+from her trunk with eagerness. She longed now to know the secret of her
+mother's life; she would know why happiness had passed her by.
+
+There was tragedy in those little poems--a soul's long tragedy in their
+halting lines, in the faltering breath with which they were sung. Indeed
+they were not the songs of a poet at all; they were but the helpless
+reaching out of an unsatisfied, unanchored soul. The blackboard had never
+given back what it should; the crayon would not write. Was it true there
+were countless souls who went away like this--leaving unsaid a word they
+had craved to say?
+
+"For our souls were not in tune"--was a line she found in one of the
+verses and which she sat a long time pondering. Was not the secret of it
+here? This the rock which held the wreckage of their lives?
+
+She left her room and went out of doors. The night was very still.
+A tender peace brooded over the world. She lifted her eyes to the
+stars--her soul to the great Wonder. Enveloping her was Life--drawing her
+straight to the heart of things was Love. Doubts and speculations and
+ominous memories seemed blown away by the breath of the night. The years
+had no lesson to teach save this--One must love! All that was wrong in
+the world came through too little loving. All that was great and
+beautiful sprang from love which knew not doubts nor fears. What was a
+"point of view" when one throbbed with the memory of his good-bye kiss!
+
+There was a force which moved the world. She was in the grip of that
+force to-night. All else was but the tiny whirlpool against the mighty
+current. And she was not afraid. Love would deal kindly with her own.
+She lifted her soul to the great Mother and Father of the world. "Oh take
+me and teach me!"--was her passionate prayer.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+
+THE LETTER
+
+What was that story the old Greeks told about love being the union--or
+reunion--of the two halves of an originally perfect whole? The envious
+gods--who were a very bad lot--cut the original perfect being in two.
+Then love is a finding of one's own--also, a getting ahead of the gods. I
+have more respect for the old Greeks to-night than I ever had before! But
+you cannot know just how it is. You are younger than I, and I do not
+believe the fear of life passing you by ever entered and chilled your
+heart. You were always sure it was coming some time, weren't you, my
+new-found little one? You could not have had that calm, sweet look in
+those big eyes of yours had you feared the best of life might be withheld
+from you. But can you fancy what it would mean to have felt for many
+years that somewhere there was a cool, sweet spring of eternal joy, and
+to become fearful your footsteps might never lead you to those blessed
+waters? And then can you fancy the profound thankfulness that would fill
+one's being, when after long wandering, after several mistakes and
+disappointments, the music of those waters was borne to the ear? And
+when, almost fearful to believe, and yet very, very sure, one stepped a
+little nearer, can you fancy the joy in finding the cooling breeze from
+that eternal spring upon one's face, of seeing it there as one had ever
+dreamed of it, knowing that beside it one could drink deep--long and very
+deep--of those life-giving, soul-satisfying waters? Can you fancy the
+all-pervading thankfulness, almost unbelievable joy, in that first hour
+of standing beside the long-desired, the half-despaired of water of life?
+
+"Thank God I was not weak enough to resign the whole for the half! There
+was once a voice said to me: 'This is a pretty good spring. There is
+not much chance of your finding the other. Why not take this?' But
+something--your voice from a far distance?--called me on.
+
+"A strange enough letter for a man to be writing the girl who has just
+promised to marry him! Conventionally, I suppose, I should say to you:
+'I never knew anything like this before.' And instead I am saying: 'There
+was something once of somewhat similar exterior. But I was mistaken. I
+was disappointed.' But doesn't this make you see--dear new love--dear
+_real_ love--how happy I am, and why?
+
+"But you poor little girl--how I've cheated you! Why, liebchen--God bless
+the Germans for inventing that name for you--you were entitled to weeks
+and weeks of beautiful, delicate courtship. Will you forgive me for
+jumping right over those days when I should have sent you roses and nice
+pretty notes, and prepared you in proper and approved way for all of
+this? But I had been waiting for you so long that when I found you, I
+just couldn't wait a minute longer.
+
+"And it was Georgia--my red-headed, freckled, foolish cousin Georgia
+did this! Why, liebchen, I'll take my oath right this minute Georgia
+hasn't a freckle! I'm even willing--(oh Lord, _am_ I?--Yes, by the gods I
+_am_)--to read every abominable line she writes for that abominable
+paper. Am I an ingrate? Didn't Georgia bring me to _you?_--and is
+anything too much, even to the reading of her stuff--yes, by Jove, and
+_liking_ it?
+
+"Now prepare yourself to receive the sympathy of every one you know when
+you tell them you are going to marry me. Some kind of divine
+hallucination is upon you, acting for my good, and you do not see how
+profoundly you are to be pitied. But other people will see, and will tell
+you about it, only you will think _they_ are under a hallucination, which
+is one of the phases of _yours_. The truth is I am a grubbing old
+scientist. I prowl around in laboratories and don't know much of anything
+else, and more than half the time my hands are stained with unaesthetic
+colours you won't like at all. And they tell me I have a foolish way of
+sitting and thinking about one thing, and that sometimes I don't do
+things I say I am going to--meet my appointments and things like that,
+although of course that won't apply to you. And here you might have
+married some artist chap, or society fellow who would know all about the
+proper thing!
+
+"But never mind, poor little girl--I'll make it up to you. You may miss
+some of the lesser, but you'll have the greater. You'll have the
+love that enfolds one's whole being--the love that is eternal. Yes,
+dear--eternal. The mariner has his compass, the astronomer his stars, the
+Swiss peasant has his Alps--and we have our love. It must mean all those
+eternal things to us. Don't you feel that it will?
+
+"This train is rushing along jostling my hand so I can scarcely write.
+But then my heart is rushing on jostling my brain so I can scarcely
+think, so perhaps my handwriting matches my thoughts.
+
+"And we'll work! We'll work to prove how much we love--is there better
+reason for working than that? I can work now as I never did before, for
+don't I want to prove to this old world that I appreciate its bringing me
+to you? And you'll teach me about this art of yours, won't you, my little
+girl with the long, serious name? I'm ignorant, sweetheart, I don't know
+much about pictures, but don't you think that I can learn? Why, liebchen,
+I'm learning already! I never knew what they meant by lights and shadows
+until I saw your face.
+
+"But tell me, how does it happen your hair grows back from your temples
+that way? Why, no one else's hair does that. And where did you learn
+about tilting your chin forward like that and looking straight out of
+your eyes at one? It is so strange--no one else does any of those things.
+I've often thought of the many things in science I do not understand and
+never will, but they are the very simplest things imaginable in
+comparison with that puzzling way you smile, the wonderful way your face
+lights up when you are happy.
+
+"Are you looking up at the stars? I think you are. And in the heavens do
+you see one newly discovered, unvanishable star? That is the star of our
+love, dear,--the star which has changed heaven and earth. Are you
+dreaming about it all?--Oh but I know you are. I will fulfill those
+dreams, dear girl. I have waited for you too long, I prize you too
+inestimably not to consecrate my life to the fulfilling of those dreams."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+
+KARL
+
+He was one of the men who go before. Out in the great field of
+knowledge's unsurveyed territory he worked--a blazer of the trail, a
+voice crying from the wilderness: "I have opened up another few feet.
+You can come now a little farther." Then they would come in and take
+possession, soon to become accustomed to the ground, forgetting that
+only a little while before it had been impassable, scarcely thinking of
+the little body of men who had opened the way for them, and now were out
+farther, where again the way was blocked, trying to beat down a few more
+of the barriers, open up a little more of that untrodden territory. And
+only the little band itself would ever know how stony that path, how deep
+the ditches, how thick and thorny the underbrush. "Why this couldn't have
+been so bad," the crowd said, after it had flocked in--"strange it should
+have taken so long!"
+
+Not that the little band sought popular acclaim, or desired it.
+"Heavens!" he had once exclaimed to a laboratory assistant, after a
+reporter had been vainly trying to persuade him to "tell the whole story
+of his work in popular vein,"--"you don't suppose medical research is
+going to become a drawing-room lap dog!"
+
+But he need not have feared. A capricious fancy might rest upon them for
+the minute, but the big world which followed along behind would never
+come into any complete understanding of such as they. In an age of each
+man seeking what he himself can gain, how could there be understanding of
+the manner of man who would perhaps work all of his lifetime only to put
+up at the end the sign-board: "Do not take this road. I have gone over it
+and found it profitless." Failure is not the name they give to that. They
+say his wanderings astray brought others that much nearer to the goal.
+
+In his last year at the medical school one of his professors had put it
+to him like this: "You must make your choice. It is certain you can not
+do both. You will become a general practitioner, or you will go into the
+research work for which you have shown aptitude here. I am confident you
+would succeed as a surgeon. In that you would make more money, and, in
+all probability, a bigger name. That is certain. In this other, you take
+your chances. But if I were you, I would do whichever I cared for more."
+
+That settled it, for he had long before heard the cry from the unknown:
+"Come out and take us! We are here--if only you know how to get us."
+There was in his blood that which thrilled to the thought of doing what
+had not been done before. With the abandonment of his intense and rugged
+nature, he yielded himself to the delights of the untravelled path.
+
+At the time of his falling in love, Dr. Karl Hubers was thirty-nine years
+old. He had worked in European laboratories, notably the Pasteur
+Institute of Paris, and among men of his kind was regarded as one to be
+reckoned with. Within the profession his name already stood for vital
+things, and it was associated now with one of the big problems, the
+solving of which it was believed this generation would have to its
+credit. The scientific and medical journals were watching him, believing
+that when the great victory was won, his would be the name to reach round
+the world.
+
+Three years before, the president of a great university, but newly sprung
+up by the side of a great lake, sitting in his high watch tower and with
+mammoth spy-glass looking around for men of initiative in the
+intellectual domain, had spied Karl Hubers, working away over there in
+Europe. This man of the watch tower had a genius for perceiving when a
+man stood on the verge of great celebrity, and so he cried out now: "Come
+over and do some teaching for us! We will give you just as good a
+laboratory as you have there and plenty of time for your own work." Now,
+while he would be glad enough to have Dr. Hubers do the teaching, what he
+wanted most of all was to possess him, so that in the day of victory that
+young giant of a university would rise up with the peon: "See! _We_ have
+done it!" And Dr. Hubers, lured by the promise of time and facility for
+his own work, liking what he knew of the young university, had come over
+and established himself in Chicago.
+
+In those three years he had not been disappointing. He had contributed
+steadily to the sum of the profession's knowledge, for he worked in
+little by-paths as well as on his central thing, and he himself felt,
+though he said but little, that he was coming nearer and nearer the goal
+he had set for himself.
+
+His place in the university was an enviable one. The enthusiasm of the
+students for him quite reached the borderland of reverence. To get some
+work in Dr. Hubers' laboratory was regarded, among the scientific
+students, as the triumph of a whole university career. And it was those
+students who worked as his assistants who came to know the fine fibre of
+the man. They could tell best the real story of his work. They it was who
+told him when he must go to his classes and when he must go to his meals,
+who kept him, in times of complete surrender to his idea, in so much of
+touch with the world about him as they felt a necessity. Their hearts
+beat with his heart when a little of the way was cleared; their spirits
+sank in disappointment as they lived with him through the days of
+depression. And as they came day by day to know of the honesty of his
+mind, the steadfastness of his purpose, to feel that flame which glowed
+within him, they fairly spoke his name in different voice from that used
+for other things, and when they told their stories of his eccentricities,
+it was with a tenderness in their humour, never as though blurring his
+greatness, but rather as if his very little weaknesses and foibles set
+him apart from and above every one else.
+
+Generations before, his ancestors up there in North Europe had swept
+things before them with a mighty hand. With defeat and renunciation they
+did not reckon. If they loved a woman, they picked her up and took her
+away. And civilisation has not quite washed the blood of those men from
+the earth. Germany gave to Karl Hubers something more than a scholar's
+mind. At any rate, he did a very unapproved and most uncivilised thing.
+When he fell in love and decided he wanted to marry Ernestine Stanley,
+and that he wanted to take her right over to Europe and show her the
+things he loved there, he asked for his year's leave of absence before he
+went to find out whether Miss Stanley was kindly disposed to the idea of
+marrying him. Now why he did that, it is not possible to state, but the
+thing proving him quite hopeless as a civilised product is that it never
+struck him there was anything so very peculiar in his order of procedure.
+
+His assistants had to do a great deal of reminding after he came back
+that week, and they never knew until afterwards that his abstraction was
+caused by something quite different from germs. They thought--unknowing
+assistants--that he was on a new trail, and judged from the expression of
+his face that it was going to prove most productive.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+
+FACTS AND "HIGHER TRUTH"
+
+"Mr. Beason," said Georgia McCormick, looking across the dinner table at
+the new student who had come to live with them--almost every one who
+lived around the university had "students"--"if you had a dear cousin who
+had married a dear friend, if said dear cousin and dear friend had gone
+skipping away to Europe, and for one year and a half had flitted gayly
+from country to country, looking into each other's eyes and murmuring
+sweet nothings all the while that _you_ had been earning your daily bread
+by telling daily untruths for a daily paper, if at the end of said period
+said cousin and friend, forced by a steadily diminishing bank account to
+return to the stern necessities of life, had written you a nonchalant
+little note telling you to 'look up a place for them to lay their
+heads'--which being translated in terms of action meant that you were to
+walk the streets looking for vacant houses when vacant houses there were
+none--if this combination of circumstances befell you, Mr. Beason--just
+what would you do?"
+
+Beason pondered the matter carefully. Mr. Beason applied the scientific
+method to everything in life, and was not one to commit himself rashly.
+"I think," he announced, weightily, "that I would tell them to go to a
+hotel and stay there until they could look up their own house."
+
+"But Mr. Beason," she rambled on, eyes twinkling--Georgia had decided
+this young man needed "waking up"--"suppose you loved them both very
+dearly--suppose they were positively the dearest people who ever walked
+the earth--and that breaking your neck for them was the greatest pleasure
+life could confer upon you--what would you do _then?_"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know," said Beason, bluntly; "I never loved any one
+that dearly."
+
+"'Tis better to love and break one's neck,"--began Harry Wyman, who
+aspired to the position of class poet.
+
+"If you had ever known Ernestine and Karl,"--a tenderness creeping into
+Georgia's voice--"you'd be _almost_ willing to hunt houses for them.
+Almost, I say--for I doubt if any affection on earth should be put to the
+house-hunting test. Even my cousin Dr. Karl Hubers------"
+
+"Your--_cousin?_"--Beason broke in. "_Your--?_"--in telling the story
+Georgia always spoke of the unflattering emphasis on the final your. But
+at the time she could think of nothing save the transformed face of John
+Beason. The instantaneousness with which he had waked up was fairly
+gruesome. He was looking straight at Georgia; all three were held by his
+manner.
+
+"Now my dear Mr. Beason," she laughed finally, "don't be so hard on
+us. My mother and Dr. Hubers' mother were sisters, but please don't
+rub it in so unmercifully that poor mother has been altogether
+distanced in the matter of offspring. You see mother married an Irish
+politician--hence me. While Aunt Katherine--Karl's mother--married a
+German scholar--therefore Karl. And the German scholar was the son of a
+German professor. In fact, from all I have been led to believe the Hubers
+were busily engaged in the professoring business at the time Julius
+Caesar stalked up from Italy."
+
+"Now Georgia," hastened Mrs. McCormick earnestly, "this newspaper work
+gives you such a tendency to exaggerate. I never heard it said before
+that the family went _that_ far back."
+
+"Perhaps not. But just because a thing has never been said before, isn't
+there all the more reason for saying it now? And I'm just trying to make
+Mr. Beason understand"--demurely--"why some people are scholars and
+others are not."
+
+But Season's mind was working straight from the shoulder.
+
+"Does he ever come here?" he demanded.
+
+"Yes, indeed; he honours our poor board quite often with the light of his
+countenance."
+
+Beason accepted that as unextravagant statement of fact.
+
+"Well, do you--know about him?" he asked, bluntly.
+
+"That he's 'way up? Oh, my, yes. And we're tremendously proud of him."
+
+"I should think you would be," said Beason, rather grimly.
+
+"Karl is indeed remarkable," said Mrs. McCormick, blandly expansive, well
+pleased with both Karl and her own appreciation of him. "I feel that our
+family has much to be proud of, to think both he and Georgia have done so
+well with their work."
+
+The expression of Beason's face was a study. Georgia laughed over it for
+weeks afterwards.
+
+"Now my chief interest," said Wyman, who was at the stage where he put
+life in capital letters, and cherished harmless ideas about his own
+deep understanding of the human heart, "is in Mrs. Hubers. There, I
+fancy,"--it was his capital letter voice--"is a woman who understands."
+
+"A dandy girl," said Georgia, briskly.
+
+"She has the artistic temperament?" he pursued.
+
+"Oh, not disagreeably so," she retorted.
+
+"You see," turning to Beason, who was plainly impatient at this shifting
+to anything so irrelevant as a wife, "I play quite a leading part in Dr.
+Hubers' life. I'm his cousin--that's the accident of birth; but I handed
+over to him his wife, for which he owes me undying gratitude. I'm looking
+for something really splendid from Europe."
+
+"I wish I hadn't gone home so early that spring," sighed Wyman. "I'd like
+to have seen that little affair. It must have been the real thing in
+romance."
+
+"But it was nothing of the sort! It was the most disgraceful thing I ever
+had anything to do with."
+
+"Now Georgia," protested her mother, "you know you are so apt to be
+misunderstood."
+
+"Well I couldn't be misunderstood about this! Oh, it was awful!--the
+suddenness of it, you know. You see Miss Stanley was an old college
+friend of mine. In fact, I roomed at their house,"--she paused and seemed
+to be thinking of other things--serious things. "A year ago last spring,"
+she went on, "Ernestine stopped here on her way home from New York. Her
+parents had died, but an old aunt lived in their house, and she was going
+to see her. I had always told her about Karl, but she had never met him,
+because when Ernestine and I were together so much, he was in Europe. So
+I wanted her to meet him--well, principally because he was a good deal of
+a celebrity, and I thought it would be nice. I'll be real honest and
+confess it never occurred to me there would be anything exciting doing.
+Well, Karl didn't want to come. First he said he would, and then he
+telephoned he was busy. So I just went over to the laboratory and _got_
+him. I told him he was expected, and if he didn't come, mother and I
+never would forgive him. He washed his hands and came along, grumbling
+all the way about how one's relatives interfered with one's life--oh,
+Karl and I are tremendously frank, and then when he got here--well, I'll
+just leave it to mother."
+
+"He did seem to be greatly impressed with Georgia's friend." said Mrs.
+McCormick, consciously conservative.
+
+"I never saw him act so stupid! Oh, but I was mad at him! I wanted him to
+talk about Europe and be brilliant, but he didn't do anything but sit and
+look at Ernestine. Fact of the matter is, Ernestine doesn't look quite
+like the rest of us. At least Karl thought she didn't, and evidently he
+made up his mind then and there he was going to have her. Ernestine left
+Chicago sooner than he thought she was going to, and what does he do but
+go after her--and get her! You see, all of Karl's ancestors weren't meek
+and gentle scholars and wise professors. Lots of them were soldiers and
+bloodthirsty brigands, and those are the ones he brags about most and in
+spite of his mind, and all that, those are the ones he is most like. I
+suppose it was in the blood to get what he wanted. I'm sure I don't
+know how he did it. Lots of men had wanted Ernestine, and she had the
+caring-for-her-art notion--she's made good tremendously, you know--but
+art took a back seat when Dr. Hubers arrived on the scene. That's all
+there is to it. I wouldn't call it a romance. It was more in the line of
+a hop, skip and jump."
+
+She had pushed back her chair a little, but laughed now, reminiscently.
+
+"Oh it was just too funny! Some of it was too rich to keep. Karl came
+here the day after he returned--wanted to hear me talk of Ernestine, you
+know. People in love aren't exactly versatile in their conversation. I
+did talk about her for two hours, and then I ventured to change the
+subject. 'Karl,' I said, 'what do you think of the colour they're
+painting the new Fifty-seventh Street station?'
+
+"He had been sitting there in rapt silence and he looked up at me with a
+seraphic, far-away smile. 'Colour,' he said, dreamily, 'was there ever
+such a colour before?'
+
+"'There certainly never was,' I replied, meaning of course the brick red
+of the aforesaid station.
+
+"'That divine brown,' he pursued,' that soft, dark, liquid brown of
+unfathomable depth!' Now there," nodding laughingly at Beason, "you have
+a sample of the great Dr. Hubers' mighty intellect."
+
+Beason hovered around, hoping for a few more stray words, but as Harry
+Wyman and Georgia were talking about some foolish newspaper affairs, he
+went to his room and tried to settle down to work.
+
+A half hour later Wyman, who had also gone in to do a little studying,
+came out to where Georgia was looking over the other evening papers.
+
+"Say," he laughed, "you've got to do something for that fellow in
+there--he's crazy as a loon. You've got him all stirred up, and if you
+don't go in and get him calmed down he won't sleep a wink to-night, and
+neither will I. He says Dr. Hubers is the greatest man in the world. He
+says he won't except anybody--no, sir, not a living human soul! He's been
+walking up and down the floor talking about it. Gee! you ought to hear
+him. He says he came to this university on purpose to get some work with
+Dr. Hubers, that his life will be ruined if he doesn't get it, and that
+he's going to make all kinds of a ten-strike, if he does. And you can't
+laugh at the fellow, for he's just dead down in earnest! He wanted me to
+come out here and ask you some questions--I can't remember 'em straight.
+How he worked--whether he was approachable. Oh, he fired them at me
+thick. Say now, he would appreciate it, if you'd just go in and give him
+a little talk about your cousin. Kind of serious talk, you know. Why,
+he'd just hang on every word."
+
+And Georgia, laughing--Georgia was strongly addicted to laughing--said if
+there was any man ready to hang upon her every word, that she, being
+twenty-seven and prospectless, must not let him get away.
+
+She told Beason many things--some of them facts and some of them "higher
+truth," Georgia holding that things which ought to be true were higher
+truth. She told him how Karl had tried to burn down his father's house,
+when a very small boy, to see if something somebody had said about fire
+was true, how he dissected a strange and wonderful bird which came to the
+house on a visitor's hat, how he inspired a whole crew of small boys to
+run away from home as explorers, how he whipped a bigger boy most
+unmercifully for calling the Germans big fools. Georgia arranged for her
+cousin what she called a thoroughly consistent childhood. And then some
+less high truth about his working his way through college, getting money
+enough to go abroad, his absolute forgetfulness of everything when
+immersed in work--facts and higher truth tallied here.
+
+"Karl's queer," she said. "He's roasted a good deal by the academic
+folks--pooh-hoos a lot of their stuff, you know. He seems to have a
+strange notion that science, learning, the whole business is for
+humanity. Unique conception, isn't it?"
+
+After she went away, Beason said he had no doubt that when one came to
+know Miss McCormick, he would see, in spite of her lightness of manner,
+that she had many fine qualities.
+
+"Qualities!" burst forth the enthusiastic Wyman. "Say--you just
+ought to hear the newspaper fellows talk about Georgia McCormick! I
+tell you she's a peach, and more than that, she's a brick. She's the
+divide-her-last-penny kind--Georgia McCormick is. And I want you to know
+that if ever any one had the joy of living stunt down pat, she's it. It's
+an honest fact that if she was put in the penitentiary and you went to
+see her after she'd been there awhile, she'd tell you so many funny and
+interesting things about the pen. that you'd feel sore to think you
+weren't in yourself. And _smart?_ And a hustler? Well, her paper's done
+some fool things, but it's had sense to hold on to _her_ all right-all
+right."
+
+And Beason replied that of course Dr. Hubers' cousin was bound to be
+smart.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+
+THE HOME-COMING
+
+"Yes, suh, Chicago only two hours, suh," and the porter smiled broadly.
+There was both memory and anticipation in that smile.
+
+The car was almost empty. Across the aisle a man slept peacefully; a
+little farther ahead a young lady read of the joys and sorrows of a
+knight and his lady who had lived some several hundred years before, and
+still farther on a lady all in black was looking from the window,
+evidently lost to sorrows of more recent date. As no one was paying any
+attention to the man and woman back there in the rear of the car it was
+perfectly safe, when the porter passed on, for her hand to slip over into
+his.
+
+He responded with that quiet, protecting smile which always made it seem
+no bad thing could ever come to her.
+
+"Almost home, dear," he said, and then for a long time neither of them
+spoke. Many big forces flowed freely into the silence of that moment.
+
+She looked up at him at last with a smile which broke from her
+seriousness as a ripple breaks from a wave.
+
+"Suppose we had to say everything in words!"
+
+"Suppose we had to walk on one leg!"
+
+"Oh, but that--you know, Karl, it's a little like the rivers and the
+ocean. The words are the rivers flowing into the ocean of silence. Rivers
+flow into oceans--but do they _make_ them? And then the ocean gives back
+to the rivers in the things which it breathes out. There are so many
+reasons why it seems like that."
+
+"Ernestine, where did you get all this? I sometimes think I'm not square
+with you at all. Why, I've been in all those places before! I saw the Bay
+of Naples long before I ever saw you--and yet I didn't really see it
+before at all. Don't you see? Eyes and appreciation and every decent
+thing I take from you. Where did you get it all, Ernestine?"
+
+She pushed back a little curl which was always coming loose,--he loved
+that little curl for always coming loose.
+
+"Perhaps I 'got it' from that way you have of looking at me--the way
+you're looking at me now; or maybe I got it from the way you say
+'Ernestine'--the way you said it just now. But does it matter much what
+comes from which?"--with which bit of lucidity she wrinkled up her nose
+at him in a way which always vanquished argument and returned to the
+silence which seemed waiting to claim her.
+
+He watched her then; he loved so to do that--just see how far he could
+follow. Ernestine seemed to draw things to her in a way very wonderful to
+him.
+
+"You know, liebchen,"--as he saw that steady light of resolution shine
+through the veil of her tenderness--"it seems so queer to me that you
+really _do_ anything."
+
+"Well for a neatly turned compliment--"
+
+"I mean it seems so queer you should really _amount_ to anything."
+
+"Now before you overwhelm me with further adulation, what _are_ you
+talking about?"
+
+"I'm talking about your being an artist. I can't get used to your being
+anything but _Ernestine_! That day last spring when we went to see your
+Salon picture, and when those chaps were talking to you, and I realised
+that they just simply accepted you as one of them--that you belonged, and
+that that was all there was about it--I, oh I had such a funny feeling
+that day. And now, a minute ago, when I saw that look, I had it again."
+
+"Why, Karl, you don't _mind_, do you?"
+
+"No, it's just that it seems queer. You see you're such a wonderful
+sweetheart, it's hard to think of you as anything else. I'll never forget
+that day over there. Something just seemed to leap up within you. I--well
+I think I was a little scared--or was I awed? Something that was shining
+from your eyes made me feel things in my backbone."
+
+"But you're glad?" she laughed.
+
+"Of course I'm glad; and I'm proud. But it's--queer."
+
+She smiled at him understandingly; the understandingness of her smile
+always went beyond her words. It was a beautiful face upon which he
+watched the play of lights, saw the changing currents of thought and
+dreams and purpose. But the thing most rare in it, that which made one
+quite forget accepted standards, was the steadfastness with which a
+certain great light shone through the aura of her tenderness. There were
+moments in which she transcended both her beauty and her beauty's
+weaknesses.
+
+As the flower to the sun, naturally, quietly, inevitably, she had
+expanded under the breath of life. With the fullness of a rich nature she
+had responded to the touch of the spirit of living. Love loved her for
+what she had been able to take.
+
+And in the year which had passed, life, with tender rather than defacing
+lines, had put upon her face the touch of sorrow. Europe meant more to
+her than an Old World civilisation, more than tradition, beauty or art.
+It even meant more than the place where she had spent those first dear
+months of her love. It meant to her the place where she had hoped with
+woman's dearest hope, and where she had given up the child which should
+have been hers. Her tenderest, deepest thoughts were not of the wonders
+and beauties she had seen; they were of the dreams within, of the holy
+happiness of first knowledge, and then the grief in giving up the much
+desired, which she had known only in anticipation. The most cherished
+memories of their love were memories of those days in which he had
+comforted her, of the tenderness with which he had consoled, the strength
+with which he had upheld. Those hours had reached far into her soul,
+deepening it, giving her, as if in compensation, new channels for love,
+new understanding of those innermost things of life. But in those first
+days, even while the soul of the woman was deepening, the bruised heart
+was as the heart of a child. It was as a child she had been to him in
+those days, and he had comforted her as one would comfort an idolised
+child, whose hurt one strove to take wholly unto one's self. The memory
+of those hours knit them together as no other thing could have done.
+
+Looking down at her face now he saw that look he had come to know--that
+far-away, frightened, wistful look. Very gently he laid his hand upon her
+knee.
+
+"I am going to make you so happy. Life is going to be so beautiful," he
+said.
+
+She smiled at him, but the tears were in it.
+
+"Yes, Karl--I know. But now that we are coming home--together--alone,
+doesn't it seem--"
+
+He turned away. The man had suffered too.
+
+"And we are leaving it over there--over there, alone--away from us--the
+life that should have been--"
+
+With that he turned resolutely back to her.
+
+"Ernestine, isn't there another way to look at it? It came of our love,
+and now, dear, it has gone back into our love. It isn't something apart
+from us,--something gone. We have taken it back unto ourselves. It is
+here with us. The greater love we have--that is it, dear."
+
+The flame of understanding leaped quickly to her eyes.
+
+"Oh, I like that Karl," she whispered. "I like that better than anything
+you ever said."
+
+She turned then and looked from the window. Across the fields, over near
+the horizon, she could see a little house. The smoke was curling from the
+chimney. The autumn twilight had come on and they had lighted the lamp. A
+bit of home! The tears came to her eyes--tears of tender anticipation.
+She too was to make a home. And was it not good to think that smoke was
+coming from many chimneys and many lamps were being lighted? Was it not
+good to feel that the dear world was full of homes?
+
+To the man this coming back to Chicago, returning to his work after the
+year and a half he had been away, was charged with a happy significance.
+As they drew nearer and nearer, an impatience possessed him to begin at
+once; that desire of the worker to start in immediately. He had worked
+some over there, had done a few things which were most satisfactory, but
+he wanted now to settle down to actual work in his old place, 'with his
+own things. He fell to wondering if they had changed the laboratory,
+resentful at the possibility.
+
+"Why look here, Ernestine," he suddenly burst forth, turning to her
+eagerly, "to-morrow's a school day, we're late getting home, everything
+is in swing--they're waiting for me, and, by Jove, I can just as well as
+not begin to-morrow!"
+
+A woman who never made one feel things in one's backbone might have
+resented the quick, eager plunge into work, but Ernestine knew the love
+of work herself, and her eyes brightened to his spirit.
+
+"But dear me, Karl," after a second's hesitation, "it seems you should
+take a day or two first."
+
+"Why?" he demanded.
+
+"Well,"--vaguely--"to get rested up."
+
+"Rested up!" He stretched forth his arm and then doubled it back, and
+they both laughed. "That's a joke--my getting rested up. Why I feel like
+a fighting cock!"
+
+"And crazy to get to work?"
+
+"Getting that way. Oh, I tell you, Ernestine, there's nothing like it."
+
+Again she did not mind; she understood. She looked at his glowing face,
+all alight with enthusiasm for the work to which he was going back. She
+was never tired of thinking how Karl's face was just what Karl's face
+should be--reflective of a clear-cut, far-seeing, deeply comprehending
+mind. It seemed all written there--all those things of mind and
+character, and something too of those other things--the things which
+were for her alone. Ernestine held that one could tell by looking at Karl
+that he was doing some great thing.
+
+"But see here, Dr. Hubers, a nice way you have of shirking your domestic
+duties! Who is going to help me settle this famous house Georgia tells
+about?"
+
+"I'll do it at night," he protested eagerly. "I'll work every night until
+the house is spick and span."
+
+Ernestine sighed. "I have a sad feeling that our house never will be
+spick and span. But we'll have some fun,"--eagerly--"fixing it up."
+
+"Of course we'll have fun fixing it up! Georgia's sure to be on hand, and
+I'll make old Parkman get busy too--do him good."
+
+"I don't care about knowing a lot of men--"
+
+"Well I should _hope_ not"
+
+"You didn't let me finish. I was going to say that Dr. Parkman is one man
+I do want to know."
+
+"You'll like Parkman; and he'll like you. By Jove, he's got to! You
+mustn't mind if he snaps your head off occasionally. His life's made
+him savage, but even his life--he's had an awful one, Ernestine--couldn't
+make him vicious. He's the gruffest, snarliest, biggest man I ever
+knew--meaner than the devil, and the best friend on top of earth. And
+Lord, how he works! I don't know any other three men could swing the same
+load. And I tell you, Ernestine, he's great. There's not a better surgeon
+in all Europe. Parkman's a tremendous help to me. Oh, it's going to be
+_great_ to get back!"
+
+"We have some really nice things for our house," mused Ernestine. "I'm
+glad we decided to take that rug for the library. Of course it seemed
+pretty high, but a library without a nice rug wouldn't do at all--not for
+us."
+
+"No--that's right--library without a rug--now I wonder if I am to have my
+old eight o'clock lecture hour? I _want_ that hour! I want to get all the
+school business out of the way in the morning. I must have plenty of
+uninterrupted time for myself. I tell you what it is, Ernestine, I'm
+going to _get_ it! What I saw over there of the other fellows makes me
+all the more sure of myself. And coming back now after being made all
+over new--you see there's such a thing as inspiration in my work, just as
+there is in yours. Of course it's work--work--work, work your way through
+this and that, but there's something or other that leads you on--and I
+_know_ I'm going to do something now!"
+
+"I know it too, Karl," she responded, and the steadfastness shone strong
+through the tenderness now. "We all know it."
+
+"I've got to," he murmured--"got to." And then his whole mind seized upon
+it; some suggestion had come to him, some of that inspiration of which he
+had spoken. He sat there looking straight ahead, brows drawn, eyes
+sometimes half closing, occasionally nodding his head as he saw a point
+more clearly. He looked in such moments as though indeed made for
+conquest,--indomitable. One could almost feel his mind at work, could
+fancy the skillful cutting away of error, the inevitable working ahead to
+truth.
+
+At last he turned to her. "There's no reason for not beginning
+to-morrow," he said, with the eagerness of a boy who would try a new gun
+or fishing rod. "There are a whole lot of things I want to get right
+at now."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+
+"GLORIA VICTIS"
+
+"We'll just put our Russian friend back here in the corner, where the
+shelf suppresses him," said Georgia, who seemed to have accepted the
+self-appointed position of head cataloguer. "Some of the students might
+happen to call."
+
+"This," said Dr. Parkman, who was dusting Gibbon's Rome, "is the sort of
+thing that is called the backbone of a library."
+
+"Consequently," replied Georgia glibly, "we will put it up here on the
+top shelf. Nobody wants a library's backbone. It's to be had, not read.
+Now the trimmings, like our friend Mr. Shaw here, must be given places of
+accessibility."
+
+The host was picking his way around among the contents of a box which he
+had just emptied upon the floor. The hostess was yielding to the
+temptation of an interesting bit which had caught her eye in dusting "An
+Attic Philosopher in Paris."
+
+"Now here," said Dr. Hubers, picking up a thick, green book, "is Walt
+Whitman and that means trouble. No one is going to know whether he is
+prose or poetry."
+
+"When art weds science," observed Georgia, "the resulting library is
+difficult to manage. Mr. Haeckel and Mr. Maeterlinck may not like being
+bumped up here together."
+
+"Then put Haeckel somewhere else," said Ernestine, looking up from her
+book.
+
+"No, fire Maeterlinck," commanded Karl.
+
+"See," said Georgia--"it's begun. Strife and dissension have set in."
+
+"I'm neither a literary man nor a librarian," ventured Dr. Parkman, "but
+it seems a slight oversight to complete the list of poets and leave
+Shakespeare lying out there on the floor."
+
+"Got my Goethe in?" asked Karl, after Shakespeare had been left immersed
+in Georgia's vituperations.
+
+"I think Browning and Keats are over there under the Encyclopedia
+Britannica," said Ernestine, roused to the necessity of securing a
+favourable position for her friends.
+
+"Observe," said Georgia, "how they have begun insisting on their
+favourite authors. This is one of the early stages."
+
+Ernestine, looking over their shoulders, made some critical remark about
+the place accorded Balzac's letters to Madam Hanska, which caused
+Georgia to retort that perhaps it would be better if people arranged
+their own libraries, and then they could put things where they wanted
+them. Then after she had given a resting place to what she denounced as
+some very disreputable French novels, she leaned against the shelves and
+declared it was time to rest.
+
+"This function," she began, "will make a nice little item for our
+society girl. Usually she disdains people who do not live on the Lake
+Shore Drive, but she will have to admit there is snap in this 'Dr. and
+Mrs. Karl Ludwig Hubers,'"--pounding it out on a copy of Walden as
+typewriter--"' but newly returned from foreign shores, entertained last
+night at a book dusting party. Those present were Dr. Murray Parkman,
+eminent surgeon, and Miss Georgia McCormick, well and unfavourably known
+in some parts of the city. Rug beating and other athletic games were
+indulged in. The hostess wore a beautifully ruffled apron of white and
+kindly presented her guest with a kitchen apron of blue. Beer was served
+freely during the evening.'"
+
+"Is that last as close as your paper comes to the truth?" asked
+Ernestine, piling up Emerson that he might not be walked upon.
+
+"That last, my dear, is a hint--a good, straight-from-the-shoulder hint.
+I did it for Dr. Parkman. He looks warm and unhappy."
+
+Dr. Parkman protested that while a little warm, he was not at all
+unhappy, but upon further questioning as to thirst was led into damaging
+admissions. So the little party divided, Georgia calling back over her
+shoulder that as the host was of Teutonic origin, there need be no fear
+about the newly stocked larder.
+
+Left alone a curious change came over the two men. They had entered with
+the heartiness of schoolboys into the raillery of a few minutes before,
+but all of that dropped from them now, and as they pulled up the big
+chairs and Dr. Parkman's "Well?" brought the light of a great enthusiasm
+to the face of his friend, drawing him into the things he had been so
+eager to reach, one would not readily have associated them with the
+flippant conversation from which they had just turned.
+
+For here were men who in truth had little time for the lighter, gayer
+things of life. They stood well to the front in that proportionally small
+army of men who do the world's work. "Tommy-_rot_!" Dr. Parkman had
+responded a few days before to a beautiful tribute some one was seeking
+to pay "The Doctor"--"A doctor is a man who helps people make the best of
+their bad bargains--and damned sick he gets of his job. A man must make a
+living some way, so some of us earn our salt by bucking up against the
+law of the survival of the fittest, thereby rendering humanity the
+beautiful service of encumbering the earth with the weak. If the medical
+profession would just quit its damn meddling, nature might manage, in
+time, to do something worth while."
+
+But all the while, by day and by night, at the expense of leisure and
+pleasure,--often to the exclusion of sleep and food, he kept steadily at
+his "damn meddling,"--proving the most effective enemy nature had in that
+part of the country; and sadly enough--for his philosophy--he was even
+stripped of the vindication of earning his salt. In the one hour a day
+given to his business affairs, Dr. Parkman made more money than in the
+ten or twelve devoted to his profession. Men said he had financial
+genius, and he admitted that possibly he had, stipulating only that
+financial genius was an inflated name for devil's luck. He liked the
+money game better than poker, and played it as his pet dissipation, his
+one real diversion. But having more salt than he could use during the
+remainder of his days, did not tend toward an abatement of this war he
+waged against nature's ultimate design. He himself would analyse that as
+a species of stubbornness, an egotistic desire to see how good an
+interference he could establish, but he gave body and brain and soul to
+his meddling with a fire suspiciously like consecration.
+
+They all knew that Dr. Parkman worked hard. Some few knew that he
+overworked, and a very few knew why. Of the personal things of his own
+life he never spoke, and though he was but fifty, his lined face and
+deep-set eyes made him seem much closer to sixty.
+
+The two men were an interesting contrast; Dr. Parkman was singularly,
+conspicuously dark, while Karl Hubers was a true Teuton in colouring. Dr.
+Parkman was a large man, and all of him seemed to count for force.
+Something about him made people prefer not to get in his way. It was his
+hands spoke for his work--superbly the surgeon's hands, that magical
+union of power and skill, hands for the strongest grip and the lightest
+touch, lithe, sure, relentless, fairly intuitive. His hands made one
+believe in him.
+
+With Karl it was the eyes told most. They seemed to be looking such a
+long way ahead, and yet not missing the smallest thing close at hand. As
+he talked now, his face lighted with enthusiasm, it occurred to Dr.
+Parkman that Hubers was a curious blending of the two kinds of men there
+were behind him. Some of those men had been fighters and some had been
+thinkers, but Karl was the thinker who fights. He had drawn from both of
+them, and that gave him peculiar fitness for the work he was doing. It
+was work for the thinker, the scholar, but work which must have the
+fighting blood. Even his appearance bore the mark of the two kinds of
+things bequeathed him. He had the well-knit body of the soldier, the face
+of the student. He was not a large man, but he gave the sense of large
+things. He had the slight stoop of the laboratory, but when interested,
+aflame, he straightened up and was then in every line the man who fights.
+His eyes, to the understanding observer, told the story of much work
+with the microscope. They were curiously, though not unattractively,
+unlike. The left he used for observations, the right for making the
+accompanying drawings. That gave them a peculiarity only the man of
+science would understand.
+
+The things which the two men radiated were different things. One felt
+their different adjustment toward life. Dr. Parkman had turned to hard
+work as some men turn to strong drink, to submerge himself, to take him
+out of himself, to make life possible; while with Karl Hubers, work and
+life and love were all one great force. Dr. Parkman worked in order that
+he might not remember; Karl in order that he might fulfill.
+
+Their friendship had begun ten years before in Vienna, one of those rare
+friendships which seem all the more intimate because formed in a
+foreign land; a friendship taking root in the rich soil of kindred
+interests,--comradeship which drew from the deep springs of
+understanding. To come close to Karl's work had been one of the real joys
+of Dr. Parkman's very active but very barren life.--He loved Karl; his
+own heart was wrapped up in the work his friend was doing. And the doctor
+meant much to Karl; had done much for him. The one was the man of
+affairs; the other the man of thought; they supplemented and helped each
+other. As the practicing physician, Dr. Parkman could see many things
+from which the laboratory man would be shut out. He was Karl's channel of
+communication with the human side of the work. And Karl gave Parkman his
+complete confidence; that was why there was so much to tell now. He must
+go over the story of his year's work, touch upon his plans, his new
+ideas. And the doctor had something to say of the observations he had
+made for Karl; he told of an operation day after to-morrow he must see
+and said he had several cases worth watching.
+
+"You will have to come out to the laboratory," Karl finally urged. "We
+can't begin to get at it here."
+
+"We're forgetting the hungry and thirsty men," said Georgia, after they
+had been eagerly chatting across the kitchen table for ten or fifteen
+minutes. But Ernestine said it did not matter. She knew what was going on
+in the library and how glad they were of their chance. She and Georgia
+too had much to discuss: the work done in Europe, Georgia's work here,
+how splendid Karl was, what a glorious time they had had, something of
+the good times they would all have together here, and then this house
+which Georgia had found for them and into which they had gone at once.
+
+"I knew well enough," she said, buttering a sandwich in order to stay
+her conscience, "that you and Karl didn't belong in a flat. There
+couldn't be a studio and a laboratory and library and various other
+exotic things in a flat. But only old settlers and millionaires live in
+detached houses here, so please appreciate my efforts. I thought this
+place looked like you--not that you're exactly old-fashioned and
+irregular."
+
+"I liked it at once. Big enough and interestingly queer, and not
+savouring of Chicago enterprise."
+
+"Not that there is anything the matter with Chicago enterprise," insisted
+Georgia.
+
+"You like Chicago, don't you, Georgia?"
+
+"Love it! I know one doesn't usually associate love with Chicago, but I
+love even its abominations. You know I had a tough time here, but I won
+out, and most of us are vain enough to be awfully fond of the place where
+we've been up against it and come out on top. I haven't forgotten the
+days when I edited farm journals and wrote thirty-cent lives of great men
+and peddled feature stories from office to office, standing with my hand
+on door knobs fighting for nerve to go in, but now that it is all safely
+tucked away in the past, I'm not sorry I had to do it. It helps one
+understand a few things, and when new girls come to me I don't tell them,
+as I was told, that they'd better learn the millinery trade or do honest
+work in somebody's kitchen. None of that kind of talk do they get from
+me!"
+
+It was always absorbing to see Georgia very much in earnest. Her alert
+face kept pace with her words, and her emphatic little nods seemed to be
+clinching her thought. People who had good cause to know, said it was
+just as well not to turn the full tide of her emotions to wrath. She was
+a little taller than Ernestine, very quick in her movements, and if one
+insisted on an adverse criticism it might be admitted she was rather
+lacking in repose. The people who liked her, put it the other way. They
+said she was so breezy and delightful. But even friendship could not deny
+her freckles, nor claim beauty for her bright, quick face.
+
+They seemed to fall naturally into more serious things when they met over
+what Georgia called the evening bite. Although differing so widely, they
+were homogeneous in that all were workers; they touched many things,
+their talk live with differences.
+
+"How do you like it?" asked Ernestine, following Dr. Parkman's eyes to
+her favourite bronze, a copy of Mercie's Gloria Victis, which she had
+unpacked just that day and given a place of honour on the mantel.
+
+"It's so Christian," he objected laughingly.
+
+"Oh, but is it?"
+
+"A defeated man being borne aloft? I call it the very essence of
+Christianity. I can see submission and renunciation and other
+objectionable virtues in every line of it."
+
+"Go after it, Parkman," laughed Karl. "Ernestine and I all but came to
+blows over it. I wanted her to buy a Napoleon instead. I tell her there
+is no glory in defeat."
+
+"I don't think of it as the glory of defeat," said Ernestine. "I think of
+it as the glory of the conquered."
+
+"But even so, Ernestine," said Georgia, who had been looking it over
+carefully, "there's no real glory. When I fall down on an assignment, I
+fall down, and that's all there is to it--at least my city editor thinks
+so. If Dr. Parkman doesn't win a case, he loses it. His efforts may have
+been very worthy--but gloria's surely not the word for them. Or take a
+football game," she laughed. "Sometimes the defeated team really does
+better work than the winners--but wouldn't we rather our fellows would
+win on a fluke than go down to defeat putting up a good, steady fight?
+The thing is to _get there!_"
+
+"In football or in life," laughed Karl. "Defeat furnishes good material
+to the poets and the artists, but none of us care to have the glory of
+the conquered apply to _us._"
+
+They were all looking at the bronze and Ernestine looked from one face to
+another, trying to understand why it moved none of them as it had her.
+Karl's face was very purposeful tonight, reflecting the stimulus of his
+talk with his friend. Filled with enthusiasm for this fight he was
+making, he had no eye in this hour for the triumph of the vanquished.
+
+"Why I don't want to submit," he laughed just then. "I want to win!"
+
+"An idea which has done a great deal of harm," observed Dr. Parkman.
+"That 'you'll-get-your-reward-somewhere-else' doctrine is the worst
+possible armour for life. The poets, of course, have always coddled the
+weak, but I see more poetry in the to-hell-with-defeat spirit myself."
+
+That too she could understand--a simple matter of the arrogance of the
+successful.
+
+And with Georgia it was that thing of "getting there"--the world's hard
+and fast standards of success and failure.
+
+She too turned to the statue. Were they right, and she wrong? Was it just
+the art of it, the effectiveness, which moved her, and was the thought
+back of it indeed weakening sentimentality?
+
+"Defend it, Ernestine," laughed Karl; and then, affectionately, seeing
+her seriousness, "Tell us what _you_ see in it."
+
+Dr. Parkman turned from the statue to her. He never forgot her face as it
+was then.
+
+He had decided during the evening that her great charm was her exquisite
+femininity; she seemed to have all those graces of both mind and body
+which make for perfect loving. It was the world force of love, splendidly
+manifest in gentleness, he had felt in her first. But now something new
+flamed up within her. Here was power--power moving in the waves of
+passion through the channel of understanding. Her face had grown fairly
+stern in its insistence.
+
+"But don't you _see_ The keynote of it is that stubborn grip on the
+broken sword. I should think every fighter would love it for that. And it
+is more than the glory of the good fight. It is the glory of the
+unconquerable will. Look at the woman's face! The world calls him
+beaten. _She_ knows that he has won. I see behind it the world's
+battlefields--'way back from the first I see them all, and I see that the
+thing which has shaped the world is not the success or failure of
+individual battles one-half so much as it is this wresting of victory
+from defeat by simply _breathing_ victory even after the sword
+has been broken in the hand. What we call victory and defeat are
+incidents--things individual and temporal. The thing universal and
+eternal is this immortality of the spirit of victory. Why, every time I
+look at that grip on the broken sword,"--laughing now, but eyes
+shining--"I can feel the world take a bound ahead!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+
+ERNESTINE IN HER STUDIO
+
+The next morning she went to work. She had never wanted anything with
+quite the eagerness that she wanted to work that morning.
+
+"What I want to know is," Georgia had demanded the night before, "did
+either of you do any work? I hear a great deal about quaint little
+villages and festive cafes, but what did you actually do?"
+
+Now if Georgia were only here to repeat the question, she could answer
+jubilantly: "What did I do? Why, I got ready for this morning! Wasn't
+that a fine year's work?"
+
+It had seemed queer at first. "Why don't I work," she would ask Karl,
+"now that I am here where I always wanted to be?" But Karl would only
+laugh, and say that was too obvious to explain. Once he had talked a
+little about it. "I wouldn't worry, liebchen. Isn't it possible that the
+creative instinct is being all used up? It's your dream time, sweetheart.
+It's your time to do nothing but love. After a while you'll turn to the
+work, and you'll do things easily then that were hard to do before."
+
+How had he known? For nothing had ever been more true than that. She knew
+this morning that she could do things easily now which had been hard to
+do before.
+
+One of the very best things about this curious, old-fashioned house was
+that it had an attic which had all the possibilities of a studio. Just a
+little remodeling--and Paris itself could do no better.
+
+To that attic she turned just as soon as Karl had gone over to the
+university. Her things had been carried up; now for a fine morning of
+sorting them out! But instead of attacking the unpacking and sorting and
+arranging she got no farther than a book of her sketches. Sitting down on
+the floor she spread them all around her.
+
+Despite the fact that she had not at once settled down to serious work,
+she made sketches everywhere, just rough, hasty little things--"bubbles
+of joy" she called them to Karl. It seemed now that these were counting
+for more than she had thought. Everything was counting for more than she
+had thought!
+
+Something of the joy of it carried her back to the days when she was a
+little girl and had had such happy times with her blackboard. The thought
+came that now, out of her great happiness, she must pay back to the
+blackboard all that it had given her in those less happy days. Work was
+but the overflow of love!
+
+During the last five months, when Karl had been working in Paris, she had
+studied with Laplace. He had taken her in at once, rejoiced in her and
+scolded her. One day in an unguarded moment he said she knew something
+about colour. No one remembered his ever having said a thing like that
+before. And Ernestine had seen a teardrop on his face when he stood
+before her picture of rain in the autumn woods. That teardrop was very
+precious to her. It seemed she could work years on just the memory of it.
+
+So there were many reasons why she felt like working this morning. All
+the loving and the living and the dreaming and the thinking and the
+working of a lifetime! Karl had understood. Her dream time! She loved
+that way of putting it. Beautiful days to be cherished forever! How rich
+she was in the things she had known! How unstinted love had been with
+her! She wanted now to give with that same largeness, that same
+overwhelming richness, with which she had received. Enthusiasm and desire
+and joy settled to fixed purpose. She began upon actual work.
+
+She kept at it until late in the afternoon. She had never had such a day,
+and the great thing about it was that it seemed a mere beginning, just an
+opening up. A new day had dawned; a day which meant, not the death of the
+dream days, but their reincarnation into life. Those hours when she sat
+idly beneath blue skies, looking dreamily out upon beautiful vistas it
+seemed she should have been painting--how well, after all, they had done
+their work! Dreams which she had not understood were making themselves
+plain to her now. The love days were translating themselves in terms of
+life and work. She wanted to glorify the world until it should be to all
+eyes as the eyes of love had made it to her.
+
+Laplace had said once it was too bad she had married. She thought of that
+now, and smiled. She was sorry for any one who thought it too bad she had
+married!
+
+And then Karl telephoned. Would she come over to the university? He had
+been wanting to show her around, and this would be a good time. She
+dressed hurriedly, humming a little song they had heard often in Paris.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+
+SCIENCE, ART, AND LOVE
+
+From his window in the laboratory he saw her as she was coming across the
+campus, and waved. She waved back, and then wondered if it were proper to
+wave at learned professors who were looking from their windows. In one
+sense it was hard to comprehend that it was her Karl who was such an
+important man about this great university. Karl was so completely just
+her Karl, so human and dear, and a great scientist seemed a remote
+abstraction. She must tell that to Karl. He would enjoy himself as a
+remote abstraction.
+
+She was still smiling about Karl's remoteness as she came into the
+building. He had come down to meet her. "You see I thought you might get
+lost," he explained.
+
+"I might have," she responded, and then laughed, for when people are very
+happy it is not at all difficult to laugh.
+
+"Do you know what you look like?" he said. "You look like a kind of
+spiritualised rainbow--or like the flowers after the rain."
+
+"I dressed in five minutes," said Ernestine, smoothing down her gown with
+the complacency of a woman who knows she has nothing to fear from
+scrutiny.
+
+"As if that had anything to do with it! You dress as the birds and
+flowers dress--by just being yourself."
+
+She let that bit of masculine ignorance pass with a wise little smile.
+
+They were in the laboratory now. "I came," said Ernestine severely, "to
+listen to an elucidation of the mysteries of science."
+
+"Then you had no business to come looking like this," he responded
+promptly.
+
+She was looking around the room. "And this is where all those great
+things are done?"
+
+"Um--well this is where we make attempts at things."
+
+He was not quite through, and Ernestine sat down by the window to wait
+for him. It seemed surprising, somehow, that it should be such a simple
+looking room. Karl was doing something with some tubes, writing something
+on a chart-like thing. Something in the expression of his face as he bent
+over the work carried her back to other days.
+
+"Karl," she said abruptly, "why don't you and I have any quarrels about
+which is greater--science or art?"
+
+He looked up at her in such absolute astonishment that she laughed.
+
+"Liebchen," he said, "don't you think that would be going a long way out
+of our road to hunt a quarrel? Now I can think up much better subjects
+for a quarrel than that. For instance: Do I love you more than you love
+me, or do you love me more than I love you? Your subject makes me think
+of our old debating society. We used to get up and argue in thunderous
+tones something about which was worse--fire or water!"
+
+"But Karl--it isn't logical that you and I should love each other this
+way!"
+
+He pushed back his work and turned squarely around to her. He was smiling
+in his tenderly humorous way. "Well, sweetheart," he said, "would you
+rather be logical, or would you rather be happy?"
+
+"Oh, I'm not insisting upon the logic. I'm just wondering about it."
+
+"Isn't love greater than either a test tube or a paint brush?" Karl asked
+softly.
+
+She nodded, smiling at him lovingly.
+
+He sat there looking a long way ahead. She knew he was thinking something
+out. "Ernestine," he began, "do you ever think much about the _oneness_
+of the world?"
+
+"Why, yes--I do, but I didn't suppose you did."
+
+"But, liebchen--who would be more apt to think about it than I? Doesn't
+my work teach oneness more than it teaches anything else? All the
+quarrelling comes through a failure to recognise the oneness. I often
+think of the different ways Goethe and Darwin got at evolution. Goethe
+had the poetic conception of it all right; Darwin worked it out step by
+step. Who's ahead? And which has any business scoffing at the other?"
+
+He went back to his notes, and her thoughts returned to the battles she
+had heard fought in the name of science. She looked about the room, out
+at the great buildings all around, and then back to Karl, who seemed soul
+of it all. How different all this was! What would her father think to
+hear a man like Karl Hubers giving to a poet place in the developing of
+the theory of evolution? What _was_ the difference between Karl and her
+father? Was it that the school to which they belonged was itself
+changing, or was it just a difference in type? Or, perhaps, most of all,
+was it not a difference in degree? Her father had only seen a little way,
+and that down a narrow path bounded by high walls of bigotry. Karl had
+reached the heights from which he could see the oneness! And was it not
+love had helped him to those heights?
+
+A little later, when Karl was seeking to explain what he evidently
+regarded as a very simple little thing, and just as a few glimmers of
+light were beginning to penetrate her darkness, she looked up and at the
+half open door saw a boy whose consternation at sight of her made it
+difficult for Ernestine to repress a smile.
+
+"Come in, Beason," said Karl, who had just noticed him. "I want you to
+meet Mrs. Hubers." Ernestine looked at Karl suspiciously--something in
+his voice signified he was enjoying something.
+
+But there was nothing about Mr. Beason which signified any kind of
+enjoyment. He advanced to meet her sturdily, as one determined to do his
+duty at any cost. The boy was rendered peculiar in appearance by an
+abnormally long, heavy jaw, which gave his face a heavy, stolid
+appearance which might or might not be characteristic. He had small,
+sharp eyes, and Ernestine was quite sure from one look at his face that
+he did not laugh often, or see many things to laugh about.
+
+He was not impenetrable to graciousness, however, for within five minutes
+he had told her that he was born in southern Indiana, that he lived in
+Minneapolis now, and that he had come to Chicago to get some work with
+Dr. Hubers. Upon hearing that Ernestine immediately noticed what a
+remarkably intelligent face he had, and felt sure that that heavy jaw
+gave him a phlegmatic look which was most misleading.
+
+Karl laughed as the boy went away. "Funny fellow--Beason. He'll have to
+cut away a lot of the trees before he gets a good look at the woods.
+Never in his life has one gleam of humour penetrated him. In fact if a
+few humour cells were to creep in by mistake, they'd be so alien as to
+make a tremendous disturbance."
+
+"He seems to think a great deal of you," said Ernestine, a little
+reproachfully.
+
+"Oh, yes; and I like him. I like the fellow first rate. He's a splendid
+worker--conscientious, absolutely to be depended upon. 'Way ahead of lots
+of these fellows around here who think they know it all. But he has those
+uncompromising ideas about science; ready to fight for it at the drop of
+the hat. Oh, Beason's all right. We need his sort. I'll tell you whom I
+do want you to meet, Ernestine, and that's Hastings. You'll like him.
+He's such a success as a human being. He's more like the old-time
+professor of the small college, has a fatherly, benevolent feeling toward
+all the students. You see we're so big here that we haven't many of the
+small college characteristics about us. It's each fellow doing his own
+work, and not that close comradeship that there is in the small school.
+But Hastings is a connecting link. Then, on the other hand, there's Lane.
+You must meet him too, for he's a rare specimen: pedantic, academic; I
+don't know just why they have him, he doesn't represent the spirit of the
+place at all. He's entirely too erudite to be of much use. But I'll let
+Parkman tell you about Lane. Oh, but he hates him! They met here in the
+laboratory one day and upon my soul I thought Parkman was going to pick
+him up and throw him out the window."
+
+As they were looking through the general laboratory they met Professor
+Hastings, and she could see at once what Karl meant. He was apparently a
+man of about sixty, and kindness was written large upon him. Ernestine
+could fancy his looking after students who were ill, and trying to devise
+some way of helping the poverty-stricken boy through another year in
+college.
+
+They left the building and sauntered slowly across the campus. Almost in
+the centre of the quadrangle Ernestine stopped and looked all around. She
+was beginning to feel what it was for which the University of Chicago
+stood. It was not "college life," all those things vital to the
+undergraduate heart, which this university suggested. She fancied there
+might be things the undergraduate would miss here; she was even a little
+glad her own college days had been spent at the smaller school. As she
+stood looking about at building upon building she had visions, not of
+boys and girls singing their college songs, but of men and women working
+their way toward truth. She looked from one red roof to another, and each
+building seemed to her a separate channel through which men were working
+ahead to the light. It was a place for research, for striving for new
+knowledge, for clearing the way. She turned her face for the moment to
+the north; there was great Chicago, where men fought for wealth and
+power, Chicago, with all the enthusiasm of youth, and the arrogance of
+youthful success, with all the strength of youthful muscle, all the power
+and possibility of young brain and heart. This seemed far away from the
+Board of Trade, from State Street and Michigan Avenue. But was not the
+spirit of it all one? This, too, was Chicago, the Chicago which had
+fought its way through criticism, indifference and jeers to a place in
+the world of scholarship. People who knew what they were talking about
+did not laugh at the University of Chicago any more. It had too much to
+its credit to be passed over lightly. Men were doing things here; she
+felt all about her the ideas here in embryo. How would they develop?
+Where would they strike? What things now slumbering here would step,
+robust and mighty, into the next generation?
+
+And greatest of all these was Karl! She turned to him with flushed,
+glowing face. He had been watching her, following much of her thought.
+"I like this place," she said--her eyes telling all the rest. "I was not
+sure I was going to, but I do."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+
+AS THE SURGEON SAW IT
+
+"But, Karl, you _must!_"
+
+"I tell you, my dear, I can't!"
+
+"Well, I think it's just--"
+
+"Now, Ernestine,"--in tones maddeningly calm and conciliatory--"you go on
+down to Parkman's office and I'll come just as soon as I can. Now be
+sensible--there's a good girl."
+
+"Well, I call it _mean!_"--this after hanging up the receiver. "I don't
+care,"--still talking into the telephone, as if there were satisfaction
+in having something understand--"it's not _nice_ of Karl."
+
+They had an engagement with Dr. Parkman for dinner at his club, to meet
+some people he wanted her to know, and now Karl had telephoned from the
+laboratory at the last minute that he was not ready to leave and for her
+to go on down alone.
+
+"And he'll come late--and not dressed--and they'll think,"--she went over
+and sat down by the window to enjoy the mournful luxury of contemplating
+just what they would think.
+
+Couldn't he go over to the laboratory a little earlier in the morning and
+finish up this terribly important thing? Was it nice of a man to have
+people being _sorry_ for his wife? Was it considerate of Karl to ask her
+to put on this pearl-coloured dress and then let her go down in the train
+all alone?
+
+She would telephone Dr. Parkman that they could not come. Then Karl would
+be sorry! But no--severely and with dignity--she would show that one
+member of the family had some sense of the conventions. Oh, yes--this in
+long-suffering vein--she would do _her_ part, and would also do her best
+to make up for Karl. No doubt she might as well become accustomed to that
+first as last.
+
+Going down in the train she had a very clear picture of herself as the
+poor, neglected wife of the man absorbed in his work. She saw so many
+reasons for being unhappy. Was it kind the way Karl had told her in that
+first letter about some other woman in his life, and then had never so
+much as revealed to her that other woman's name? Where did this woman
+live? When had Karl known her? How _well_ had he known her? And all the
+while her sense of humour was striving to make attacks upon her and the
+consciousness in her inmost heart that all this was absurd and most
+unworthy only made her the more persistently forlorn.
+
+She had never been to Dr. Parkman's office, and she was not very familiar
+with Chicago--had it never occurred to Karl she might get lost and have
+some unfortunate experience? But fate did not favour her mood, and she
+reached the office in safety. Dr. Parkman did not seem at all surprised
+at seeing her alone, which flamed the fire anew.
+
+"He hasn't backed out?" he demanded, laughing a little.
+
+She explained with considerable dignity that her husband had been
+detained at the laboratory, that he regretted it exceedingly, but would
+be with them just as soon as circumstances permitted.
+
+He took her into his private office, and Ernestine was too sincere a
+lover of beautiful things to be wholly miserable in a room like that.
+
+"Why, this doesn't look like an office," she exclaimed. "It's more like a
+pet room in a beautiful home."
+
+He laughed, not mirthfully.
+
+"I hardly think you could call it that, but this is where I spend a good
+deal of my time, so I tried to make it livable."
+
+He was busy at his desk, and she watched his hands. She was thinking that
+she would like to paint a picture and call it "The Surgeon." She would
+leave the man's face and figure in shadow, concentrating the light upon
+those hands, letting them tell their own story.
+
+The whole man stood for force. She was sure that he always had his way
+about things, that he simply took for granted having his own way. Yet
+there was something in which he had not had his way. Karl had told her a
+little about that; she must ask him more about it. It seemed suddenly
+that there was something pathetic about this beautiful room. Did it not
+reflect a man trying to make up to himself for the things he did not
+have? It was a room which suggested pleasant hours and fine, quiet
+enjoyment. The deep, leather chairs seemed made for long, intimate
+conversations. The dark red tapestry, the oak panelling, this richly
+toned rug, the few real pictures, the little odds and ends suggestive of
+remote corners of the world--it seemed a setting for some beautiful
+companionship, some close sympathy, a place where one would like to sit
+for hours and be just one's self. But was not Dr. Parkman's life lacking
+in the very things of which this bespoke an appreciation? There was a
+subtle pathos in a beautiful room which breathed loneliness. She thought
+of their own library at home, quick to sense the difference.
+
+The doctor went into an adjoining room, and her thoughts were broken by
+the low murmur of voices. Then the inner door opened; he was showing a
+man through to the outer office. The man stumbled over the rug, and at
+his exclamation Ernestine looked up. Her own face paled; she half rose
+from her chair;--the native impulse to do something. She looked at Dr.
+Parkman. His face was entirely masked. The man passed into the outer
+room, leaving behind him something which caused Ernestine's heart to beat
+fast.
+
+The doctor walked slowly over to his chair and sat down. He seemed
+unconscious of her for a moment, and then he looked at her and saw that
+she had seen and that she wanted to know.
+
+"You'd think a man would get used to it," he said in his short, gruff
+way. "You'd think it would become a matter of course, but it doesn't.
+That man's wife is dying of cancer. It's not an operable case. I told him
+that to-day. He asked for the truth and I gave it. I even gave my
+estimate of the time." He swung his chair around and looked out at the
+roof of the building below, and then turned sharply back to her. "You
+said a while ago that this looked like a home. Well, it's not. It's like
+a good many other things--empty show. Where that man lives, it's not much
+for looks, but it _is_ a home, and this means--breaking it up. In there a
+minute ago, I told him he had to lose the only thing in life he cares
+anything about. He--oh, well!" and with one of his abrupt changes, he
+turned away.
+
+But Ernestine was leaning forward in her chair. Her lips were parted. Her
+eyes were very dark.
+
+"Cancer--you say, doctor?"--her voice was so low he could barely catch
+it. "Cancer?"
+
+He nodded, looking at her intently.
+
+"But that's what Karl's working on! That's what Karl's doing this very
+minute!"
+
+"Yes, and do you ever think of it like that? Do you ever think of the
+lives and homes he is going to save; the tragedies and heartbreaks he is
+going to avert; the children he is going to keep from being motherless or
+fatherless if he does do this thing?--and I believe with all my heart
+he will! I tell you, Mrs. Hubers, you want to help him! I'm not sorry
+you saw that little thing just now. It will show you the other side of
+it--the human side. And there wasn't anything unusual in it. All over the
+world, physicians are doing this same thing every day--telling people
+it's hopeless, admitting there's nothing to be done. Then think of the
+tremendousness of this work Karl Hubers is doing!--where it strikes--the
+hearts breaking for it--the thousands praying for it! Is it any wonder
+we're watching it? Interested? I tell you _we_ know what it means."
+
+She was unconscious of the tear on her cheek, of the quivering of her
+face.
+
+"And Karl is doing that? _That_ is what Karl's work means?"
+
+"Karl's work simply means giving into our hands the power to save more
+lives. Now we're doing the best we can with what we have--but God knows
+we're short on power! We're groping around in the dark. Karl's work means
+letting in the light."
+
+His voice had grown warm. Something had fallen from him--leaving him
+himself. In his eyes was a wealth of unspeakable feeling.
+
+"Doctor, I want to thank you!"--but it was her face thanked him most
+eloquently.
+
+She was glad when he left her for a minute before they finally went away.
+Her heart was very full. This was Karl! This the real meaning of Karl's
+work! To think she had looked at it in that small, paltry way--that even
+in her thoughts she had put the slightest stumbling block in his path.
+This very afternoon had come new inspiration and she had resented it, had
+said small, mean things in her heart because he stayed to work out his
+precious thoughts. Why, it would have been fairly criminal for Karl to
+run away from that call of his work!
+
+She wanted to tell him all about it; she yearned to "make it up to him,"
+make him more happy than he had ever been before. She dwelt upon it all
+until, when Dr. Parkman came in for her, he was startled at the light
+shining from her face.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+
+KARL IN HIS LABORATORY
+
+One of their favourite speculations, as the days went on, was as to
+whether any one had ever been so happy before. They argued it from all
+sides, in a purely unprejudiced and dispassionate manner, and always
+arrived at the conclusion that of course no one ever had. "Because,"
+Ernestine would say, "no one ever had so many reasons for being happy."
+"And if they had," he would respond, "they would have said something
+about it."
+
+Ernestine worked that winter as she had never worked before. That first
+day had not been a deceptive one. She had done some of the things which
+something within her heart assured her that day she could do. The best
+thing she had done she sent to Laplace, as he had asked her to. "It's
+considered rather superior to disdain the Salon," she said to Karl, the
+day they packed the canvas, "but Paris seems the only way of proving to
+Americans that good can come out of America."
+
+She had heard from Laplace that the picture would be hung. His brief
+comment had been that America could not be so bad as was sometimes said.
+She was eager now to hear more about it. She would surely have a letter
+very soon. And she and Karl were so happy! It had been such a glorious,
+wholesome, splendidly worth while winter.
+
+It was one afternoon in early spring that over in the laboratory John
+Beason and Professor Hastings were talking of Dr. Hubers. "But that isn't
+all of it," said Professor Hastings in the midst of a discussion. "This
+fanaticism for veracity Huxley talks about isn't all of it by any means.
+Any of us can get together a lot of facts. It takes the big man to know
+what the facts mean."
+
+"Somebody said that truth was the soul of facts," said Beason, in the
+uncertain way he talked of anything outside tabulated knowledge. "But I
+suppose that's just one of those things people say."
+
+"Yes--but is it? Isn't it true? Why is Hubers greater than the rest of
+us? It isn't that he works harder. We all work. It isn't that he's more
+exact. We're all exact. Isn't it that very thing of having a genius
+for getting the soul out of his facts? That man looks a long way
+ahead--smells truth away off, as it were. I tell you, Mr. Beason,
+scientific training kills many men for research work. They're afraid to
+move more than inch by inch. They won't take any jumps. Now Dr. Hubers
+jumps; I've seen him do it. Of course, after he's made his jump he goes
+back and sees that there aren't any ditches in between, but he's not
+afraid of a leap in the dark. That's his own peculiar gift. Most of us
+are not made for jumping."
+
+"But that doesn't sound like the scientific method," said Beason, brows
+knitted.
+
+"I'll admit it wouldn't do for general practice," replied the older man,
+a twinkle in his eye. "The spirit has to move you, or you wouldn't gain
+anything but a broken neck."
+
+"Yes, but that thing of a spirit moving you," said Beason, more sure of
+himself here, "that does not belong in science at all; that is a part of
+religion."
+
+"And to a man like Dr. Hubers"--very quietly and firmly--"science is
+religion."
+
+Beason pondered that a minute. "They're entirely distinct," was his
+conclusion.
+
+"So it seems to you; but I'm a year or two older than you are, Mr.
+Beason, and the longer I live the more firmly I believe that there is
+such a thing as an intuitive sense of truth. If there isn't, why is Dr.
+Hubers a greater man than I am?"--and with that he left him, smiling a
+little at how it had never occurred to Beason to say anything polite.
+
+Beason was in truth much perturbed. It was not pleasing to have the
+greatness of his idol explained on unscientific principles. He did not
+like that idea of the jumps. Jumping sounded unscientific, and what could
+be worse than to say of a man that he was not scientific? Preposterous to
+say the greatest things of science were achieved by unscientific methods!
+
+To-day Dr. Hubers had been all afternoon alone in his laboratory. Some
+one had brought him in some luncheon at noon, but since one o'clock the
+door had not opened, and now it was almost five. What was going on in
+there? Even Beason had the imagination to wonder.
+
+Could he have seen he would not have been much enlightened. The man was
+sitting before a table, his arms reaching out in front of him--some
+tubes, his microscope, other things he had been working with within
+reach, but unheeded now. For he was not seeing now the detail, the
+immediate. This was not one of those moments of advancing step by step.
+The light in those eyes of wonderful sight was the light from a farther
+distance. A way had opened ahead; far out across dim places he could see
+it now. The afternoon had been a momentous one. He had taken a step
+leading to a greater height, and with the greater height came a wider
+vision. A few of those minutes such as he was living now fires a man for
+months--yes, years, of work. Ahead were days when the fires of
+inspiration would be in abeyance, when the work would be only a working
+of step by step--detail, some would call it drudgery. But it is in these
+moments of inspiration man qualifies for the fight. In the hours of
+working onward toward the light he may grow very weary, but he can never
+forget that one day, for just a moment, the light opened to him. Moments
+such as Karl Hubers was living now mark the great man from the small.
+
+And his glowing moment was more than a promise; it was also a reward. It
+was spring now, and all through the winter he had worked hard. He had
+come back in the fall determining in the gratitude of his great happiness
+to do the best work of his life. He pulled his microscope over in front
+of him and looked over it after the manner of one dreaming. How many days
+he had come to it eager to note the slightest significance in its
+variations of colour, for the staining of the slides made colour count in
+his work almost as it did in Ernestine's, only to be met with the
+non-essential, more of the husk and no sight of the kernel. He smiled a
+little to think what a bulky and stupid volume it would make were he to
+write down all he had done. If each hope, each possibility, each
+experiment and verification were to be put down, he could quite rival in
+bulk a government report. And if added to that should be a report of the
+cases he had watched, the operations he had attended, the attempts at
+getting living matter and of working with dead, how large and how useless
+that volume would be were it to contain it all! He had done days and days
+of useless work to get the slightest thing that was significant.
+
+Only the week before Ernestine had laughingly read him an article one of
+the popular magazines printed on cancer research. The whole thing is
+becoming a farce--so said the popular magazine. Every once in a while
+some man issues a report saying the germ is in sight. Then another man
+appears with a still more learned report saying it is not a germ at all.
+All doing different things, and all sure they are on the right track!
+Meanwhile the disease is on the increase, surgery cannot meet it
+satisfactorily, and while laboratories pursue the peaceful tenor of their
+way, men and women are dying hard deaths which no one seems able to stay.
+Truly, the man behind the microscope is a very slow man the article had
+concluded.
+
+No doubt that seemed true. He could see the writer's point of view well
+enough. The things the man behind the microscope did accomplish sounded
+so very easy that the on-looker could give only indolence and stupidity
+as the reason for not accomplishing a great deal more.
+
+And even from his own point of view, with his own knowledge of all the
+facts in the case, he had no doubt that once done it would sound so easy
+that he would stand amazed to think it had not been done before. Let the
+unknown become the known, and even the trained worker cannot look upon it
+as other than a matter of course. It was so easy now to meet diphtheria.
+Strange they had let so many children die of it! It was so very easy now
+to give a man an anesthetic. Fearful how they had let a man suffer
+through every stroke of the knife, or die for need of it! Should he blame
+the man outside for looking at it that way when even to him things
+accomplished took on that matter of course aspect?
+
+He began putting away his things. It was Ernestine's birthday, and he had
+promised to be home early, for they were going to the theatre. "It will
+be like all the rest," he mused. "Once done, it will seem so easy that we
+will wonder why it was not done long before." Again the fire leaped high
+within him. To do it! Perhaps after all he did see it too complexly. He
+must not let the husk dull his eye to the kernel. A man building a
+beautiful tower must erect a scaffold. But the scaffolding should not
+make him forget the tower! Some way in this last hour his mind had seemed
+to clear. His immense amount of useless work was not hanging about his
+neck like a millstone. Something had cut that away. He was free from it
+all. He could feel within himself that his approach to his problem was
+better than it had been before. Perhaps he had made the mistake of the
+others of looking at it as something fearfully complex, something it
+would be the hardest thing in all the world for any man to do. It all
+looked more simple now. It was as if muscles strained to the point of
+tenseness had relaxed, and in an easy and natural way he foresaw victory
+as a logical part of his work.
+
+He was happy to-night, light-hearted. The windows of the laboratory were
+open to the soft air of that glorious day of early spring, and his spirit
+was open too, open to the soul of the world, taking unto itself the sweet
+and simple spirit of the men who have done the greatest things. From his
+window he could see one of the tennis courts. Some of the students were
+playing. "Good!" he exclaimed enthusiastically to himself, as he watched
+a return that had looked impossible. He was glad they were playing
+tennis. Why shouldn't they?
+
+Professor Hastings heard him whistling softly to himself--a German love
+song--as he walked through the big laboratory, and catching a glimpse of
+the younger man's face, he nodded his head and smiled. It had been a
+good afternoon--that was plain. Now let there be more afternoons like
+this--and then--to think it should be done right here under his very
+eyes! Was not that joy enough for any man?
+
+On the steps of the building Karl stopped suddenly, put his hand in his
+inner pocket and drew out a small box. Yes, it was there all right, and a
+girl passing up the steps just then was amazed and much fluttered to
+think Dr. Hubers should be smiling so beautifully at her. In fact,
+Dr. Hubers did not know that the girl was passing. She had simply been in
+the direction of his smile; and he was smiling because it was Ernestine's
+birthday, and because he had so beautiful a present for her. He walked
+along very fast. He could scarcely wait to see her face when he gave it
+to her. Too bad he had kept her waiting so long!
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+
+PICTURES IN THE EMBERS
+
+They were back home now.
+
+"Why, Mary has intuitions," laughed Ernestine, when she saw that a fire
+had been lighted in the library, and was in just the proper state for
+seeing pictures. "A girl who knew we would want a fire has either been in
+love or ought to be. At any rate, she knows we are."
+
+"This is the kind of a night when a fire serves artistic purposes only.
+You don't need it, so you have to enjoy it all the more."
+
+"Still, these spring evenings are damp," she insisted, defending the
+fire. "It doesn't feel at all uncomfortable."
+
+"And looks immense," he added, turning down the gas and pulling up a seat
+just right for sitting before the fire.
+
+She leaned over, holding her hand so close to the flame that he wondered
+at first what she was doing.
+
+"See!" she cried, "see my ruby in the firelight, Karl! It's just a piece
+of it right up here on my hand!"
+
+"And I suppose,"--seeming to be injured--"that during the remainder of my
+life, I may play second fiddle to that ring. Oh, Ernestine--you're a
+woman! I was mortified to death at the theatre. You didn't look at the
+play at all. You just sat and looked down at that ring. Oh, I saw through
+that thing of not being able to fasten your glove!"
+
+She was twisting her hand about to show off the stone--any woman of any
+land who has ever owned a ring knows just how to do it.
+
+"See, dear!" she laughed exultantly, "it _is_ fire! You can see things in
+it just as you can in the coals."
+
+But he was not looking at the ring. There were things to be seen in her
+face and he was looking at them. He loved this child in her. Was it in
+all women when they love, he wondered, as many other men have wondered of
+other women, or was it just Ernestine?
+
+"It was a dreadful thing for you to get it," she scolded,--these
+affectionate scoldings were a great joy to him. "It's a ridiculous thing
+for a poor college professor--that's you--to buy a ruby ring. Why, rubies
+exist just to show millionaires how rich they are! And it's a scandalous
+thing for a poor man's wife--that's I--to be wearing a real ruby!" Then
+her other hand went over the ring, and clasping both to her breast she
+laughed gleefully: "But it's mine! They'll not get it now!"
+
+"Who wants it, foolish child?" he asked, pressing her head to his
+shoulder and holding the ring hand in his.
+
+She moved a little nearer to him.
+
+"See some pictures for me in the fire," she commanded. "See something
+nice."
+
+"I see a beautiful lady wearing a beautiful ring. See?--right under that
+top piece of coal. The ring is growing larger and larger and larger. Now
+it is so large you can't see the lady at all, just nothing but the ring."
+
+She laughed. "Now see one that isn't silly. See a beautiful one."
+
+"Liebchen, I see two people who are growing old. See?--right down here.
+One of them must be sixty now, and one about seventy, but they're smiling
+just as they did when they were young. And they're whispering that they
+love each other a great deal better now than they did in those days of
+long ago; that it has grown and grown until it is a bigger thing than the
+love of youth ever dreamed of."
+
+"That _is_ nice," she murmured happily. "That would be a nice picture to
+paint." They were silent for a time, perhaps both seeing pictures of
+their own. "It's growing late," said Ernestine, a little drowsily, "but
+then, I'll never have this birthday again."
+
+"And it was happy?" he asked tenderly. "Just as happy as you wanted it to
+be?"
+
+"So happy that I hate to see it go. It was--just right."
+
+"Weren't any of the others happy, dear?"--he was stroking her hair,
+thinking that it too had caught little touches of the fire-light.
+
+"None of the others were perfect. Of course, last year was our first one
+together, and"--a shudder ran through her.
+
+"I know, dear," he hastened; "I know that wasn't a perfect day."
+
+"Before that," she went on, after a minute of looking a long way into the
+fire, "something always happened. My birthday seemed ill-fated. That was
+why I wanted a happy one so much--to make up for all the others. This day
+began right by the work going so splendidly. Is there anything much more
+satisfying than the feeling which comes at the close of a good day's
+work? It puts you on such good terms with yourself, convinces you that
+you have a perfect right to be alive. Then this afternoon I read some
+things which I had read long ago and didn't understand then as I do now.
+You see, there was a great deal I didn't know before I loved you, Karl;
+and books are just human enough to want to be met half way."
+
+"Like men," he commented, meeting her then a trifle more than half way.
+
+"Yes, they have to be petted and fussed over, just like men. Now, Karl,
+are you listening or are you not?"
+
+He assured her that he was listening.
+
+"Then, this afternoon, Georgia came out and we went for a row on the
+lagoon in Jackson Park. Did you happen to look out and see how beautiful
+it was this afternoon, Karl? I wish you would do that once in a while.
+Germs and cells and things aren't so very aesthetic, you know, and I
+don't like to have you miss things. I was thinking about you as we passed
+the university. It seemed such a big, wonderful place, and I love to
+think of what it is your work really means. I _am_ so proud of you,
+Karl!"
+
+"And was it nice down there?" he asked, just to bring her back to her
+story of the day.
+
+"So beautiful! You and I must go often now that the spring evenings have
+come. There is one place where you come out from a bridge, and can see
+the German building, left from the World's Fair, across a great sweep of
+lights and shadows. People who want to go to Europe and can't, should go
+down there and look at that. It's so old-worldish.
+
+"Then Georgia and I had a fine talk,"--after another warm, happy silence.
+"Georgia never was so nice. She was telling me all about a man. I
+shouldn't wonder; but I mustn't tell even you--not yet. Then I came home
+and here were the beautiful flowers from Dr. Parkman. Karl--you _did_
+tell him! Honest now--you did--and it was awful. Why didn't you put it in
+the university paper so that all the students could send me things? That
+nice boy, Harry Wyman, wrote a poem about me--'To the Lovely Lady'--now
+you needn't laugh! And oh, I don't know, but it all seemed so beautiful
+and right when I came home this afternoon. I love our house more and
+more. I love those funny knobs on the doors, and this library seems just
+_us_! I was so happy I couldn't keep from singing, and you know I can't
+sing at all. Then _you_ came home! You had the box out in your hand--I
+saw it clear across the street. You were smiling just like a boy. I shall
+never forget how you looked as you gave me the ring. I think, after all,
+that look was my _real_ birthday gift.--Now, Karl, don't you _know_ you
+shouldn't have bought such a ring? But, oh!--I, _am_ so happy,
+sweetheart."
+
+He kissed her. His heart was very full. There was nothing he could say,
+so he kissed her again and laid his cheek upon her hair.
+
+He knew she was growing sleepy. Sleep was coming to her as it does to the
+child who has had its long, happy day. But like the child, she would not
+give up until the last. It was true, he was sure, that she was loath to
+let the day go.
+
+"The play to-night was very nice," she said, rousing a little, "but so
+short-sighted."
+
+"Short-sighted, liebchen? How?"
+
+"So many things in literature stop short when the people are married. I
+think that's such an immature point of view--just as if that were the end
+of the story. And when they write stories about married people they
+usually have them terribly unhappy about having to live together, and
+wishing they could live with some one else. It seems to me they leave out
+the best part."
+
+"The best part, I suppose, meaning us?"
+
+"Yes!"
+
+"But, dear, if you and I were written up, just as we are, we'd be called
+two idiots."
+
+"Would we?"--her head was caressing his coat.
+
+"Have you ever thought how a stenographic or phonographic report of some
+of our conversations would sound?"
+
+"Beautiful," she murmured.
+
+"Crazy!" he insisted.
+
+"Perhaps the world didn't mean people to be so happy as we are,"--her
+words stumbled drowsily.
+
+"The world isn't as good to many people as it is to us. Oh,
+sweetheart--why,"--he held her closely but very tenderly, for he knew she
+was going to sleep--"why are we so happy?"
+
+"Because I'm the--lovely--lady,"--it came from just outside the land of
+dreams.
+
+It was sweet to have her go to sleep in his arms like this. He trembled
+with the joy of holding her, looking at her face with eyes of tenderest
+love, rejoicing in her, worshipping her. He went over the things she had
+said, his whole being mellowed, divinely exultant, at thought of her
+going to sleep just because she was tired from her day of happiness. Long
+ago his mother had taught him to pray, and he prayed now that he might
+keep her always as she was to-day, that he might guard her ever as she
+had that sense now of being guarded, that her only weariness might come
+as this had come, because she was so happy. How beautiful she was as she
+slept! The Lovely Lady--that boy had said it right, after all. And she
+was his!--his treasure--his joy--his sweetest thing in life! He had heard
+a discussion over at the university a few days before about the equality
+of man and woman. How foolish that seemed in this divine moment! God in
+His great far-sightedness had given to the world a masculine and a
+feminine soul. How insane to talk of their being alike, when the highest
+happiness in life came through their being so entirely different! And she
+was his! Other men could send her flowers--write poems about her
+loveliness--but she was his, all his. His to love and cherish and
+protect--to work for--live for!
+
+He kissed her, and her eyes opened. "Poor little girl's so tired; but
+she'll have to wake up enough to go to bed."
+
+She smiled, murmured something that sounded like "Happy day," and went to
+sleep again.
+
+The fire had died low. He sat there a minute longer dreaming before it,
+thanking God for a home, for work and love and happiness. Then he picked
+Ernestine up in his arms as one would pick up the little child too tired
+to walk to bed. "Oh, liebchen," he breathed in tender passion, as she
+nestled close to him,--"ich liebe dich!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+
+A WARNING AND A PREMONITION
+
+It put him very much out of patience to have his eyes bothering him just
+when he was so anxious to work. What in the world was the matter with
+them, he wondered, as he directed a couple of students on some work they
+were helping him with. It seemed that yesterday afternoon he had taken a
+new start; now he was eager to work things out while he felt like this.
+This was a very inopportune time for a cold, or whatever it was, to
+settle in his eyes. Perhaps the lights at the theatre last night, and
+then the wind coming home--but he smiled an intimate little smile with
+himself at thought of last night and forgot all about that sandy feeling
+in his eyes.
+
+During the morning it almost passed away. When he thought of it at all,
+it was only to be thankful it was not amounting to anything, for he was
+anxious to do a good day's work. He would hate it if anything were to
+happen to his eyes and he had to wear glasses! He had never had the
+slightest trouble with them; in fact they had served him so well that he
+never gave them any thought. The idea came now of how impossible it would
+be to do anything without them. His work depended entirely on seeing
+things right; it was the appearance of things in their different stages
+which told the story.
+
+Dr. Hubers had a queer little trick with his eyes; the students who
+worked with him had often noticed it. He had a way of resting his finger
+in the corner of his eye when thinking. Sometimes it would rest in one
+eye for awhile, and then if he became a little restless, moved under a
+new thought, he would slip his finger meditatively over his nose to the
+corner of the other eye. It did not signify anything in particular,
+merely an unconscious mannerism. Some men pull their hair, others gnaw
+their under lip, and with him it was a queer little way of rubbing his
+finger in his eye.
+
+It was Saturday, and that was always a good day for him as he could give
+all of his time to the laboratory. He was especially anxious to have
+things go well this morning, as he wanted to stop at two o'clock and go
+down to one of Dr. Parkman's operations. That end of it was very
+important and this was to be an especially good operation.
+
+He was thinking about Dr. Parkman on the way down;--of the man's splendid
+surgery. It was a real joy to see him work. He did big things so very
+easily and quietly; not at all as though they were overwhelming him. Poor
+Parkman--things should have gone differently with him. If it had been
+almost any other man, it would have mattered less, but it seemed a matter
+of a lifetime with Parkman. He could understand that better now than he
+once had. To have found Ernestine and then--then to have found she was
+_not_ Ernestine! But of course in the case of Ernestine that could not
+be. Now if Parkman had only found an Ernestine--but then he couldn't very
+well, for there was only one! Since the first of time, there had been
+only one--and she was his! He fell to dreaming of how she had looked last
+night in the fire-light, and almost forgot the station at which he was to
+get off.
+
+He was in very jubilant mood when they went down to Dr. Parkman's office
+after the operation. It had verified some of his own conclusions; seemed
+fairly to stand as an endorsement of what he held. He had never felt more
+sure of himself, had never seen his way more clearly. It was a great
+thing to have facts bear one out, to see made real what one had believed
+to be true. He went over it all with Parkman, putting his case clearly,
+convincingly, his points standing out true and unassailable; throwing
+away all the irrelevant, picking out unerringly, the little kernel of
+truth;--a big mind this, a mind qualified to cope with big problems. Dr.
+Parkman had never seen so clearly as he did to-day how absolutely his
+friend possessed those peculiar qualities the work demanded. He had never
+felt more sure of Karl's power; and power did not cover it--not quite.
+
+"Something in your eye?" he asked when, just as Karl was about to leave,
+he seemed to be bothered with his eye, and was rubbing it a little.
+
+"I don't know. It's felt off and on all day as though something was the
+matter with them both."
+
+"Want me to take a look at them?"
+
+"Oh no--no, it's nothing."
+
+"By the way, you have a bad trick with your eyes. I've noticed it several
+times lately and intended to tell you about it. You have a way of rubbing
+them;--not rubbing them exactly, but pressing your finger in them. I'd
+quit that if I were you. If you must put your finger somewhere, put it on
+your nose. A man dealing with the stuff you do can't be too careful."
+
+"Why, what do you mean?"
+
+"Simply what I say. One drop of some of those things you have out there
+would be--a drop too much."
+
+"Now, look here, you don't think I'm any such a bungler as that, do you?"
+
+"Hum! You ought to know your medical history well enough to know that all
+the victims haven't been bunglers, by a long sight."
+
+Karl's hand was on the knob. "Well, don't worry about me; I'm not built
+for a victim. I may be run over by an automobile--anybody is liable to be
+run over by yours, the way you run that thing--but I'm not liable to be
+killed by my own sword. That's not the way I work."
+
+"Just the same, you'd better keep your hands out of your eyes!"
+
+"All right," he agreed laughingly. "It does sound like a fool's trick.
+It's new to me;--didn't know that I did it."
+
+When he was making some calls late that evening, Dr. Parkman passed the
+university and for some reason recalled what Karl had said that afternoon
+about his eyes bothering him. Why hadn't he examined them; or better
+still, one of the best oculists in the city was right there in the
+building--why hadn't he made Karl go in to see him? It was criminal for a
+man like that to neglect his eyes! He was near the Hubers now; he had an
+impulse to run over and make sure that everything was all right. He
+slowed up the machine and looked at his watch. No, it was almost eleven;
+he would not go now. After all he was silly to be attaching any weight to
+such a thing as a man's rubbing his eyes. He smiled a little as he
+thought of it that way. Karl wasn't bothering about it; so why should he?
+
+But he had it on his mind, thinking of it frequently until he went to
+bed. And the thing which worried him most was that he was worrying a
+great deal more than the facts in the case warranted. He was not given to
+taking notions, and that was just what this seemed. One would suppose
+that a man like Hubers would be able to look out for himself,--"but for a
+fool, give me a great man!" was the thought with which the doctor went to
+sleep.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+
+AN UNCROSSED BRIDGE
+
+Karl awoke next morning with the sense of something wrong. Something was
+making him uncomfortable, but he was not wide enough awake at first to
+locate the trouble. He lay there dozing for a few minutes and when he
+roused again he knew that his eyes were hurting badly. He awakened
+instantly then. His eyes? Why, they had bothered him a little all day
+yesterday. Was there something the matter with them?
+
+He got up, raised the shade and looked in the glass. They looked badly
+irritated, both of them. They felt wretchedly; he could scarcely keep
+looking into the glass. Then leaning over the dressing table, he looked
+more closely. He thought he saw something he did not like. He took a hand
+mirror and went to the window. He could see better now, and the better
+light verified the other one. It was true that in the corner of one eye
+there was a drop of pus. In the other there was a suggestion of the same
+thing.
+
+He began to dress, proceeding slowly, his brows knitted, evidently
+thinking about something, and worried. Then he opened a drawer, took out
+a handkerchief, got the drop of pus from his eye and arranged the
+handkerchief for preserving it.
+
+He would find out about that, and the sooner the better! He did not like
+it. He would see an oculist, too, this morning. It was plain he was going
+to have some trouble with his eyes.
+
+Ernestine noticed them at once. What made them so red?--she wanted to
+know. Did they hurt? And wasn't there something he could put in them? He
+told her he was going to look after them at once. He could not afford to
+lose any time, and of course he could do nothing without his eyes.
+
+Immediately after breakfast he started over to the laboratory.
+
+It was Sunday morning and there would be no one there, which was so much
+the better. He wanted to get this straightened out.
+
+He had his head down all the way over to the university, partly because
+his eyes bothered him and partly because he was thinking hard. The
+trouble had evidently been coming on yesterday. He stopped short. That
+trick Parkman told him about! But of course--moving on a little--that
+could not have anything to do with this. He had no recollection--he was
+very sure--then he walked faster, and the lines of his mouth told that he
+was troubled.
+
+When he reached the laboratory he began immediately upon the microscopic
+examination. He hoped he could get at it through that, for the culture
+process meant a long wait. But after fifteen minutes of careful work the
+"smear" proved negative. There remained then only the longer route of the
+culture.
+
+He did not begin upon that immediately. He sat there trying to think back
+to just what it was he had been doing Friday afternoon. The latter part
+of the afternoon he had been sitting here by this table. That was the
+time he was so buoyed up--getting so fine a light on the thing. It was
+the cancer problem then--but in the nature of things nothing could have
+happened with that. But there were always other things--all those things
+known to the pathological laboratory.
+
+He turned around toward the culture oven, opened the outer door and
+through the inner door of glass looked in at the row of tubes. He was
+trying to recall what it was he had been working with the earlier part of
+Friday afternoon.
+
+He knew now; one of the tubes had brought it to him. Yes, he knew now,
+and within him there was a pause, and a stillness. Right over there was
+where he sat preparing some cultures. There were two things with which he
+had been working;--again a pause, and a stillness. One of them could not
+make any serious difference; he went that far firmly, and then his heart
+seemed to stand quite still, waiting for his thought to go on. But he did
+not go on; there was a little convulsive clutching of his consciousness,
+and a return, with acclaim, to the fact that _that_ could not make any
+serious difference. He clung there; he would not leave that; doggedly,
+defiantly, insistently, all-embracingly he affirmed that _that_ could not
+make any serious difference. It was without opening his thought to
+anything further that he got out his things and began preparing the
+culture.
+
+He was so accustomed to this that it went very mechanically and quickly.
+He took one of the test tubes arranged for the process in the culture
+oven and with the small wire instrument he had there, lifted the drop of
+pus on the handkerchief into the bullion of the tube. He did it all very
+carefully, very exactly, just as he always did. Then he put the tuft of
+cotton over the top and placed the tube in that strange-looking box
+commonly called a culture oven. In twenty-four hours he would know the
+truth. He adjusted the gas with a firm hand, arranging with his usual
+precision this thing which outwardly was like any of his experiments and
+which in reality--but he would not go into that.
+
+Now for an oculist. His eyes were hurting badly; it was time to do
+whatever there was to be done. After all he was rather jumping at
+conclusions. There was a big chance that this was just something
+characteristic to eyes and had no relation to the things of his work. He
+seized upon that, ridiculing himself for having looked right over the
+most simple and natural explanation of all. Did not a great many people
+have trouble with their eyes?
+
+That nerved him up all the way down town. He was almost ready to think it
+a great joke, the way he had hurried over to the laboratory and had gone
+at it in that life-and-death fashion.
+
+He knew that the oculist in Dr. Parkman's building was a good one, and so
+he went there. It was a little disconcerting when he stepped into the
+elevator to meet Dr. Parkman himself. He had not thought of trying
+especially to avoid the doctor, but he had wanted to see the oculist
+first and get the thing straightened out. He was counting a great deal
+now on the oculist.
+
+"Hello!" said the doctor, seeming startled at first, and then after one
+sharp glance: "Going up to see me?"
+
+"Well, yes, after a little. Fact of the matter is I thought I'd run in
+and let this eye fellow take a look at me."
+
+"Eyes bothering you?"
+
+"Somewhat." He said it shortly, almost curtly.
+
+When they reached the fifth floor, Dr. Parkman stepped out with him,
+although he himself belonged farther up.
+
+"I know him pretty well," he explained, "I'll go with you."
+
+He could not very well say: "I would rather you would not," although for
+some reason he felt that way.
+
+It was soon clear to their initiated minds that the oculist did not know
+the exact nature of the trouble. He admitted that the case perplexed him.
+He, too, must make an examination of the pus. He treated Karl's eyes, and
+advised that they begin upon an immediate and aggressive course of
+treatment. Dr. Parkman, observing Karl's growing irritability, said that
+he would look after all that, see that the right thing was done.
+
+As he walked out of that office Karl was a little dizzy. His avenue of
+hope had grown narrower. It was not, then, some affection characteristic
+of eyes. It was, after all, something from without. It was, in all
+probability, one of two things,--it was either--but again he did not go
+beyond the first, telling himself with nervous buoyancy that _that_ would
+not make any serious difference.
+
+They stepped into an elevator and went up. He knew Parkman would ask him
+questions now, but it seemed he could not get away from the doctor if he
+tried. He felt just at present as though he had not strength to resist
+any one. That oculist, he admitted to himself, had taken a good deal of
+starch out of him.
+
+When they reached the office, Dr. Parkman offered him a drink; that
+irritated him considerably.
+
+"Why no," he said, fretfully, "No--I don't want a drink. Why should I
+take a drink? Did you think I was all shot to pieces about something?"
+
+The doctor was looking over his mail, fingering it a great deal, but not
+seeming to accomplish much of anything with it. At last he wheeled around
+toward him.
+
+"What's the matter with your eyes?" he asked with disconcerting
+directness.
+
+"How should I know?" retorted Karl, heatedly, almost angrily. "What do I
+know about it? If an oculist can't tell--you say he is a good one--why
+should you expect me to?" And then he added with a touch of eagerness, as
+if seizing upon a possibility: "I don't believe that fellow amounts to
+much. I think I'll go out now and hunt up somebody who knows something."
+
+"The man's all right," said Dr. Parkman shortly. His own foot was tapping
+the floor nervously. "You ought to have some idea," he added, with what
+he felt to be brutal insistence, "as to whether or not you got anything
+in your eyes."
+
+"Well, I haven't! I don't know anything about it."
+
+But he was breathing hard. His whole manner told of fears and
+possibilities he was not willing to state. He would tell what he thought
+now in just a minute; the doctor knew that.
+
+He began with insisting, elaborately, that he never got things on his
+hands--that was not his way; and even if he did get something on his
+hands, he wouldn't get it in his eyes; even if he did rub his eyes
+sometimes--he didn't admit it--but even if he did, would he be such a
+fool as to rub them when he had something on his hands? But if, in spite
+of all those impossibilities, just admitting for the sake of argument,
+and because Parkman insisted on being ominous, that it was something like
+that, there were two things it might be. It might be--he named the first
+with emphasis, and Dr. Parkman, after a minute's thought, heaved a big
+sigh of unmistakable relief.
+
+"Now you see that couldn't make any vital difference," Karl added, with a
+debonair manner, a thin veneer of aggressiveness.
+
+The doctor was leaning forward in his chair. He was beginning to grow
+fearful of the emphasis put upon this thing which could make no vital
+difference.
+
+Karl stopped as though he had reached the end of his story. But the
+silence was wearing on him. His eyes had a hunted look.
+
+"Why, you can see for yourself," he said--and this was the note of
+appeal--"that that could not make any vital difference."
+
+Dr. Parkman was looking at him narrowly. His own breath was coming hard.
+He saw at last that he would have to ask.
+
+"The--other?" he said, succeeding fairly well in gaining a tone of
+indifference.
+
+"Heavens--how you fellows nag for details! How you drag at a man! Well,
+the other--if you're so anxious to know"--the doctor's heart sank before
+the defiance of that--"the other is"--he looked all about him as one
+hunted, desperate, and then snapped it out and turned away, and instantly
+the room grew frightfully still.
+
+It struck Dr. Parkman like a blow from which one must have time to
+recover. Steeled though he was to the hearing of tragic facts, he was
+helpless for the minute before this. And then, refusing to let it close
+in upon him, it was he who turned recklessly assertive, defiantly
+insistent.
+
+"Any fool would know it's not that," he said, his gruff voice touched
+with bravado.
+
+There was one of those strange changes then. Karl turned and faced him.
+
+"How do you know?" he asked, with a calm not to be thrust aside. "How do
+you know it's not that? You can't be sure," he pursued, and there was
+fairly cunning in forcing his friend upon it, cutting off all escape,
+"but there are just fifty chances out of a hundred that it _is_ that. And
+if it is," with a cold, impersonal sort of smile--"would you give very
+much for my chances of sight?"
+
+"You're talking like a fool!"--but beads of perspiration were on the
+doctor's forehead. And then, the professional man getting himself in
+hand: "You're overworked, Karl. You're nervous. Why I can fix this up for
+you. I'll just--" but before that steady, understanding gaze he could not
+go on.
+
+"Not on me, Parkman--," slowly and very quietly--"not on me. I know the
+ropes. Don't try those little tricks on me. I don't need professional
+coddling, and I don't need professional lies. You see I happen to know
+just a little about the action of germs. We'll do the usual things, of
+course--that's mere scientific decency, but if this thing has really
+gotten in its work--oh I've studied these things a little too long, old
+man, I've watched them too many times, to be able to fool myself now."
+
+"Well you will at least admit," said Parkman--brusque because he was
+afraid to let himself be anything else--"that there are fifty chances
+out of a hundred in your favour?"
+
+Karl nodded; he had leaned back in his chair; he seemed terribly tired.
+
+"Come now, old chap--it isn't like you to surrender before the battle.
+We'll prepare to meet the foe--though I give you my word of honour I
+don't expect the enemy to show up. This isn't in the cards. I _know_ it."
+
+Karl roused a little. There was a bracing note in that vehemence. "Well,
+don't ask me to do any crossing of a bridge before I come to it. I think
+our friend down stairs is thinking of hospitals and nurses and all kinds
+of quirks that would drive me crazy. Tell him I know what I'm about. Tell
+him to let me alone!"
+
+"All right," laughed the doctor, knowing Karl too well to press the
+matter further just then, "though, of course, common-sense demands quiet
+and a dark room."
+
+"Ernestine will darken our rooms at home," said Karl stubbornly.
+
+It was strange how quickly they could turn to the refuge of everyday
+phrases, could hide their innermost selves within their average selves as
+the only shelter which opened to them. There was something Dr. Parkman
+wanted to do for him, and they went into the treatment room. In there
+they spoke about meeting for dinner,--Ernestine had asked the doctor to
+come out. Georgia and her mother were coming too, Karl told him, and the
+interview closed with some light word about not being late for dinner.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+
+"TO THE GREAT UNWHIMPERING!"
+
+"Tell me some good stories about doctors," said Georgia; "I want to use
+them in something I'm going to write."
+
+"Isn't it dreadful?" said Mrs. McCormick, turning to Dr. Parkman, "she
+even interviews people while they eat!" Mrs. McCormick had that manner of
+some mothers of seeming to be constantly disapproving, while not in the
+least concealing her unqualified admiration.
+
+"I'm not interviewing them, Mother. Skillful interviewers never
+interview. They just get people to talk."
+
+"But what is it you're going to write," asked the doctor, "a eulogy or
+denunciation?"
+
+"Both; something characteristic."
+
+"Meaning that something characteristic about doctors would include both
+good and bad?"
+
+"Well, they're pretty human, aren't they?" laughed Georgia.
+
+"And think how grateful we should be," ventured Karl, "for the inference
+of something good."
+
+Dr. Parkman looked over at him with a hearty: "That's right," relieved
+that his friend could enter into things at all.
+
+In the library before they came in, things had gone badly. Mrs. McCormick
+held persistently to the topic of Karl's eyes, putting forth all sorts of
+"home remedies" which would cure them in a night. He had grown nervous
+and irritable under it, and Mrs. Hubers several times had come to the
+rescue with her graciousness. She was worried herself; the doctor could
+see that in the way she looked from her husband to him, scenting
+something not on the surface. He was just beginning to fear the dinner
+was going to be miserable for them all, when Miss McCormick broke the
+tension by asking for stories.
+
+"Tell us what you're going to write, Georgia," said Ernestine, she too
+seizing at it gratefully, "and then our doctors will have a better idea
+of what you want."
+
+"Well, I was talking to Judge Lee the other day, and he told me some good
+stories about lawyers--characteristic stories, you know. So I thought I
+would work up a little series--lawyers, doctors, ministers and so on,
+and see how nearly I could reach the characteristics of the professions
+through the stories I tell of them; not much of an idea, perhaps--but I
+know a man who will buy the stuff."
+
+Ernestine was smiling in a knowing little way. "Do you want to begin with
+something really characteristic?" she asked.
+
+"That's it. Something to strike the nail on the head, first blow."
+
+"Then lead off with the story of Pasteur's forgetting to go to his own
+wedding. There's the most characteristic doctor story I know of."
+
+"That's a direct insult," laughed Karl.
+
+"Why, not at all, Karl," protested Mrs. McCormick, "every one knows you
+were on hand for _your_ wedding."
+
+"Yes, and a good thing he was," declared Ernestine. "I don't think I
+should have been as meek and gentle about it as the bride of Pasteur. I
+fancy I would have said: 'Oh, really now--if it's so much trouble, we'll
+just let it go.'"
+
+"No, Ernestine," said Mrs. McCormick, seriously, after the laugh, "I
+don't believe you would have said that,"--and then they laughed again.
+
+"Well, it's a good story," she insisted; "and characteristic. I believe
+after all that Pasteur was a chemist and not a doctor, but the doctors
+have appropriated him, so the story will be all right."
+
+"If you want to tell some stories about Pasteur," said Karl, "tell about
+his refusing the royal decoration. He told the Emperor that the honour
+and pleasure of doing such work as his was its own reward, and that no
+decoration was needed. That story made a great hit in the scientific
+world."
+
+"But is it characteristic?" asked Georgia, slyly.
+
+"Well," he laughed, "it ought to be."
+
+"Another one of the independent kind," said Parkman, "is on Bilroth. He
+was summoned to appear at a certain hour before the Emperor of Austria.
+Bilroth was with a very sick patient until the eleventh hour and arrived
+a little late in business clothes. The scandalised chamberlain protested,
+telling him he could not go in like that. Whereupon Bilroth blustered
+out: 'I have no time to spare. Tell His Majesty if he wishes to see me,
+I am here. If he wants my dress suit, I will have a boy bring it
+around.'"
+
+"Did he get in?" asked Mrs. McCormick, anxiously.
+
+"I think he did, although undoubtedly Miss McCormick will be too modern
+to say so."
+
+"There was a story I always liked about a Vienna doctor," he continued;
+he was anxious to guide the stories, for Karl had seemed suddenly to sink
+within himself. He understood why--he might have foreseen where this
+would lead. For there were other stories of medical men, stories which
+fitted a little too closely just now; he was especially sorry he had
+mentioned Bilroth. "This shows another side of the doctor," he went on,
+after a minute, "and as you are going to give good as well as bad, this
+may help out on the good side--there's where you will be short. A woman
+came to see this doctor regarding her consumptive son. He told her there
+was nothing he could do for him, adding: 'If you want him to live, you
+must take him to Italy.' The woman broke down and told him she could not
+do that, that she had no money. The doctor sat there thinking a moment,
+and then sent over to the bank and got her a letter of credit covering
+the amount involved. Another doctor, who happened to be near, asked why
+he did that. 'You can't possibly support all your needy patients,' he
+said; 'why did you choose this particular case? Of course,' he added, 'it
+was very good of you.' 'No,' said the doctor, 'it was not good of me.
+There was nothing good about it. But I was guilty of proposing to her
+something I knew she could not do. After opening up that possibility it
+was my obligation to see that she could fulfill it. I suggested what I
+knew to be the impossible; after I suggested it, it was my business to
+make it possible.' Don't you think that a pretty good sense of justice?"
+he asked of Ernestine.
+
+"What might be called an inner squareness," said Georgia, as Ernestine
+responded only with the fine lights the story had brought to her eyes.
+
+Karl did not seem to have heard the story. Ernestine looked toward him
+anxiously.
+
+"Now I'm going to tell a story," she said, with a gaiety thrown out for
+rousing him, "a very fine story;--every one must listen." He looked over
+at her and smiled at that, listening for her story.
+
+"This man's name can't be printed, because he lives in Chicago and it
+might embarrass him,"--Karl and Dr. Parkman exchanged glances with a
+smile. "This is a characteristic story, as it shows a doctor's tyranny.
+There was a boy taken ill at a little town near Chicago. The country
+doctor telephoned up to the boy's father, and the father telephoned the
+family physician who, from the meagre facts, scented appendicitis. I
+don't know how he knew it was bad, but I believe a good doctor is a
+pretty good guesser. At any rate he suspected this was serious, and told
+the father they would have to go down there at once. The father said
+there was no Sunday train. 'Then get a special,' said the doctor. 'We'll
+probably have to bring him up to the hospital to operate, and can't do it
+in the automobile.' The father protested against the special, saying it
+would be very expensive and that he did not think it necessary. The
+doctor said he did think it necessary or he would not have suggested it.
+The father demurred still more and the doctor rang off. Then you called
+up the railroad office, yourself--wasn't that it?" turning to Dr.
+Parkman, who grew red and looked genuinely embarrassed. "Oh dear,"--in
+mock dismay--"now I've mixed it up, haven't I? Well, this doctor--I'm not
+saying anything about who he is--called up the railroad office and calmly
+ordered the special. I must not forget to say that the man who did not
+want to spend the money had an abundance of money to spend. Then he
+called the boy's father and said, 'Be at the station in twenty minutes.
+The special will be waiting. You will have nothing to do but sign the
+check.'"
+
+"Well," said Mrs. McCormick, when Ernestine stopped as though through,
+"would the father pay for it, and did the boy have to have an operation,
+and did he get well?"
+
+"Mother doesn't like this new way of telling a story," said Georgia; "she
+likes to hear the got-married-and-lived-happily-ever-after part."
+
+"I'm sure no one said anything about getting married in this," said Mrs.
+McCormick, serenely.
+
+"But don't you think that a fine doctor story?" Ernestine asked smilingly
+of Dr. Parkman.
+
+"A very bad story to tell. Miss McCormick's general reader will
+say--: 'Oh yes, of course, he was just bound to have an operation.'"
+
+"Georgia,"--this was from the man at the head of the table, and there was
+something in his voice to arrest them all--"if you are in earnest about
+wanting stories of doctors, why don't you tell some of the big ones? Some
+of the stories medical men have a right to be proud of?"
+
+"What are they?" she asked, promptly. "Tell me some of them."
+
+Dr. Parkman's eyes were on his plate. He was handling his fork a little
+nervously.
+
+"If I were going to tell any stories about medical men," Karl went on,
+and in his quiet voice there was still that compelling note, "it seems to
+me I should want to say something about the doctors who died game--just a
+little something about the men who took their medicine and said nothing;
+men with the nerve to face even their own understanding--cut off, you
+see, from the refuge of fooling themselves. Ask Dr. Parkman about the
+surgeons who lost their hands or their lives through infection. Those are
+the stories he knows that are worth while. He's only giving you the
+surface of it, Georgia. Tell him you'd like a little of the real thing.
+Ask him about the men who died slow deaths, looking a fatal future in the
+face from a long way off. He mentioned Bilroth just now, telling a funny
+story about him. There's a better story than that to tell about Bilroth.
+You know he was the man who knew so much about the heart; he probably
+understood the heart better than any other man. And by one of those
+leering tricks of fate, he had heart disease himself. He watched his own
+case and made notes on it, that his profession might profit by his
+destruction. There you have something worth writing about! In his last
+letter home, he said he had ten days to live--and he missed it by just
+one; he lived eleven. If you're going to tell any stories about Bilroth,
+tell that one, Georgia. And then a story or two showing that while many
+men take chances, it's the doctor who takes them most understandingly.
+Why medical science is full of an almost grotesque courage! Don't you
+begin to see how the doctor's been trifling with you, Georgia?"
+
+He paused, but no one felt the impulse to speak. His eyes were hidden by
+the dark glasses he was wearing because of that cold, or whatever it was,
+in his eyes, but his face told the story of an alert mind, a heart
+responsive to the things of which he spoke. Then he went on and talked a
+little, quietly enough, but with a passionateness, a high note of
+understanding, of the men who had had the nerve--eyes open--to face the
+things fate handed them. It was as if he were looking back over the whole
+sweep of the world and picking from many times and many places the men
+whose souls had not flinched to the death. And at the last he said,
+smiling--the kind of smile one meets with a tear--"Let's have a little
+toast." He raised his glass of claret and for a minute looked at it in
+silence. And then he said slowly, his very quiet voice and that little
+smile tempering the words:
+
+"Here's to all those fellows who went down without the banners or
+the trumpets!--To the boys who took the starch out of their own
+tragedies!--To those first class sports who made no fuss about their own
+funerals! Here's to the Great Unwhimpering!"
+
+Dr. Parkman choked a little over his wine, the tightening in Ernestine's
+throat made it hard for her with hers, Georgia's cheeks were burning with
+enthusiasm for the story she saw now she could write, and even Mrs.
+McCormick had no questions as to just what men had died that way. Then it
+was Karl himself who abruptly turned the conversation to the more shallow
+channels of dinner talk.
+
+After that he was not unlike a man who had had a little too much
+champagne. He startled them with the nimbleness of his wit, the light
+play of his fancy. It was as though he had a new vocabulary, a lighter
+one than was commonly his. There was a sort of delicate frolicsomeness in
+his thought.
+
+For a reason unknown to her, it troubled Ernestine. She looked from Karl
+to Dr. Parkman, but the doctor had that impenetrable look of his. What
+was the matter with him? He had talked so freely during the early part of
+the dinner, and now he seemed to have dropped out of it entirely. She
+caught him looking at Karl once; the keen, narrow gaze of physician to
+patient. Then she saw, distinctly, that his face darkened, and after
+that, when he smiled at the things which were being tossed back and forth
+between Karl and Georgia, it was what she called to herself a "made-up
+smile"; and once or twice when Karl said something especially funny, she
+was quite sure she saw Dr. Parkman wince.
+
+A lump rose in Ernestine's throat; Karl seemed to have slipped away from
+her. This was a mood to which she could not respond and it seemed he did
+not expect her to. Almost all of his talk was directed to Georgia, who,
+with her quick wit and inherent high spirits, was enjoying the pace he
+set her. It seemed to resolve itself into a duel of quick, easy play of
+thought and words between those two. But the things they said did not
+make Ernestine laugh. She smiled, as Dr. Parkman did, a "made-up" smile.
+
+She had always enjoyed Karl's humour immensely, but now, though she had
+never seen him as brilliant, something about him pulled at her heart. She
+could not restrain a resentfulness at Georgia for encouraging him. For
+she could not get away from the feeling that all of this was not grounded
+on the thing which was Karl himself. It was like nothing in the world so
+much as the breeziness of a mind which had let itself go. She was glad
+when at last she could rise from the table.
+
+In the library it was as though he were holding on to Georgia, determined
+not to let her out of the mood into which he had brought her. The things
+of which he talked were things having no bearing whatever upon himself.
+If she had not been there, had simply heard of the things said, she
+would not have recognised Karl at all. For the first time since they had
+known one another, Ernestine felt left out,--alone.
+
+Mrs. McCormick said that they must go, but Karl protested. "We're having
+such a good time," he said, "don't think of going."
+
+But Georgia had an engagement. She insisted at last that they must go.
+Dr. Parkman had remained too, although Ernestine was satisfied he was not
+enjoying things.
+
+"Why, what in the world have you done to Karl?" laughed Georgia, pinning
+on her hat. "I haven't had such good fun for months. I had no idea he was
+such a gem of a dinner man."
+
+"I do not think Karl is very well," said Ernestine, a little coolly.
+
+"_Well_? Why, bless you, I never saw him in such exuberant mood."
+
+"Didn't they make the words fly?" laughed Mrs. McCormick. "My dear, you
+and the doctor and I were quite left behind."
+
+"It seemed that way," said Ernestine, trying to keep her chin from
+quivering.
+
+When she returned to the library, Dr. Parkman and Karl were evidently
+just closing a discussion for Karl was saying, heatedly: "Now just let me
+manage things in my own way!"
+
+The doctor seemed reluctant to leave. Ernestine was alone with him for a
+minute in the hall, and she was sure he started to say something once and
+then changed it to something else. But when he did leave, it was with
+merely the conventional goodbye.
+
+She walked slowly back to the library. Karl was sitting in the Morris
+chair, his elbow upon one arm of it, his hand to his forehead. His whole
+bearing had changed; it was as though he had let down. Again it seemed as
+though in the last hour he had been intoxicated, and this the depression
+to follow that kind of exuberance. But he looked up as he heard her, and
+smiled a little, a wan, tired smile. She was beside him in an instant.
+
+"You seemed so happy this afternoon, dear," she said, stroking his hair,
+"and now you seem so tired. Aren't you well, Karl?" she asked, a little
+timidly.
+
+His face then mirrored a dissatisfaction, a sort of resentment.
+
+"I talked like a fool this afternoon!" he said gruffly.
+
+"Why, no, dear, only--not quite like yourself."
+
+"Well, the fact of the matter is"--this after a minute's thought--"I have
+a frightful headache. I suppose it comes from this trouble with my eyes.
+I thought I wasn't going to be able to keep up, and in my efforts to do
+it, I"--he paused and then laughed rather harshly--"overdid it."
+
+He seemed anxious for her reply to that.
+
+"I knew it was something like that," she said simply. Then, after a
+minute: "Is there anything I can do for the head?"
+
+He told her no, but that he believed he would turn the chair around with
+his back to the light.
+
+"And I won't talk, dear," he said gently; "I'll just rest a little."
+
+She helped him with the chair and for a minute sat there on a low seat
+beside him.
+
+"You know, sweetheart," resting her cheek upon his hand, "I don't like
+those dark glasses at all. I'll be so glad when you don't have to wear
+them."
+
+"Why?" he asked, his voice a little muffled.
+
+"Because they shut me out. I always seem closer to you when I can look
+into your eyes.--Oh--does it pain so?" as he drew sharply away.
+
+"That did hurt," he admitted, his voice low. "I--I'd better not talk for
+a little, dear."
+
+So she said if there was nothing she could do for his head, she would
+leave him while she wrote a couple of letters.
+
+For a long time he sat there without moving. It was the exhaustion which
+follows intoxication, for he had indeed intoxicated himself that
+afternoon, and with an idea. It had come about so strangely. After they
+sat down to dinner, he had been on the point a half a dozen times, of
+excusing himself on the plea of a bad headache. Then when they began to
+talk about doctors, those other things had come to him, and it was as
+though the spirit of all those men who had gone down that way entered
+into him, came so close, possessed him so completely, that he could not
+hold back those words about them. A spirit quite beyond his control had
+moved him to that little toast. After that, something--perhaps a spark
+from the nerve of those men of whom he had spoken--brought his mind
+firmly into possession of the feeling that everything was all right. It
+was not that he argued himself out of his fears, but rather that
+something brought the assurance of its being all right, and after that
+there came a number of arguments sustaining the conviction. Just before
+dinner he had gone over to the laboratory and looked at the culture. It
+had not shown anything at all. At the time he accepted that as a matter
+of course--it was not time for it to show anything. But looking back on
+it after this conviction came to him, he took the very fact of its not
+showing anything as proof that there was nothing there to show. His mind
+only grasped one side of it--that it showed nothing at all. Brightening
+under that he began to talk lightly, to joke with Georgia, and talking
+that way seemed to enable him to keep hold of the conviction that
+everything was all right. The more he talked, the more sure he was of it,
+the gayer he felt, the more disposed to let his mind run wild. He was a
+little afraid if he stopped talking, this beautiful conviction of its
+being all right would leave him. So he made Georgia keep at it, Georgia
+was the one could play that sort of game.
+
+As he talked, new arguments came to him. The oculist! At first he had
+thought it a bad thing that the oculist could not tell what was the
+matter. Now he seized upon that as proving there was nothing the matter
+at all. And Dr. Parkman had said, at the last, that it did not amount to
+anything. At the time that had been a mere conventional phrase, but now,
+in his exhilaration, he seized upon it as indisputable truth. But always
+there was the feeling that he must keep on feeling this way, or the
+conviction, and all that it meant, would go. That was why he clung to
+Georgia. Finally he reached the point where he could distinctly remember
+getting the other stuff--the stuff which did not make any difference--on
+his hands. He could fairly see it on his hands, could remember distinctly
+getting it in his eye. And then Georgia had said something about going,
+and he had begged her not to go. But she insisted, and he began to feel
+then that the exhilaration was wearing off, that he was coming back to
+face things; to the doubt, the uncertainty, the suffering. And now that
+he had come back to things as they were, he felt inexpressibly tired.
+
+He went over it again and again, trying to gain something now, not from
+any form of excitement, but from things as they were. Suddenly his face
+brightened. He sat there in deep thought, and then at last he smiled a
+little. Whatever happened must have occurred Friday afternoon. But he had
+never in all his life felt as happy about his work as he did before he
+left the laboratory Friday afternoon. Could a man feel like that, would
+it be in the heart of things to let a man feel that way, if he had
+already entered upon the road of his destruction? It had been more than a
+happiness of the mind; it was a happiness of the soul, and would not a
+man's soul send out some note of warning? And then that same evening when
+he and Ernestine sat before the fire! If already this grim fate had
+entered into their lives, would not their love, would not _her_ love, all
+intuition, deep-seeing, feeling that which it could not understand, have
+felt in that moment of supreme happiness, some token of what was ahead?
+It could not be that the world jeered at men like that. Their love would
+have told them something was wrong.
+
+Ernestine came in just then and he called her to him.
+
+"Liebchen," he said, "I've been thinking about that evening of your
+birthday, about how beautiful it was. Weren't you happy, dear, as we sat
+there before the fire?"
+
+"So happy, Karl," she murmured, warmly glad to have her own Karl again.
+"Everything seemed so beautiful; everything seemed so perfectly right."
+
+He drew her to him with a passion she did not understand. His Ernestine!
+His wife! She who communed with love, whose harmony with the great soul
+of things was perfect--they could not have deceived her like that!
+Ernestine and love dwelt too closely together. She would have received
+some sign.
+
+For a time that calmed and sustained him; he believed in it; it was his
+weapon to use against the doubts and terrors which preyed upon him. But
+the gloom of his soul seemed to thicken with the deepening of the night.
+His heart grew cold with the coming of the shadows. The passing of day
+inspired in him fears not to be reasoned away.
+
+He grew very nervous during the evening and finally said he must go over
+to the laboratory and arrange some things for morning. Ernestine
+protested against it--and if he must go would he not let her go with him?
+But he told her he believed it would be better for his head if he walked
+alone for just a little while. He did not have a headache more than once
+in five years, he assured her, laughing a little, and when he did, it was
+apt to upset him.
+
+When he came back at last--it seemed to her a very long time--she saw,
+watching from the window, that he was walking very slowly, almost as if
+exhausted She could not hold back her alarm at his white, worn face.
+Something in it gripped at her heart.
+
+"Is it worse, dear?" she asked anxiously.
+
+"It's a little bad--just now. I'll go to bed. It will be better then." He
+spoke slowly, as though very tired.
+
+"Won't you take something for it, Karl?" she persisted. "Won't you?"
+
+"I do not know of anything to take that would do any good,
+Ernestine,"--and he could not quite keep the quiver out of those words.
+
+"But other people take things. There _are_ things. Let me go out and get
+you something."
+
+He shook his head.
+
+"Doctors don't take much stock in medicine," he said, with a touch of his
+usual humour.
+
+She wanted to stay with him until he went to sleep. She wanted to put
+cold cloths on his head. It was hard to avoid Ernestine's tenderness.
+
+"It did not show anything," he assured himself, pleadingly, when alone.
+"It only showed that it was going to show in the morning. I knew that. I
+knew all the time I was going to know in the morning. I'll not go to
+pieces. I'll not be a fool about it," he kept repeating.
+
+But a little later Ernestine was sure she heard him groan. She could not
+keep away from that.
+
+"Oh, sweetheart," she murmured, kneeling by his bed, "I can't bear it not
+to help you. Let me do just some little thing," she pleaded.
+
+He put his hand over in hers. "Hold it, dear; if you aren't too tired. I
+don't want to talk,--but hold on to my hand."
+
+His grip grew very tight after a minute. She was sure his head must be
+paining terribly. If only he would take something for it!
+
+In a little while he grew very quiet. Soon she was sure that he was
+asleep. But after she had at last stolen away he turned and buried his
+face in his arms.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+
+THE VERDICT
+
+It was Monday morning now. The hours of that night had been hours of
+torture. Sleep had come once or twice, but sleep meant only the surrender
+of his mind to the horrors which preyed upon it. He could, in some
+measure, exert a mastery when awake, but no man is master of his dreams.
+His dreams put before him all those things his thoughts fought away. In
+his dreams, there was a fearful thing pursuing him, reaching out for him,
+gaining upon him with each step. Or sometimes, it stalked beside him, not
+retreating, not advancing, but waiting, standing there beside him with
+grim, inexorable smile. It was after waking from such dreams that he
+breathed his prayer that this night pass. No matter what be ahead, he
+asked that this night pass away.
+
+After he was up he found himself able to go on in much the usual way.
+When Ernestine came in and asked about his head, he told her it was
+better; when she wanted to know about his eyes, he said they were not any
+better yet, but that that was something which would simply have to run
+its course. She begged him not to go over to the university, but he told
+her it was especially important to go this morning. He added that he
+might not be there very long.
+
+He ate his usual breakfast. A truth that would shake the foundations of
+his life might be waiting for him just ahead, and yet he could make his
+usual laughing plea for a second cup of coffee. Undoubtedly it was so
+with many men; beneath a mail of conventions and pleasantries they lived
+through their fears and sorrows alone.
+
+Something clutched at his heart as he kissed Ernestine good-bye and there
+was a momentary temptation. Could he face it alone, if he had to face it?
+To have her with him! But he put that aside; not alone for her sake, but
+because he felt that after all there were things through which one must
+pass alone. But after he had reached the door, he came back and kissed
+her again. What if he were to go down into a place too deep for his voice
+to reach her?
+
+There was some solace, assurance, in the naturalness of things about him.
+Everything else was just the same; it did not seem that it could be part
+of natural law then for his own life to be entirely overturned.
+
+And the world was so beautiful! It was a buoyant spring morning. There
+was assurance in the song of the birds, in the perfume of flowers and
+trees. The air upon his face was soft and reassuring. This seemed far
+away from the hideous phantoms of the night. Why the world did not _feel_
+like tragedy this morning!
+
+He had a lecture at eight o'clock, and he made up his mind he would give
+it. In the night he had thought of going first of all to the laboratory.
+The truth would be waiting for him there. But it was his business to give
+the lecture and he could not be sure of giving it if he went to the
+laboratory first. A man had no right to let his own affairs interfere
+with his work. Oh yes--by all means, he would give the lecture. In spite
+of his prayer that the uncertainty should end, he reached out for another
+hour of holding it off.
+
+He knew as the hour advanced that he had never done better work in the
+lecture room. He pinned his mind to it with a rigidity which prompted him
+to put the subject as though it were the most vital thing in all the
+world. He threw the whole force of his will to filling his mind with the
+things of which he spoke that he might not yield so much as an inch to
+the things which waited just outside.
+
+He talked until the last minute; in fact, he went so much over his time
+that another class was waiting at the door. He clung to those last
+moments with the desperation of the drowning man to the splintered piece
+of board. After it was over, just as he was yielding the desk to the man
+who followed him, one of his students approached him with a question and
+the thankfulness, the appeal, almost, in the smile with which he received
+him, mystified the student until he stammered out his question
+bewilderedly.
+
+He could wait no longer now. That room belonged to others. The next
+period was his usual hour in the laboratory. It was an hour which on
+Monday morning he could, if he wished, spend alone.
+
+His temples were beating, thundering. His hands were so cold that they
+seemed things apart from him. But his mouth--how parched it was!--was set
+very hard, and his steps, though slow, was firm.
+
+In the outer laboratory, Professor Hastings stopped him, remonstrating
+against his working when he was having trouble with his eyes. He assured
+him, elaborately, that he was taking care of them, that probably he would
+not be in there long.
+
+He opened the door of his laboratory and passed in. He closed it behind
+him, and stood there leaning against it. He was all alone now. There was
+nothing in the room but himself and the truth which was waiting for him.
+
+He put his book down upon the table. He walked over and sat down before
+the culture oven. He must get this over with! He was getting sick. He
+could not stand much more.
+
+With firm, quick hand he wrenched open the doors. He put his hand upon
+what he knew to be the tube. He pulled it out, turned around to the light
+and held it up between him and the window. For one moment he looked
+away;--how parched his mouth was! And then, a mighty will turning his
+eyes upon it, in one long gaze he read the plain, unmistakable,
+unalterable truth. He had never seen a better culture. Science would
+perhaps commit itself no further than to say his eyes had become
+inoculated with the most virulent germ known to pathology. But out beyond
+the efforts which would be made to save him, he read--written large--the
+truth.
+
+He was going blind.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+
+"GOOD LUCK, BEASON!"
+
+Minutes passed and nothing happened. There was no sound of splintering
+glass. The tube did not fall from his hands. Not so much as gasp or groan
+broke the stillness of the laboratory. He did not seem to have moved even
+the muscle of a finger.
+
+He faced it. He understood it. He faced it and understood it as he had no
+other truth in all his life. No merciful, mitigating force caused his
+mind to totter. With fairly cosmic regularity, cosmic inevitability,
+comprehension struck blow after blow.
+
+He was going blind. He had spent his life studying the action of such
+forces as this. _He knew them!_ A man who knew less would have hoped
+more. Some idle dreamer might attempt to push one star closer to another.
+An astronomer would not do that.
+
+He was going blind. He could no more do his work without his eyes than
+the daylight could come without the sun. Fate jeered at him: "Your eyes
+are gone, but your life will remain." It was like saying to the sun: "You
+are not to give any more light, but you are to go on shining just the
+same."
+
+He was going blind. The world which had just opened to him--the world of
+sunsets and forests and mountains and seas gulped to black nothingness!
+
+Blind! Swept under by a trick he would not have believed possible from
+his most careless student! Mastered by the things he had believed he
+controlled! Meeting his life's destruction from the things which were to
+bring his life's triumph! In that moment of understanding's throwing wide
+her gates to torture, fate stood out as the master dramatist. Making him
+do it himself! Working it out of a mere fool's trick!
+
+Blind?--_Blind?_ But his eyes fitted his brain so perfectly it was
+through them all knowledge came to him. They were the world's great
+channel to his mind. It was through his eyes he knew his fellow beings.
+The lifting of an eyebrow, a queer twist to a smile--those things always
+told him more than words. And--but here he staggered. The mind could get
+this, as it had all else, but on this the heart broke. _Ernestine!_--that
+smile--the love lights in her eyes--the glints of her dear, dear
+hair--The tube fell from his hand. His head sank to the table. He was
+buried now under an agony beyond all power to lift.
+
+Whether it was minutes or hours which passed then, he never knew in the
+days which followed. Time is not measured by common reckoning on the hill
+of Calvary.
+
+The thing which brought him from under the blow at last was a blinding
+rage. He wanted to take a revolver and blow his brains out, then and
+there. He--a man supposed to have a mind! _He_--counted a master of those
+very things! And now, what? Manhood, power, _himself_ gone. Stumbling
+through his days! Useless!--a curse to himself and everyone else. Groping
+about in the dark--a thing to be pitied and treated well for pity's sake!
+Cared for--looked after--_helped!_ That beat down the bounds of control.
+He did things then which he never remembered and would not have believed.
+
+It all rushed upon him--the birthday night--the crafty, insidious mockery
+through every bit of it, until everything to which he had held tottered
+about him, and goaded beyond all power to bear there came a slow,
+comprehending, soul-deep curse on the world and all that the world had
+done. And then, out of the darkness, through the blackened, dizzying,
+tottering mass--a voice, a face, a smile, a touch, a kiss, and the curses
+gave way to a sob and things steadied a little. No, not the world and
+everything it had done, for it was a world which held Ernestine, a world
+which had given Ernestine to him for his.
+
+He fought for it then: for his faith in the world, his belief in the
+things of love. It was the fight of his life, the fight for his own soul.
+Come what might in the future, it was this hour which held the decisive
+battle. For if he could not master those things which were surging upon
+him, then the things which made him himself were gone for all time. And
+when sense of the underlying cunning of the blow brought the surrendering
+laugh close to his parched lips it was held back, held under, by that
+ever recurring memory of a touch, a voice, a face. It was Ernestine,
+their love, fighting against the powers of damnation for the rescue of
+his soul.
+
+Even in the battle's heat, he had full grasp of the battle's
+significance, knew that all the future hung upon making it right this
+hour with his own soul. His face grew grey and old, he concentrated days
+of force into minutes, but little by little, through a strength greater
+than that strength with which men conquer worlds, a force greater than
+the force with which the mind's big battles are won, by a force not given
+many since the first of time, he held away, beat back, the black tides
+ready to carry him over into that sea of bitterness from which lost souls
+send out their curses and their jeers and their unmeetable silences.
+
+He tried to see a way. He tried to reach out to something which should
+help him. Standing there amid the wreck of his life, he tried to think,
+even while the ruins were still falling about him, of some plan of
+reconstruction. It was like rebuilding a great city destroyed by fire;
+the brave heart begins before the smoke has cleared away. But that task
+is a simple one. The city destroyed by fire may be rebuilded as before.
+But with him the master builder was gone. Out of those poor, scarred,
+ungeneraled forces which remained, could he hope to bring anything to
+which the world would care to give place?
+
+He could see no way yet. All was chaos. And just then there came a knock
+at the door.
+
+He paid no heed at first. What right had the world to come knocking at
+his door? What could he do for any one now?
+
+The knock was repeated. But he would not go. If it were some student,
+what could he do for him? He could only say: "I can do nothing for you.
+Go to some one else." And should it be one of his fellow professors, come
+to counsel with him, he could only say to him: "I have dropped out. Go on
+without me. I wish you good luck."
+
+That message he had thought to give!--and now--
+
+Again the knock, timidly this time, fearing a too great persistency, but
+reluctant to go away. He would go in just a minute now. There would not
+come another knock. Well, let him go. When all the powers of fate had
+gathered round to mock and jeer was it too much to ask that there be no
+other spectators? Was not a man entitled to one hour alone among the
+ruins of his life?
+
+He who would gain entrance was starting, very slowly, to walk away. He
+listened to him take a few steps, and then suddenly rose and hurried to
+the door. He was not used to turning away his students unanswered.
+
+It was Beason who turned eagerly around at sound of the opening door.
+Beason--of all people--that boy who never in the world would understand!
+
+He was accustomed to reading faces quickly and even through his dark
+glasses his worried eyes read that Beason was in trouble, moved by
+something from the path in which he was wont to go.
+
+"I'm sorry to interrupt you," stammered the boy, as he motioned him to a
+chair.
+
+"Oh--that's all right; I wasn't doing anything, very important.
+Just--finishing up something," he added, glad, when he heard his own
+voice, that it was only Beason.
+
+"I'm in trouble," blurted out Beason, "and I--I wanted to see you."
+
+The man was sitting close to a table, and he rested his elbow upon it,
+and shaded his eyes with his hand.
+
+"Trouble?" his voice was kind, though a little unsteady. "Why, what's the
+trouble?"
+
+"I've got to stop school! I've got to give up my work for a whole year!"
+
+The hand still shaded his darkened eyes. His mouth was twitching a
+little.
+
+"A year, Beason?" he said--any one else would have been struck with the
+note in it--"You say--a year?"
+
+"Yes," said Beason, "a whole year. My father has had some hard luck and
+can't keep me here. I'd try to get work in Chicago, and stay on, but I
+not only have to make my own way, but I must help my mother and sister.
+Next year another deal my father's in will probably straighten things
+out, and then I suppose I can come back."
+
+The man very slowly nodded his head. "I see," he said, his voice coming
+from 'way off somewhere, "I see."
+
+"It's tough!" exclaimed Beason bitterly--"pretty tough!"
+
+Dr. Hubers had turned his chair away from Beason, and with closed eyes
+was facing the light from without. There was a long pause. Beason waited
+patiently, supposing the man to be thinking what to say about so great a
+difficulty.
+
+"As I understand it," he said, turning around at last, "it's like this.
+You are to give up your work at the university for a year--just one short
+little year--and do something else; something not so much in your line,
+perhaps, but something which will be helping those you care for--making
+it easier for some one else. It's to be your privilege, as I understand
+it, to fill a man's place. That's about it, isn't it?"
+
+"But that's not the point! I thought,"--in an injured, almost tearful
+voice--"that you would understand."
+
+"Oh, I do. I see the other point. You hate to stop work for,"--he cleared
+his throat--"for a year."
+
+"A year," said Beason dismally, "is such a long time to lose."
+
+The man had nothing to say to that. His head sank a little. He seemed to
+be thinking.
+
+Finally he came out of his reverie; seemed to come from a long way off.
+"And where are you going, my boy?" he asked kindly. "What are you going
+to do?"
+
+"I'm going clear out West," said Beason gloomily. "Father has something
+for me with a company in the Northwest."
+
+"Out there!"--an eager voice rang out, a voice which rested on a
+smothered sob. "Great heavens, man, you're going out there? Out there to
+the mountains and the forests? Out there where you can see the sun come
+up and go down, can see--can see--" but his voice trailed off to a
+strange silence.
+
+"I never cared much for scenery," said Beason bluntly, "and I care a lot
+for--all this I'm leaving."
+
+"We don't really leave a thing," said the man--his voice was low and
+tired--"when we're coming back to it. The only real leave-takings are the
+final ones."
+
+Beason shifted in his chair. Some of these things were not just what he
+had expected.
+
+"Beason,"--something in his voice now made the boy move a little
+nearer--"I'm sorry for your disappointment, but I wish I could make you
+see how much you have to live for. Get in the habit of looking at the
+sunsets, Beason. Take a good many long looks at the mountains and the
+rivers. It's not unscientific. You know,"--with a little whimsical toss
+of his head--"we only have so many looks to take in this world, and when
+we're about through we'd hate to think they'd all been into microscopes
+and culture ovens. And don't worry too much, Beason, about things running
+into your plans and knocking them over. You know what that wise old Omar
+had to say about it all." He paused, and then quoted, very slowly, each
+word seeming to stand for many things:
+
+
+ And fear not lest Existence closing your
+ Account, and mine, shall know the like no more;
+ The Eternal Saki from that Bowl has pour'd
+ Millions of Bubbles like us, and will pour.
+
+
+"And--will--pour,"--he repeated the three words. And then his head
+drooped, his hands fell laxly at his sides. It seemed it was not of
+Beason he had been thinking as he looked Fate in the face with that taunt
+of the old Persian poet.
+
+But he looked at him after a moment, came back to him. He saw that the
+boy was disappointed. The gloom with which he had come had not lifted
+from his face. That would not do. He was not going to fail his student
+like that.
+
+"Why, look here, Beason," he said in a new tone, all enthusiasm now,
+"maybe you'll shoot a bear. I have a presentiment, Beason, that you will,
+and when you're eighty-five and have your great grandchild on your knee,
+you'll think a great deal more about that bear than you will about the
+year you missed here at school. Now brace up! Hard knocks wake a fellow
+up. You'll come back here and do better work for your year of roughing
+it--take my word for it, you will."
+
+Beason had brightened. "And you think,"--he grew a little red--"that when
+I come back I can have my old place here with you?"
+
+The man drew in his breath, drew it in rather hard; something had taken
+the enthusiasm away.
+
+"I'll do my little part, Beason," he said, exceedingly quietly, "to see
+that you are not overlooked when you come back."
+
+The boy rose to go. "I do feel better," he said clumsily, but with
+heartiness.
+
+He looked around the room. "I hate to leave it. I've had some good times
+here, and I'm--fond of it." The man was leaning against the wall. He did
+not say anything at all.
+
+Then Beason held out his hand. "Good-bye," he said, "and--thank you."
+
+For a minute there was no reply, nothing save the very cold hand given in
+response to Beason's. But that was only for the instant. And then the man
+in him, those things which made him more than a great scientist, things
+more than mind, not even to be comprehended under soul, those fundamental
+things which made him a man, rose up and conquered. He straightened up,
+smiled a little, and then heartily, quite sunnily, came the words: "Take
+a brace, Beason--take a good brace. And good luck to you, boy--good
+luck."
+
+The door had closed. At last he was alone again. Dizzy with the strain he
+staggered to a chair. For a long time he sat there, many emotions
+struggling in his face. He could not see it yet--not quite. It was all
+very new, and uncertain. But 'way out there in the darkness it seemed
+there was perhaps something waiting for him to grasp. He would never give
+that other message, but it might be, if he worked hard enough, and never
+faltered, he could learn to say to the world which had given him this,
+say heartily, quite sunnily: "Good luck to you. Good luck."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+
+DISTANT STRAINS OF TRIUMPH
+
+It worried Ernestine when she saw Dr. Parkman's motor car stopping before
+the house early Tuesday morning. He had been there the afternoon before,
+and then again late in the evening, bringing another doctor with him. He
+said that they simply came to help keep Karl amused; but surely he would
+not be coming again this morning if there were not something more serious
+than she knew. Karl had come home from the university about noon the day
+before, saying that his head was bad and he was going to consider himself
+"all in" for the day. Something about him had frightened her, but he
+insisted that it only showed what a headache could do to a fellow who was
+not accustomed to it. He had remained in his darkened room all day, not
+even turning his face from the wall when she came in to do things for
+him. That worried her, and even the doctor's assurance that he was not
+going to be ill had not sufficed. In fact, she thought Dr. Parkman
+was acting strangely himself.
+
+"I was out in this part of town and thought I'd drop in," he told her, as
+she opened the door for him.
+
+"You're not worried about Karl?" she demanded.
+
+He was hanging up his cap. "You see, I don't want him to get up and go
+over to the university," he said, after a minute's pause, in which she
+thought he had not heard her question. "That wouldn't be good for his
+eyes."
+
+"Well, doctor, what is it about his eyes? Is it just--something that must
+run its course?"
+
+"Oh, yes," he answered, and she was a little hurt by the short way he
+said it. Was it not the most natural thing in the world she should want
+to know? Really, doctors might be a little more satisfactory, she
+thought, as she told him he would find Karl in his room.
+
+She herself went into the library. Down in the next block she saw the
+postman, and thought she would wait for him. She felt all unnerved this
+morning. Things were happening which she did not understand, and then
+she felt so "left out of things." She wanted to do things for Karl; she
+would love to hover over him while he was not well, but he seemed to
+prefer being let alone; and as for Dr. Parkman, there was no sense in his
+adopting so short and professional a manner with her.
+
+But as she stood there by the window, the bright morning sunlight fell
+upon her ruby, and she smiled. She loved her ring so! It was so dear of
+Karl to get it for her. The warm, deep lights in it seemed to symbolise
+their love, and it would always be associated with that first night she
+had worn it, that beautiful hour when they sat together before the fire.
+That had been its baptism in love.
+
+The postman was at the door now, and she hurried to meet him. She was
+much interested in the mail these days, for surely she would hear any
+time now regarding her picture in Paris.
+
+It had come! The topmost letter had a foreign stamp, and she recognised
+the writing of Laplace.
+
+Heart beating very fast, she started up to her studio. She wanted to be
+up there, all by herself, when she read this letter. As she passed Karl's
+door she heard Dr. Parkman telling about having punctured a tire on his
+machine the night before. Of course then everything really was all right,
+or he would not have talked about trivial things like that.
+
+Her fingers fumbled so that she could scarcely open the envelope. And
+then she tried to laugh herself out of that, prepare for disappointment.
+Why, what in the world did she expect?
+
+As she read the letter her face went very white, her fingers trembled
+more and more. Then she had to go back and read it sentence by sentence.
+It was too much to take in all at once.
+
+It was not so much that it had been awarded a medal; not so much that a
+great London collector--Laplace said he was the most discriminating
+collector he knew--wanted to buy it. The overwhelming thing was that the
+critics of Paris treated it as something entitled to their very best
+consideration. The medal and the sale might have come by chance, but
+something about these clippings he had enclosed seemed to stand for
+achievement. They said that "The Hidden Waterfall," by a young American
+artist, was one of the most live and individual things of the exhibition.
+They mentioned things in her work which were poor--but not one of them
+passed her over lightly!
+
+She grew very quiet as she sat there thinking about it. The
+consciousness of it surged through and through her, but she sat quite
+motionless. It seemed too big a thing for mere rejoicing. For what it
+meant Was that the years had not played her false. It meant the
+justification--exaltation--of something her inmost self.
+
+And it meant that the future was hers to take! She leaned forward as if
+looking into the coming years, eyes shining with aspiration, cheeks
+flushed with triumph. She quivered with desire--the desire to express
+what she knew was within her.
+
+It was while lost to her joy and her dreaming that she heard a step upon
+the stairs. She started up--instantly broken from the magic of the
+moment. Perhaps Karl needed her. And then before she reached the door she
+knew that it was Karl himself. How very strange!
+
+"Oh, Karl!"--not able to contain it a minute--"I want to tell you--" and
+then, startled as he stumbled a little, and going down a few steps to
+meet him--"but isn't there too much light up here? Shouldn't you stay
+down in the dark?"
+
+"I don't want to stay down in the dark!"--he said it with a low intensity
+which startled her, and then she laughed.
+
+"I've always heard there was nothing so perverse as a sick man. I'll tell
+you what's the matter with you. You're lonesome. You're tired of getting
+along without me--now aren't you? But we'll go down to the library, and
+down there I'll tell you--oh, _what_ I'll tell you! I thought Dr. Parkman
+was going to stay with you a while,"--as he did not speak--"or I
+shouldn't have come away."
+
+He had seated himself, and was rubbing his head, as though it pained him.
+His eyes were hidden, but his face, in this bright light, made her want
+to cry, it told so plainly of his suffering. He reached out his hand for
+hers. "I didn't want him any longer, liebchen,"--he said it much like a
+little child--"I want--you."
+
+"Of course you do,"--tenderly--"and I'm the one for you to have. But not
+up here. The light is too bright up here."
+
+She pulled at his hand as if to induce him to rise. But he made no
+movement to do so, and he did not seem to have heard what she said.
+"Ernestine," he said, in a low voice--there was something not just
+natural in Karl's voice, a tiredness, a something gone from it--"will you
+do something for me?"
+
+She sat down on the arm of his chair, her arm about him with her warm
+impulsiveness. "Why Karl, dear"--a light kiss upon his hair--"you know I
+would do anything in the world for you."
+
+"I want you to show me your pictures,"--he said it abruptly, shortly. "I
+want to look at them this morning;--all of them."
+
+"But--but Karl," she gasped, rising in her astonishment--"not _now_!"
+
+"Yes--now. You promised. You said you'd do anything in the world for me."
+
+"But not something that will hurt you!"
+
+"It won't hurt me,"--still abruptly, shortly.
+
+"But I know better than that! Why any one knows that eyes in bad
+condition mustn't be used. And looking at pictures--up here in this
+bright light--so needless--so crazy,"--she laughed, though she was
+puzzled and worried.
+
+He was silent, and something in his bearing went to her heart. His head,
+his shoulders, his whole being seemed bowed. It was so far from Karl's
+real self. "Any other time, dear," she said, very gently. "You know I
+would love to do it, but some time when you are better able to look at
+them."
+
+"I'm just as able to look at them now as I will ever be," he said,
+slowly. "Ernestine--please."
+
+"But Karl,"--her voice quivering--"I just can't bear to do a thing that
+will do you harm."
+
+"It won't do me harm. I give you my word of honour it won't make any
+serious difference."
+
+"But Dr. Parkman said--"
+
+"I give you my word of honour," he repeated, a little sharply.
+
+"All right, then," she relented, reluctantly, and darkened the room a
+little.
+
+"Dear,"--sitting on a stool beside him--"you're perfectly sure this
+trouble with your eyes isn't any more serious than you think?"
+
+"Yes," he answered, firmly enough, but something in his voice sounded
+queer, "I'm perfectly sure of that."
+
+"Show me your pictures, Ernestine," laying his hand upon her hair; "I've
+taken a particular notion that I want to see them."
+
+"But first"--carried back to it--"I want to tell you something." She
+laughed, excitedly. "I was coming down to tell you as soon as the doctor
+left. Oh Karl--my picture in Paris--I heard from it this morning, and its
+success has been--tremendous!" She laughed happily over the word and did
+not think why it was Karl's hand gripped her shoulder in that quick,
+tight way. "Shall I read you all about it, dear? And then will you
+promise to cheer right up?"
+
+Still that tight grip upon her shoulder! It hurt a little, but she did
+not mind--it just showed how much Karl cared. The hand was still there
+as she read the letter, and then the clippings which told of the
+rare quality of her work, predicted the great things she was sure to
+do,--sometimes it tightened a little, and sometimes it relaxed, and once,
+with a quick movement he stooped down and turned her ring around, turning
+the stone to the inside of her hand.
+
+When she had finished he was quite still for a long minute. He was
+breathing hard;--Karl was excited about it too! And then he stooped over
+and kissed her forehead, and it startled her to feel that his lips were
+very cold.
+
+"Liebchen," he said, his voice trembling a bit--Karl did care so
+much!--"I am glad." For a minute he was very still again, and then he
+added, seeming to mean a different thing by it--"I am very glad."
+
+"It's gone to my head a little, Karl! Oh I'm perfectly willing to admit
+it has. I don't think I should appreciate the Gloria Victis very much
+myself this morning," she laughed, happily.
+
+She was too absorbed to notice the quick little drawing in of his breath,
+or his silence. "After all, it would be a sorry thing if I didn't
+succeed," she pursued, gayly, "for you stand so for success that we
+couldn't be so close together--could we, dear--if I were a dismal
+failure?"
+
+"You think not?" he asked--and she wondered if he had taken a little
+cold; his voice sounded that way.
+
+"Oh I don't mean that too literally. But I like the idea of our going
+through the same experiences--both succeeding. It seems to me I can
+understand you better this morning than I ever did before. I read a
+little poem last night, and at the time I liked it so much. It is about
+success, or rather about not succeeding. But I'm afraid it wouldn't
+appeal to me very much just now,"--again she laughed, happily, and it was
+well for the happiness that she was not looking at him then.
+
+"What was it?" he asked, as he saw she was going to turn around to him.
+"Say it."
+
+"Part of it was like this":
+
+
+ 'Not one of all the purple host
+ Who took the flag to-day
+ Can tell the definition
+ So clear, of victory,
+
+ As he, defeated, dying,
+ On whose forbidden ear
+ The distant strains of triumph
+ Break agonized and clear.'
+
+
+"Say that last verse again," he said, his voice thick and low;--Karl was
+so different when he was sick!
+
+
+ "As he, defeated, dying,
+ On whose forbidden ear
+ The distant strains of triumph
+ Break agonized and clear."
+
+
+"It is beautiful, isn't it?" she said, as he did not speak.
+
+"Beautiful? I don't know. I suppose it is. I was thinking that quite
+likely it is true."
+
+"But I didn't suppose you would care about it, Karl. I supposed you would
+feel about it as you did about the statue."
+
+"I wonder," he began, slowly, not seeming sure of what he wanted to
+say--"how much the comprehension, the understanding of things, that the
+loss would bring, would make up for the success taken away? I wonder just
+what the defeated fellow could work out of that?"
+
+"But dearie, _is_ it true? Why can failure comprehend success any more
+than success can comprehend failure?"
+
+"It's different," he said, shortly.
+
+"How do you know?" she asked banteringly. "What do you know about it? You
+don't even know how to spell the word failure!"
+
+He started to say something, but stopped, and then he stooped over and
+rested his head for a minute upon her hair. "Tell me about your picture,
+Ernestine," he said, quietly, after that. "Tell me just what it is."
+
+"The Hidden Waterfall? Why you know it, Karl."
+
+"Yes, but I want to hear you talk about it. I want to hear you tell just
+what it means."
+
+"Well, you remember it is a child standing in a beautiful part of the
+woods. It is spring-time, as it seems best it should be when you are
+painting a child in the woods. I tried to make the picture breathe
+spring, and you know one of the writers said that the delicious thing
+about it was the way you got the smell of the woods;--that pleased me.
+Behind the child, visible in the picture, but invisible to the child, is
+a waterfall. The most vital thing in the universe to me was to have that
+waterfall make a sound. I think it does, or the picture wouldn't mean
+anything at all. And then of course the heart of the picture is in the
+child's face--the puzzled surprise, the glad wonder, and then deeper than
+that the response to something which cannot be understood. It might
+have been called 'Wondering,' or even 'Mystery,' but I liked the simpler
+title better. And I like that idea of painting, not just nature, but
+what nature means to man. I want to get at the response--the thing
+awakened--the things given back. Don't you see how that translates the
+spirit there is between nature and man--stands for the oneness?"
+
+He nodded, seeming to be thinking. "I see," he said at last. "I wonder if
+you know all that means?"
+
+"Why, yes, I think I do. My next picture will get at it in a--um--a more
+mature way."
+
+"Tell me about it."
+
+"I don't know that I can, very well. It's hard to put pictures into
+words. I fear it will sound very conventional as I tell it, but of course
+it is what one puts into it that makes for individuality. It is in the
+woods, too. You know, Karl, how I love the woods. And I _know_ them! It
+is not spring now, but middle summer; no suggestion of fall, but mature
+summer. A girl--just about such a girl as I was before you came that day
+and changed everything--had gone into the woods with a couple of books.
+She had been sitting under a tree, reading. But in the picture she is
+standing up very straight, leaning against the tree, the books overturned
+and forgotten at her feet--drawn into the bigger book--see? It is not
+that she has consciously yielded herself. It is not that she is
+consciously doing anything. She is listening--oh how she listens and
+longs! For what, none of us know--she least of all. Perhaps to the far
+off call of life and love speaking through the tender spirit of the
+woods. Oh how I love that girl!--and believe in her--and hope for her. In
+her eyes are the dreams of centuries. And don't you see that it is the
+same idea--the oneness--the openness of nature to the soul open to it?"
+
+"And you are going to make the woods very beautiful?" he asked, after a
+little thought. "More than just the beauty of trees and grass and
+colour?"
+
+"Yes, the beauty that calls to one.
+
+"Then," he said this a little timidly--"might it not be striking to
+have your girl, not really seeing it with the eyes at all? Have her
+eyes--closed, perhaps, but she feeling it, knowing it, in the higher
+sense really seeing it, just the same?"
+
+She thought about that a minute. "N--o, Karl; I think not. It seems to me
+she must be open to it in every way to make it stand for life, in the
+sense I want it to."
+
+"Perhaps," he said, his voice drooping a little. And then, abruptly:
+"Have you done any of that?"
+
+"Oh, just some little sketches."
+
+"Show me the little sketches," he begged. "I want to see them all."
+
+"Oh, but Karl, they wouldn't convey the idea at all. Wait until it is
+farther along."
+
+"No, please show them this morning,"--softly, persuasively.
+
+She was puzzled, and reluctant, but she got them out, and with them other
+things to show him. He asked many questions. In the sketches she was
+going to develop he would know just how she was going to elaborate them.
+He asked her to tell just how they would look when worked out. "I'm a
+sick boy home from school," he said, "and I must be amused." And then he
+looked at her finished pictures; she protested against the intentness
+with which he looked at some of them, insisting they were not worth the
+strain she could see it was on his eyes. "It's queer about finished
+pictures," she laughed; "they're not half so great and satisfying as the
+pictures you are going to do next." It went through her with a sharp pain
+to see Karl hurting his eyes as she knew he was hurting them. She could
+not understand his insistence; it was not like him to be so unreasonable.
+And he looked so terribly--so worn and ill; if only he would go to bed
+and let her take care of him! But he seemed intent on knowing all there
+was to know about the pictures. A strange whim for him to cling to this
+way! As he looked he wanted her to talk about them--tell just what this
+and that meant, insisting upon getting the full significance of it all.
+
+He had never before appreciated her firm grasp. Her work in these
+different stages of evolution gave him a clearer idea of how much she had
+worked and studied, how seriously and intelligently she had set out for
+the mastery of her craft. He had always known that the poetic impulses
+were there, the desire to express, the ideas, the delight in colour, but
+he saw now the other things; this was letting him into the workman's side
+of her work.
+
+He spoke of that, and she laughed. "Yes, this is what they don't see.
+This is what they never know. Poetic impulses don't paint pictures, Karl.
+That's the incentive; the thing that keeps one at it, but you can't do it
+without these tricks of the trade which mean just downright work. I've
+never worked on a picture yet in which I wasn't almost fatally
+handicapped by this thing of not knowing enough. The bigger your idea,
+the more skill, cunning, fairly, you must have to force it into life."
+
+She told him at last that they were through. They had even looked at rude
+little sketches she had made of places they had cared for in Europe.
+Indeed he looked very long at some of those little sketches of places
+they had loved.
+
+"One thing more," he said; "you told me once you had some water colour
+daubs you did when a little girl. Let me look at them. I just want to
+see," he laughed, "how they compare."
+
+And so she got them out, and they looked them over, laughing at them.
+"You've gone a long way," he said, pushing them aside, as if suddenly
+tired.
+
+He leaned back in his chair, his hand above his eyes, as she began
+gathering up the things. "And so here I am," she said, waving her hand to
+include the things about her, "surrounded by the things I've done. Not a
+vast array, and some of it not amounting to much, but it's I, dear. It
+reflects me all through these years."
+
+"I know," he said--"that's just it,"--and at the way he said it she
+looked up quickly. "You're tired, Karl. It's been too much. We'll go down
+stairs now, and rest."
+
+He watched her as she gathered the things together. It seemed he had
+never really known this Ernestine before. Here was indeed the atmosphere
+of work, the joy of working, all the earnestness and enthusiasm of the
+real worker. And then, with masterful effort, he roused himself. He had
+not yet touched what he had come to know.
+
+"I have been thinking," he began, "a little about the psychology of all
+this. You'll think I'm developing a wonderful interest in art, but you
+see I'm laid up and can't do my own work, so I'm entitled to some
+thoughts about art. Now these things you paint grow out of a mental
+image--don't they, dear? The things you paint the mind sees first, so
+that the mental image is the true one, and then you--approximate. I
+should think then that it might help you to _tell_ about pictures. For
+instance, if in painting a picture you had to tell about it to some one
+who did not look at it, wouldn't that make your own mental image more
+clear, and so help make it more real to you?'
+
+"Why, Karl, I never thought of it, but,"--meditatively--"yes, I believe
+it would."
+
+He turned away that she might not see the gladness in his face. "And it
+would be interesting--wouldn't it--to see just how good a conception you
+could give of the picture through words?"
+
+"Yes," she said, interested now--"it would be a way of feeling one's own
+grip on it."
+
+"Of course," he continued, "that couldn't be done except in a case, like
+yours and mine, where people were close together."
+
+"Yes," she assented, "and that in itself would show that they were close
+together."
+
+At that he laid a quick hand upon her hair, caressing it.
+
+"Oh, after all, dear,"--gathering up the last of the sketches--"the
+greatest thing in the world is to do one's work--isn't it?"
+
+"Yes," he said, and his voice was low and tired, "unless the greatest
+thing in the world is to submit to the inevitable."
+
+She looked up quickly. "That doesn't sound like you."
+
+"Doesn't it? Oh, well,"--with a little laugh--"you know a scientist is
+supposed to be capable of a good deal of change in the point of view."
+
+He had risen, and was at the door. "It's been good of you to do all this,
+Ernestine."
+
+"Why it has been a delight to me, dear; if only it hasn't hurt you. But
+it is time now to go down where it is dark."
+
+"Yes," he assented wearily; "it is time now to go down where it is dark."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+
+TELLING ERNESTINE
+
+He had thought to tell her on Tuesday, but after their talk, when he took
+his last look at her pictures--it had tortured both eyes and heart to do
+that, but he knew in the days ahead that he would be unsatisfied with
+having passed it by--he could not bring himself then to do it. He could
+not keep it from her long now, but she was so happy that day in her
+triumph about the picture. He was going to darken all of her days to
+come; he would leave her this one more unclouded. But it was hard for him
+to go through with it. He longed for her so! He must have her help. He
+had asked for the pictures before telling her just because he knew it
+would be unbearable for them both, if she did know. It would need to be
+done in that casual way or not at all. It was strange how he felt he must
+see them. It was his longing to keep close to her. He could not bear the
+thought that his blindness might make him to her as something apart from
+life, even though the dearest thing of all. He must enter into every
+channel of her life.
+
+It was Wednesday now, and he had told her. All the night before he had
+lain awake trying to think of words which would hurt her the least. He
+would put it very tenderly to his poor Ernestine. He would even pretend
+he saw some way ahead, something to do. Ernestine could not bear it
+unless he did that. It was the one thing which remained for him now--to
+make it easy for her.
+
+This was firmly fixed in his mind when he told her that morning he wanted
+to talk to her about something and asked her to come into the library. He
+was sure he had himself well in hand; the words were upon his lips.
+And then when he said: "I want to tell you something, dear--something
+that will hurt you very much. I never wanted to hurt you; I can not help
+it now,"--when he had said that, and she, with quick response to the
+sorrow in his voice, had knelt beside him, her arms about his neck,
+something,--the feel of her arms, the knowing there was some one now to
+help him--swept away the words and his broken-hearted cry had been: "Oh,
+sweetheart--help me! I'm going blind!"
+
+Those first moments took from her something of youth and gladness she
+would never regain. First frozen with horror, then clinging to him
+wildly, sobbing that it could not be so--that Dr. Parkman, some one,
+would do something about it; protesting in a fierce outburst of the love
+which rose within her that it did not matter, that she would make it all
+up to him--their love make it right--in one moment stricken dumb as
+comprehension of it grew upon her, in another wildly defying fate, but
+always clinging to him, holding him so close, trying, though frightened
+and broken, to stand between him and the awful thing as the mother would
+stand between the child and its destroyer, Ernestine left with that
+hour things never to be claimed again. And when at last she began to
+sob--sobbing as he had never heard any one sob before--all his heart was
+roused for her, and he patted her head, kissed her hair, whispering:
+"Little one, little one, don't. We'll bear it together--some way."
+
+During that hour she never loosened her arms about his neck. Deep in his
+despairing heart there glowed one warm spark. Ernestine would cling to
+him as she had never done before. God had not gone out of the world then.
+He had let fate strike a fearful blow, but He had left to the wounded
+heart such love as this.
+
+"Dear," she said at last, her cheek against his, her dear, quivering
+voice trying so hard to be brave, "if you feel like telling me
+everything, I would like to know. I will be quiet. I will be good. But I
+want to bear every bit of it with you. Every bit of it, darling--now, and
+always. That is all I ask--that you let me bear it with you."
+
+The love, the understanding, the longing to help, which were in her voice
+opened that innermost chamber of his heart to her. If she had not won
+this victory now, she could never have done so in the days ahead. This
+hour made possible the other hours of pouring out his heart to her,
+taking her into it all. He told her the story of how it happened, the
+long, hard story which only covered days, but seemed to extend through
+years. He told of those hours of the day and night on the rack of
+uncertainty, of trying with the force of mind and soul to banish that
+thing which had not claimed him then, but stood there beside him, not
+retreating,--waiting. He told her of that lecture hour Monday morning
+when he literally divided himself into two parts, one part of him giving
+the lecture, giving it just as well as he had ever done, the other part
+battling with the phantom which he would vanquish or surrender to within
+an hour. And her only cry was: "You should have told me! You should have
+told me from the first!" And once he answered: "No, dear--no; before I
+knew I did not want to frighten you, and after--oh, Ernestine, believe
+me, sweetheart, I would have shielded you forever, no matter at what cost
+to myself--if only I could have done it!"
+
+At last he had finished the story. He had told it all; of sitting there
+afraid to look, of looking and seeing and comprehending. Oh how he had
+comprehended! It was as if his mind too, his mind trained to grasp
+things, had turned against him, was stabbing him with its relentless
+clearness of vision. He told her of the merciless comprehension with
+which he saw the giving up of his work, the changing of his life, the
+giving up--the eternal giving up. He told her of how it had seemed to
+mean the making over of his soul. For his soul had always cried for
+conquest, for victory, for doing things. How would he turn it now to
+submission, to surrender, to relinquishment? Everything had been tumbling
+about him, he said, when that knock came at the door as the call from
+life, the intrusion of those everyday things which would not let him
+alone, even in an hour like that. And then of the boy with his paltry
+trouble which seemed great--the hurts--the final rising up of the
+instinct to help, despite it all. Then of sitting there alone and seeing
+a faint light in the distance, wondering if, in all new and different
+ways, he could not keep his place in the world.
+
+"Oh help me to do that, sweetheart! Help me to keep right! Don't let me
+lose out with those other things of life!"
+
+Her arms about his neck! He would never forget how she clung to him.
+There was a long silence when their souls reached one another as they
+had never done before. The quivering of her body, her breath upon his
+cheek--they told him all. But after that, the words did come to her;
+broken words struggling to tell of what her love would do to make it
+right; how she would be with him, so close, so unfailing, that the
+darkness would never find him alone.
+
+His arms about her tightened. Thank God--oh yes, a million times thank
+God for Ernestine!
+
+Then he felt her start; there came a sound as though she would say
+something, but choked it back.
+
+"Yes, dear?" he said gently.
+
+"Oh, Karl, I shouldn't ask it. It will hurt you. I shouldn't ask."
+
+"I would rather you did, dear. Ask anything. We are holding nothing from
+one another now."
+
+"I just happened to think--I wanted to know--oh Karl, it wasn't in your
+eye on my birthday, was it? It hadn't happened--wasn't happening--when we
+sat there by the fire, happier than we had ever been before?"
+
+His impulse was to hold that back. Why should he put that upon her, too,
+to hurt her as it had him, shake her faith as it had tried to shake his?
+
+But his moment of silence could not be redeemed. "Karl,"--her voice was
+strangely quiet--"it wasn't, was it?"
+
+He groaned, and she had her answer.
+
+She sprang away from him, standing straight. "Then," she cried--he would
+never have dreamed Ernestine's voice could have sounded like that--"I
+hate the world! I despise it! I will not have anything to do with it! It
+fooled us--cheated us--_made fun of us_! I'll despise it--fight it"--the
+words became incoherent, the sobs grew very wild, she sank to the floor,
+crouching there, her hands clenched, sobbing: "I hate it! Oh how I want
+to pay it back!"
+
+He was long in quieting her, but at last she would listen to him.
+
+"Ernestine," he said, his voice almost stern, "if you start out like that
+you cannot help me. It is to you I look. If you love me, Ernestine, help
+me not to hate the world. If we hate the world, we have given up.
+Sweetheart,"--the voice changed on that word--"even yet--even yet in a
+different way, I want to win. I cannot do it alone. I cannot do it at
+all, if you hate the world. You are to be my eyes, Ernestine. You are to
+see the beautiful things for me. You are to make me love them more than I
+ever did before. You are to be the light--don't you see, sweetheart? And
+you cannot do it, don't you see you cannot, if your own heart is not
+right with the world?"
+
+She did not answer, but she came back to his arms. Her quick breath told
+him how hard she was trying.
+
+ "See your statue up there, liebchen? Remember how you always liked it?
+What you said about it that night? Oh, Ernestine"--crushing her to
+him--"help me to grip tight to my broken sword!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+
+INTO THE DARK
+
+She was with him as he went then into the dark. She did not fail him in
+anything: the hand in his, the little strokes of genius in holding his
+mind, and when they went into the deeps where words were not fitted for
+utterance she did not fail him in those other things. He knew that as she
+clung to him with loving arms, so her spirit reached out to him in the
+demand that it be permitted to sustain.
+
+Through the day and through the night she was with him now. There was no
+time when he could not reach out to find her, no bad dream from which he
+could not awaken to put his hand upon her and know that she was there.
+And when, time after time, bitterness rose up to submerge his soul, he
+could always finally shake it off by thanking God for Ernestine.
+
+For a time the pain in his eyes served as a kindly antidote. The light
+was going out with so intense a suffering as to mitigate the suffering in
+the consciousness of its going. It was the pain in his temples helped him
+hold off the pain of giving up his work. It was not a thing conquered; he
+knew that the deeper pain was waiting for him out there in the darkness
+when the pain of transition should have ceased, leaving only a blank, a
+darkness, no other thing to engage for him any part of his mind. There
+was blessedness in the temporary alleviation brought by the pain that was
+physical. There were many things for him to meet out there. They were
+willing to wait. Now his fighting powers were so well engaged as to take
+something from the reality of a future battlefield.
+
+In many ways it was not as he would have imagined it had he known of such
+a thing. He would have thought of it as one long mood of despair,
+inflamed at times by the passion of rebellion. There were, in truth, many
+moods. In hours when he was quiet they spoke of the things they had seen
+and loved, of Italy and the Alps they spoke often, struggling for the
+words to paint a picture. Sometimes she read a little to him--there would
+be much of that now. Through it all, they seized upon anything which
+would sustain each other. Once when he saw her faltering he told her
+that he thought after awhile he would write a book. He did not call it a
+text-book; did not speak of it as the kind of work to which a man
+sometimes turns when his creative work is done. He had always thought
+that when he was sixty or seventy he might write a few books. He would
+write them now at forty.
+
+And when there came times of its being utterly unbearable, they were
+either silent or trivial.
+
+Bitter questionings filled Ernestine's heart in those days. How was she
+going to watch him suffer and not hate a universe permitting his
+sufferings? How care for a world of beauty he could not see? How watch
+his heart break for the work taken from him and keep her belief in an
+order of things under which that was enacted? How love a world that had
+turned upon him like that? That was what he asked her to do. It seemed to
+her, now, impossible.
+
+With him, as the bearing of the physical pain grew mechanical and the
+other things grew nearer, the worst of it was wondering what he should do
+with the days that were ahead. His spirit would not go with his sight.
+His desire to do was not to be crushed with his ability for doing. What
+then of the empty days to come? How smother the passion for his work? And
+if he did smother it, what remained? While he lived, how deafen himself
+to the call of life? Through what channel could he hope to work out the
+things that were in him? And how remain himself if constantly denying to
+himself the things which were his? It was that tormented him more than
+the relinquishing of the specific thing he had believed would crown the
+work of his life. His fight now would be a fight for clinging to that in
+him which was fundamental. But with what weapon should he fight?
+
+Many times he failed to bear it in conformity with his ideal of bearing
+it. There were hours of not bearing it at all; hours of cursing his fate
+and damning the world. Then it was her touch upon his hand, her tear upon
+his cheek, her broken word which could bring him again into the sphere of
+what he desired to be. His desire to help her in bearing it, his
+thankfulness in having her,--those the factors in his control.
+
+There were two weeks of that: weeks in which two frightened, baffled
+souls fought for strength to accept and power to readjust. Their
+failures, the doubts, the rage, they sought to keep from each other;
+their hard won victories, their fought for courage they gave to the
+uttermost. A failure of one was a failure for one; but a victory of one
+was a victory for two. It was through that method courage succeeded in
+some measure in holding its own against bitter abandonment to despair.
+
+His last looks were at her face. It was that he would take with him into
+the darkness. As a man setting sail for a far country seeks to the last
+the face upon the shore, so his last seeing gaze rested yearningly upon
+the dear face that was to pass forever from his vision. And when the end
+had come, when hungering eyes turned to the face they could not see, and
+he knew with the certainty of encountered reality that he would never
+again see the love lights in her eyes, that others would respond to the
+smile that was gone from him forever, others read in her face the things
+from which he was shut out, when he knew he would never again watch the
+laughter creep into her eyes and the firelight play upon her hair, it
+came upon him as immeasurably beyond all power to endure, and in that
+hour he broke down and in the refuge of her arms gave way to the utter
+anguish of his heart. And she, all of her soul roused in the passion to
+comfort him, whispered hotly, the fierce tenderness of the defending
+mother in her voice:
+
+"You shall not suffer! You shall not! I will make it up to you! I will
+make it right!"
+
+
+
+
+PART TWO
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+
+MARRIAGE AND PAPER BAGS
+
+It was evident that peace did not sit enthroned in Georgia's soul. Her
+movements were not calm and self-contained as one by one she removed the
+paper bags from her typewriter. "So _silly!_"--she sputtered to herself.
+What were the men in this office, anyway? College freshmen? Hanging paper
+bags all over her things every time she stepped out of the office--and
+just because one of her friends happened to be in the paper bag business!
+She'd like to know--as she pounded out her opening sentence with
+vindictiveness--if it wasn't just as good a business as newspaper
+reporting?
+
+It was not a good day for teasing Georgia. She did not like the story she
+had been working on that morning. "Go out to the university," the city
+editor had said, "and get a good first-day-of-school story. Make the
+feature of it the reorganisation of Dr. Hubers' department, and use some
+human interest stuff about his old laboratory--the more of that the
+better."
+
+She hated it! Were they never going to let Karl alone? Was it decent to
+put his own cousin on the story? Georgia's chin quivered as she wrote
+that part about Karl's laboratory. "If my own mother were killed in the
+street," she told herself, trying to blink back the tears, "I suppose
+they'd make _me_ handle it because I know more about her than any one
+else in the office!"
+
+Resentment grew with the turning of each sentence. They knew that Karl
+was her cousin, and almost as close to her as her own brother. She was
+sure they had seen the tear stains on some of that maudlin copy she had
+handed in about him. When she turned in her story she was unable to
+contain herself longer.
+
+"Mr. Lewis," she said, voice quivering, "here is another one of those
+outrageous stories about my cousin, Dr. Hubers. When you ask me to write
+the next one, you may consider it an invitation for my resignation." And
+then, cheeks very red, she went back to her desk and began getting up
+some stuff for her column "Just Dogs," which they had been running on the
+editorial page.
+
+When the city editor was passing her desk about half an hour later he
+stopped and asked, very respectfully and meekly--Georgia was far too
+good to lose: "Miss McCormick, will you see Dr. Parkman some time before
+to-morrow, and ask him about this hospital story? You know, Miss
+McCormick, you're the only reporter in town he'll see."
+
+"Very well," said Georgia, with dignity.
+
+All summer long the papers had been printing stories about Karl. It made
+her loathe newspaper work every time she thought about it. To think of
+their hacking at him like that--and he so quiet and dignified and brave!
+A picture printed the Sunday before, of Karl fumbling his way around, had
+made her more furious than she had ever been in all her life.
+
+She turned just in time to see a grinning reporter writing on the
+bulletin board: "Miss G. McCormick--Human interest story about the inner
+life of a paper bag."
+
+Sometimes it might have brought a smile, usually it would have fired her
+to the desired rage, but to-day it contributed to her tearfulness. "Oh
+they needn't worry," she murmured, bending her head over a drawer, and
+tossing things about furiously, "there's no getting married for me! This
+office has settled that!"
+
+The city editor seemed to take special delight in sending her out on
+every story which would "give married life a black eye." When the father
+left the little children destitute, when the mother ran away with the
+other man, or the jealous wife shot the other woman, Georgia was always
+right on the spot because they said she was so clever at that sort of
+thing. "Oh it makes one just _crazy_ to get married," she had said,
+witheringly, to Joe one night.
+
+Why did he want to marry her, anyway? When she _told_ him she didn't want
+to--wasn't that enough? Was it respectful to treat her refusal as though
+it were a subtle kind of joke? Various nice boys had wanted at various
+times to marry her, and she had always explained to them that it was
+impossible, and sent them, more or less cheerfully, on their various
+ways. But this man who made paper bags, this jolly, good-natured,
+seemingly easy-going fellow, who held that the most important thing in
+the world was for her, Georgia, to have a good time, only seemed much
+amused at the idea of her not having time to marry him, and when she told
+him, with just as much conviction as she had ever told any of the others,
+that he had better begin looking around for some one else, he would
+reply, "All right--sure," and would straightway ask where she wished to
+go for dinner that night or whether she preferred an automobile ride to a
+spin in his new motor boat. Now what was one to do with a man like that?
+A man who laughed at refusals and mellowed with each passing snub!
+
+"Telephone, Miss McCormick,"--the boy sang out from the booth. The
+opening "Hello" was very short, but the voice changed oddly on the "Oh,
+Ernestine." Her whole face softened. It was another Georgia now. "Why
+certainly--I'll get them for you; you know I love to do things for you
+down town, but my dear--what in the world do you want with flower seeds
+this time of year?"--"Oh--I see; planted in the fall--but the flowers
+that bloom in the spring--tra la."
+
+They chatted for a little while and after Georgia had hung up the
+receiver she sat there looking straight into the phone--her face as
+dreamy as Georgia's freckled face well could be. "By Jinks,"--she was
+saying to herself--"it _can_ be like that!" It was a most opportune time
+for the paper bag man to telephone. He wondered why her voice was so
+soft, and why there was not the usual plea about being too busy when he
+asked her to meet him at the little Japanese place for a cup of tea. "And
+it's positively heroic of Joe to drink that tea," she smiled to herself,
+as she wrestled with her shirt waist sleeves and her jacket.
+
+But out on the street she grew stern with herself. "Now don't go and do
+any fool thing," she admonished. "Don't jump at conclusions. You aren't
+Ernestine, and he isn't Karl. He's Joseph Tank--of all abominable names!
+And he makes paper bags--of all ridiculous things! Tank's Paper Bags!"
+she guessed _not!_ Suppose in some rash moment she did marry him. People
+would say: "What business is your husband in?" And she would choke down
+her rage and reply--"Why--why he makes paper bags!"
+
+He was sitting there waiting for her, smiling. He was awfully good about
+waiting for her, and about smiling. It was nice to sit down in this cool,
+restful place and be looked after. He had a book which she had spoken
+about the week before, and he had a little pin, a dear little thing with
+a dog's head on it which he had seen in a window and thought should
+belong to her. And he was on track of the finest collie in the United
+States. After all, he thought it would be better for her to have a collie
+than a bulldog. She was losing ground! She was being very nice to him,
+and she had firmly intended telling him once for all that she could never
+marry a man whose name was Tank, and who contributed to the atrocities of
+fate by making paper bags. And then she had a beautiful thought. Perhaps
+he would be willing to go away somewhere and live it down. He might go to
+Boston and go into the book publishing business. Surely publishing books
+in Boston would go a long way toward removing the stigma of having made
+paper bags in Chicago. And meanwhile, sighing contentedly, and fastening
+on her new pin, as long as she was here she might as well forget about
+things and enjoy herself.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+
+FACTORY-MADE OPTIMISM
+
+The usual congested conditions existed in Dr. Parkman's waiting room when
+Georgia arrived a little after five. An attendant who knew her, and who
+had great respect for any girl Dr. Parkman would see on non-professional
+business, took her into the inner of inners, where, comfortably
+installed, sat Professor Hastings.
+
+"Glad to have you join me," he said; "I feel like an imposter, getting in
+ahead of these people."
+
+"Oh, I'm used to side doors," laughed Georgia.
+
+They chatted about how it had begun to rain, how easy it was for it to
+rain in Chicago, and in a few minutes the doctor came in.
+
+He nodded to them, almost staggered to a chair, sank into it, and leaning
+back, said nothing at all.
+
+"Why, doctor," gasped Georgia, after a minute, "can't you _take_
+something? Why you're simply all in!"
+
+He roused up then. "I am--a--little fagged. Fearful day!"
+
+"Well, for heaven's sake get up and take off that wet coat!
+Here,"--rising to help him--"I've always heard that doctors had
+absolutely no sense. Sitting around in a wet coat!"
+
+"I wonder," he said, after another minute of resting, "why any man ever
+takes it into his head he wants to be a doctor?"
+
+"And all day long," she laughed, "I've been wondering why any girl ever
+takes it into her head she wants to be a newspaper reporter."
+
+"Speaking of the pleasant features of my business," she went on, "I may
+as well spring this first as last. Here am I, a more or less sensible
+young woman, come to ask you, a man whose time is worth--well, let's say
+a thousand dollars a second--what you intend doing about those hospital
+interns getting drunk last night!"
+
+"My dear Miss Georgia,"--brushing out his hand in a characteristic way
+which seemed to be sweeping things aside--"go back to your paper and say
+that for all I care every intern in Chicago may get drunk every night in
+the week."
+
+"_Bully_ story!"
+
+"And furthermore, every paper in Chicago may go to the devil, and every
+hospital may go trailing along for company. Oh Lord--I'm tired."
+
+He looked it. It seemed to Georgia she had never understood what
+tiredness meant before.
+
+"Such a hard day?" Professor Hastings asked.
+
+"Oh--just one of the days when everything goes wrong. Rotten
+business--anyway. Eternally patching things up. I'd like to be a--well, a
+bridge builder for awhile, and see how it felt to get good stuff to start
+with."
+
+"And now, to round out your day pleasantly," laughed Professor Hastings,
+"I've come to tell you about a boy out there at the university who is in
+very bad need of patching up."
+
+"What about him?" and it was interesting to see that some of the
+tiredness seemed to fall from him as he straightened up to listen.
+
+Georgia rose to go, but he told her to stay, he might feel more in the
+mood for drunken interns by and by.
+
+He arranged with Professor Hastings about the student; and it was when
+the older man was about to leave that he asked, a little hesitatingly,
+about Dr. Hubers. "I have been away all summer," he told the doctor, "and
+have not seen him yet."
+
+Georgia was watching Dr. Parkman. His face just then told many things.
+
+"You will find him--quite natural," he answered, in a constrained voice.
+
+"One hardly sees how that can be possible," said the professor sadly.
+
+"Oh, his pleasantness and naturalness will not deceive you much. Your
+eyes can take in a few things, and then his voice--gives him away a
+little. But he won't have anything to say about--the change."
+
+He shook his head. "I'm afraid that's so much the worse."
+
+"Perhaps, but--"
+
+"Karl never was one to get much satisfaction out of telling his
+troubles," Georgia finished for him.
+
+"Hastings," said the doctor, jerkily, and he seemed almost like one
+speaking against his will--"what do you make out of it? Don't you think
+it--pretty wasteful?"
+
+"Yes--wasteful!" he went on, in response to the inquiring look. "I mean
+just that. There are a lot of people," he spoke passionately now, "who
+seem to think there is some sort of great design in the world. What in
+heaven's name would they say about this? Do you see anything high and
+fine and harmonious about it?"
+
+That last with a sneer, and he stopped with an ugly laugh. "They make me
+tired--those people who have so much to say about the world being so
+right and lovely. They might travel with me on my rounds for a day or
+two. One day would finish a good deal of this factory-made optimism."
+
+"Does Dr. Hubers feel--as you do?" Hastings asked, not quite concealing
+the anxiety in the question.
+
+"How in God's name could he feel any other way?--though it's hard making
+him out,"--turning to Georgia, who nodded understandingly. "Just when
+he's ready to let himself go he'll pull himself together and say it's so
+nice to have plenty of time for reading, that Ernestine has been reading
+a lot of great things to him this summer, and he believes now he is
+really going to begin to get an education. But does _that_ make you feel
+any better about it? God!--I was out there the other day, and when I saw
+the grey hairs in his head, the lines this summer has put in his face,
+when I saw he was digging his finger nails down into his hands to keep
+himself together while he talked to me about turning his cancer work over
+to some other man--I tell you it went just a little beyond my power to
+endure, and I turned in then and there and expressed my opinion of a God
+who would permit such things to happen! And then what did he do? Got a
+little white around the lips for a minute, looked for just a second as
+though he were going to turn in with me, and then he smiled a little and
+said in a quiet, rather humorous way that made me feel about ten years
+old: 'Oh, leave God out of it, Parkman. I don't think he had much of a
+hand in this piece of work. If you must damn something, damn my own
+carelessness.'"
+
+"He said that? He can see it like that?"--there was no mistaking the
+approval in Professor Hastings' eager voice.
+
+"Huh!"--the doctor was feeling too deeply to be conscious of the rudeness
+in the scoff. "So you figure it out like that--do you? And you get
+some satisfaction out of that way of looking at it? The scheme of things
+is very fine, but he must pay the penalty of his own oversight,
+weakness--carelessness--whatever you choose to call it. Well, I don't
+think I care much about a system that fixes its penalties in that
+particular way. When I see men every day who violate every natural law
+and don't pay any heavier penalty than an inconvenience, when I see
+useless pieces of flesh and bone slapping nature in the face and not
+getting more than a mild little slap in return, and then when I see the
+biggest, most useful man I have ever known paying as a penalty his life's
+work--oh Lord--that's rot! I have some hymn singing ancestors myself, and
+they left me a tendency to want to believe in something or other, so I
+had fine notions about the economy of nature--poetry of science. But this
+makes rather a joke of that, too--don't you think?" He paused, and
+Georgia could see the hot beating in his temples and his throat. And then
+he added, with a quiet more unanswerable than the passion had been: "So
+the beautiful thing about having no gods at all is that you're so fixed
+you have no gods to lose."
+
+The telephone rang then, and there was a sharp fire of questions ending
+with, "Yes--I'll see her before nine to-night." He hung up the receiver
+and sat there a minute in deep thought, seeming to concentrate his whole
+being upon this patient now commanding him. And then he turned to
+Hastings with something about the boy out at the university, telling him
+at the last not to worry about the financial end of it, that he liked to
+do things for students who amounted to something.
+
+Professor Hastings was smiling a little as he walked down the corridor.
+He wondered why Dr. Parkman cared anything about slaving for so senseless
+and unsatisfying a world.
+
+He loved the doctor for his inconsistencies.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+
+A BLIND MAN'S TWILIGHT
+
+"Ready?"
+
+"All ready."
+
+"Then, one--two--three--we're off!" A laugh and a scamper and one grand
+rush down to the back fence. "You go too fast," she laughed, gasping for
+breath.
+
+"And you're not steady. You jerk."
+
+"But this was a fine straight row. I can steer it just right when you
+don't push too hard. Now--back."
+
+They always had a great deal of fun cutting the grass. Ernestine used to
+wish the grass had to be cut every day.
+
+But Karl did not seem to be enjoying it as much as usual to-day. "I'm
+going to desert you," he said, after a little while.
+
+"Lazy man!"
+
+"Yes--lazy good for nothing man--leaves all the work for his wife."
+
+She looked at him sharply. His voice sounded very tired. "I'll be in in
+just a few minutes, dear," she said.
+
+She did not go with him. She knew Karl liked to find his own way just as
+much as he could. She understood far too well to do any unnecessary
+"helping."
+
+But she stood there and looked after him--watched him with deep pain in
+her eyes. He stooped a little, and of course he walked slowly, and
+uncertainly. All that happy spring and assurance had gone from his walk.
+
+She walked down to the rear of the yard, stood there leaning against the
+back fence. She had dropped more than one tear over that back fence.
+
+She too had lost something during the summer. Struggle had sapped up some
+of the wine of youth. Her face was thinner, but that was not the vital
+difference. The real change lay in the determination with which she had
+learned to set her jaw, the defiance with which she held her head, and
+the wistfulness, the pleading, with which her eyes seemed to be looking
+out into the future. The combination of things about her was a strange
+one.
+
+She looked to the west; the sun was low, the clouds very beautiful. For
+the minute she seemed to relax:--beauty always rested her. And then, with
+a sharp closing of her eyes, a bitter little shake of her head, she
+turned away. She could not look at beautiful things now without the
+consciousness that Karl could not see them.
+
+They always sat together in the library that hour before dinner--"our
+hour" they had come to call it. She wondered, with a hot rush of tears,
+if they did not care for it because it marked the close of another day.
+She turned to the house, kicking the newly cut grass with her foot,
+walking slowly. She was waiting for something--fighting for it. Karl
+needed her to-night, needed courage and cheer.
+
+She came so quietly, or else he was so deep in thought, that he did not
+hear her. For a minute she stood there in the library door.
+
+He was sitting in his Morris chair, his hands upon the arms of it, his
+head leaning back. His eyes were closed, one could not tell in that
+moment that he was blind, but it was more than the dimness, the blankness
+in his eyes, more than scarred eyeballs, made for the change in Karl's
+face. He and life did not dwell together as they had once; a freedom and
+a gladness and a sureness had gone. The loss of those things meant
+the loss of something fundamentally Karl. And the sadness--and the
+longing--and the marks of struggle which the light of courage could not
+hide!
+
+She choked a little, and he heard her, and held out his hand, with a
+smile. It was the smile which came closest to bridging the change. He was
+very close to being Karl when he smiled at her like that.
+
+She sat down on the low seat beside him, as was their fashion. "Lazy
+man,"--brushing his hand tenderly with her lips--"wouldn't help his wife
+cut the grass!"
+
+She wondered, as they sat there in silence, how many lovers had loved
+that hour. It seemed mellowed with the dreams it had held from the first
+of time. Ever since the world was very young, children of love had crept
+into the twilight hour and claimed it as their own. Perhaps the lovers of
+to-day love it because unto it has been committed the soul of all love's
+yesterdays.
+
+She and Karl had loved it from the very first: in those days when they
+were upon the sea, those supreme days of uncomprehended happiness. They
+sat in the twilight then and watched day withdraw and night spread itself
+over the waters. They loved the mystery of it, for it was one with the
+mystery of their love; they loved it for reasons to be told only in great
+silences, knowing unreasoningly, that they were most close together then.
+
+And after that they came to love the twilight for the things it
+bequeathed them. "Don't you remember," he would say, "we left it just as
+the sun was setting. Aren't you glad we can remember it so?" It was as if
+their love could take unto itself most readily that which came to it in
+the mystic hour of closing day.
+
+And when they returned, during that first year of joy in their work, they
+loved the hour of transition as an hour of rest. Their day's work was
+done; in the evening they would study or read or in some way occupy
+themselves, but because they had worked all through the day they could
+rest for a short time in the twilight. And they would tell of what they
+had done; of what they hoped to do; if there had been discouragements
+they would tell of them, and with the telling they would draw away. In
+the light of closing day the future's picture was unblurred. They loved
+their hour then as true workers love it; it was good to sink with the day
+to the half lights of rest and peace.
+
+Now it was all different, but they clung to their love for it still.
+Through the heart of the day, during those hours which from his early
+boyhood had been to him working hours, this removal from life brought to
+the man a poignancy of realisation which beat with undiminishing force
+against the wall of his endurance. It was when he finished his breakfast
+and the day's work would naturally begin that it came home to him the
+hardest. They would go into the library, and Ernestine would read to
+him--how she delved into the whole storehouse of literature for things to
+hold him best--and how great her joy when she found something to make the
+day pass a little less hard than was the day's wont! He would listen to
+her, loving her voice, and trying to bring his mind to what she read, but
+all the while his thoughts reaching out to what he would be doing if his
+life as worker were not blotted out. The call of his work tormented him
+all through the day, and the twilight was the time most bearable because
+it was an hour which had never been filled with the things of his work.
+In that short hour he sometimes, in slight measure found, if not peace,
+cessation from struggle. "This is what I would be doing now," he told
+himself, and with that, when the day had not drawn too heavily upon him,
+he could rest a little, perhaps, in some rare moments, almost forget.
+
+But to-night the spell of the hour was passing him by. Ernestine saw that
+in the restless way his hand moved away from hers, the nervous little
+cough, the fretted shaking of the head. She understood why it was; the
+fall quarter at the university opened that day. It would have marked the
+beginning of his new year's work. Very quietly she wiped the tears from
+her cheek. She tried never to let Karl know that they were there.
+
+His head had fallen to his hand, and she moved closer to him and laid her
+face against the sleeve of his coat. She did not say anything, she did
+not touch him, or wind her arm, as she loved to do, about his neck. She
+had come to understand so well, and perhaps the greatest triumph of her
+love was in knowing when to say nothing at all.
+
+At last he raised his head. His voice, like his face, was tensely drawn.
+"Ernestine, don't bother to stay. Probably you want to be seeing about
+dinner, and I--I don't feel like talking."
+
+That too she understood. She only laid her hand for the moment upon his
+hair. Then: "Call me, dear, if you want me," and she slipped away, and in
+a little nook under the stairs sat looking out into their strange future
+with wondering, beseeching eyes--seeking passionately better resources, a
+more sustaining strength.
+
+Left alone the man sat very still, his hands holding tight the arm of the
+chair. The tide of despair was coming in, was washing over the sands of
+resignation, beating against the rocks of courage. Many times before it
+had come in, but there was something overwhelming in its volume to-night.
+It beat hard against the rocks. Was it within its power to loosen and
+carry them away? Carry them out with itself to be gone for all time?
+
+He rose and felt his way to the window. He pressed his hot forehead
+against the pane. Outside was the dying light of day, but the glare of
+noonday, the quiet light of evening, the black of the night, were all one
+to him now. Was it going to be so with his mind, his spirit? Would all
+that other light, light of the mind and soul, be gulped into this black
+monotone, this nothingness?
+
+He had heard of the beautiful spirit of the blind, of the mastery of fate
+achieved, the things they were able, in spite of it all, to gain from
+life. Ernestine had read him some of that; he had been glad to hear it,
+but it had not moved him much. Most of those people had been blind for a
+long time. He too, in the course of ten or twenty years, when the best of
+his life was gone, would become accustomed to groping his way about,
+reading from those books, and having other people tell him how things
+looked. But so long as he remained himself at all how accustom himself to
+doing without his work? In the records and stories of the blind, it
+seemed if they had a work it was something which they could continue. But
+with him, the work which made his life was gone.
+
+Over there was the university. It had been a busy day at the
+university--old faces and new faces, all the exuberance of a new start,
+the enthusiasm for a clean slate--students anxious to make some
+particular class--how well he knew it all! Who was in his laboratory? Who
+working with his old things? To whom was coming the joy he had thought
+would be his? What man of all the world's men would achieve the things he
+had believed would crown his own life?
+
+Some day Ernestine would read it to him. He had made her promise to do
+that, if it came. He would see it all--just how it had been worked out,
+and the momentary joy of the revelation would sweep him back into it and
+he would forget how completely it was a thing apart from him. And then
+Ernestine would ask him if he wanted his chair a little higher or lower,
+or whether she should shut the window; and he would pick up one of his
+embossed books and try to read something, and he would know, as he had
+never known before, how the great world which did things was going right
+on without him.
+
+There were a few little petitions he sent out every once in a while. "I
+want to remain a man! I want to keep my nerve. I don't want to whine. I
+don't want to get sorry for myself. For God's sake help me to be a good
+fellow--a half way decent sort of chap!"
+
+And he had not tried in vain. His success, as to exteriors, had been
+good. Mrs. McCormick said it was indeed surprising how well one could get
+along without one's sight.
+
+But within himself he had not gone far. Ernestine knew something of
+that--though he had tried his best with Ernestine, and Parkman knew, for
+Parkman had a way of knowing everything.
+
+And yet they did not know it all. The waking up in the night and knowing
+it would not be any more light in the morning! Hearing the clock strike
+four or five, and thinking that in a little while he would be getting up
+and going to work, only to remember he would never be going to work in
+that old way again! The waking in the morning feeling like his old self,
+strength within him, his mind beseeching him to start in! No man had ever
+suffered with the craving for strong drink as he suffered for the work
+taken from him.
+
+He had, by what grit he could summon, gone along for five months. But
+ahead were five years, ten years, thirty years, perhaps, and what of
+them? Each day was a struggle; the living of each day a triumph. Through
+thousands of days should it be the same?
+
+It was the future which took hold of him then--smothered him. He went
+down before the vision of those unlived days, the grim vision of those
+relentless, inevitable days, standing there waiting to be lived. It was
+desolation. The surrender of a strong man who had tried to the uttermost.
+
+Whether it was because he upset a chair, whether she heard him groan, or
+whether she just knew in that way of hers that it was time for her to be
+there, he did not know. But he felt her at the door, and held out
+beseeching arms.
+
+He crushed her to him very close. He wanted to bring her more close than
+she had ever come before. For he needed her as he had not needed her
+until this hour. "Ernestine! Ernestine!"--the sob in his voice was not to
+be denied--"What am I going to do?"
+
+"Karl,"--after her moment of passionate silence--"tell me this. Doesn't
+it get any better? One bit easier?"
+
+"No!"--that would have no denying; and then: "Oh but I'm the brute to
+talk to you like this, after you've been"--again he swept her into his
+arms--"what you have been to me this summer."
+
+She guided him to a chair and knelt beside him. She held his hand for a
+minute as the mother holds the hand of the child in pain. And then she
+began, her voice tender, but quietly determined: "Karl dear--let's be
+honest. Let's not do so much pretending with each other. For just this
+once let's look it right in the face. I want to understand--oh how I want
+to! What's the very worst of it, dear? Is it--the work?"
+
+"Yes!"--the word leaped out as though let loose from a long bondage.
+"Ernestine--no one but a man can quite see that. What _is_ a man without
+a man's work? What is there for him to do but sit around in namby-pamby
+fashion and be fussed over and coddled and cheered up! Lord"--he threw
+away her hands and turned his face from her--"I'd rather be dead!"
+
+Her utter silence recalled him to a sense of how she must be hurt. Could
+he have looked into her eyes just then he would never have ceased to
+regret those words.
+
+There was contrition in his face as he turned back. He reached out for
+her hands--those faithful, loving hands he had thrust away. For just a
+minute she did not give them, but that was only for the minute--so quick
+was she to forgive, so eager to understand.
+
+"Forget that, sweetheart--quick. I didn't know what I was saying. Why,
+liebchen--it's only you makes it bearable at all. If I did not have you I
+should--choose the other way."
+
+"Karl!"--in an instant clinging to him wildly--"you hadn't thought--you
+couldn't think--"
+
+"Oh, sweetheart--you've misunderstood. Now, dearie--don't--don't make me
+feel I've made you cry. All I meant, Ernestine, was that without you it
+would be so utterly unbearable."
+
+He stroked her hair until she was quiet. "Why, liebchen--do you think
+anything under heaven could be so bad that I should want to leave you?"
+
+"I should hope I had not failed--quite that completely," she whispered
+brokenly.
+
+"Failed?--_You?_ Come up here a little closer and I'll try to tell you
+just how far you've come from having failed."
+
+At first he could tell her best in the passionate kiss, the gentle
+stroking of her face, the tenderness with which his hands rested upon her
+eyes. And then words added a little. "Everything, liebchen; everything of
+joy and comfort and beauty and light--light, sweetheart--everything of
+light and hope and consolation that comes to me now is through you.
+You've done more than I would have believed in human power. You have
+actually made me forget, and can you fancy how supreme a thing it is to
+make a man forget that he is blind? You've put the beautiful things
+before me in their most beautiful way. Do you suppose that alone, or with
+any one else, I could see any beauty in anything? You've made me laugh!
+How did you ever do that--you wonderful little Ernestine? And,
+sweetheart, you've helped me with my self-respect. You've saved me in a
+thousand little ways from the humiliations of being blind. Why you
+actually must have some idea of what it is like yourself!"
+
+"I have, Karl. I have imagined and thought about it and tried to--well,
+just trained myself, until I believe I do know something of what it is
+like."
+
+"You love me!" he murmured, carried with that from despair to exultation.
+
+"But if you could only know how _much._"
+
+"I do know. I do know, dear. I wish that all the world--I'd hate to have
+them know, for it's just ours--but for the sake of faltering faith they
+ought to know what you've been to me this summer."
+
+"Then, Karl,"--this after one of their precious silences--"I want to ask
+you something. It is hard to say it just right, but I'll try. You know
+that I love you--that we have one of those supreme loves which come at
+rare times--perhaps for the sake of what you call faltering faith. But,
+Karl--this will sound hard--but after all, doesn't it fail? Fail of being
+supreme? Doesn't it fail if it is not--satisfying? I don't mean that it
+should make up to one for such a thing as being blind, but if in spite of
+love like ours life seems unbearable to you without your work--why then,
+dear, doesn't it fail?"
+
+He was long in answering, and then he only said, slowly: "I see. I see
+how you have reasoned it out. I wonder if I can make you understand?"
+
+"Ernestine,"--the old enthusiasm had kindled in his face with the
+summoning of the thoughts--"no painter or sculptor ever loved his work
+more than I loved mine. And I had that same kind of joy in it; that
+delight in it as a beautiful thing to achieve. That may seem strange to
+you. But the working out of something I was able to do brought me the
+same delight the working out of a picture brings to you. Dear, it was my
+very soul. And so, instead of there being two forces in my life after I
+had you, it was just the one big thing. You made me bigger and because I
+was bigger I wanted to do bigger things. Don't you see that?"
+
+She held his hand a little more closely in response. He knew that she
+understood.
+
+"Don't think I have given up--why of course I haven't. I will adjust
+myself in a little time--do what there is for me to do. I am going to see
+immediately about a secretary, a stenographer--no, Ernestine, I don't
+want you to do that. It's merely routine work, and I want you to do your
+own work. One of us must do the work it was intended we should. I could
+have gone on with some lecture work at the university, but I--this year I
+couldn't quite do that. I'll be more used to handling myself by next
+year, have myself better in hand in every way. I couldn't quite stand the
+smell from the laboratory just now. This year I shall work on those
+books I've told you about; just class-room books--I never could write
+anything that would be literature--I'm not built for that; but these
+things will be useful, I've felt the need of something of the sort in my
+own classes. I'll always make a living, Ernestine--don't you ever worry
+about that! And the world won't know--why should we let it know we're not
+satisfied? But I can't hide from you that it is the other, the creative
+work--the--oh, I tell you, Ernestine, the fellows up there in the far
+north don't have all the fun! It may be great to push one's way through
+icebergs--but I know something that is greater than that! They say there
+is a joy in standing where no man ever stood before, and I can see that,
+for I too have stood where no man ever stood before! But I'm ahead of
+them--mine's the greater joy--for I knew that my territory was worth
+something--that the world would follow where I had led!"--The old force,
+fire, joyous enthusiasm had bounded into his voice. But it died away, and
+it was with a settling to sadness he said, "You see, little girl, if
+there was a wonderful picture you had conceived--your masterpiece,
+something you had reason to feel would stand as one of the world's great
+pictures, if you had begun on it, were in the heat of it, and then had to
+give it up, it would not quite satisfy you, would it, dear, to settle
+down and write some textbooks on art?"
+
+"Karl--it's I who have been blind! I tried so hard to understand--but
+I--oh, Karl--can't we do something? Can't we _do_ something about it?"
+
+"I was selfish to tell you--but it is good to have you understand."
+
+But she had not let go that idea of something being done. "Karl,
+_couldn't_ you go on with it? Isn't there some way? Can't we _find_ a
+way?"
+
+He shook his head. "I have thought of it by the hour--gone over every
+side of it. But work like that takes a man's whole being. It takes more
+than mere eyes and hands--more than just mind. You must have the spirit
+right for it--all things must work together. It's not the sort of work to
+do under a handicap. God knows I'd start in if I could see my way--but
+neither the world nor myself would have anything to gain. Some one would
+have to be eyes for me--and so much more than eyes. It's all in how
+things look, dear--their appearance tells the story. An assistant could
+tell me what _he_ saw--but he could not bring to me what would be
+conveyed if I saw it myself. All that was individual in my work would be
+gone. Minds do not work together like that. I should be too much in the
+dark," he concluded, sadly.
+
+For a long time her head was on his shoulder. She was giving him of that
+silent sympathy which came with an eternal freshness from her heart.
+
+"We'll manage pretty well," he went on, in a lighter tone which did not
+quite deceive her. "Our life is not going to be one long spell of moping.
+It's time now for the year's work to begin. You must get at your
+pictures, and I'll get at the books. Oh, I'll get interested in them,
+all right--and oh, liebchen"--with a tenderness which swept all else
+aside--"I have _you!_"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+
+HER VISION
+
+Some of the university people came over that night to see Karl. Ernestine
+was glad of that, for she had been dreading the evening. Their talk of
+the afternoon had made it more clear and more hard than it had ever been
+before.
+
+Her mothering instinct had been supreme that summer. It had dominated her
+so completely as to blur slightly the clearness of her intellectual
+vision. To be doing things for him, making him as comfortable as
+possible, to find occupation for him as one does for the convalescent, to
+hover about him, showering him with manifestations of her love and
+woman's protectiveness--it had stirred the mother in her, and in the
+depths of her sorrow there had been a sublime joy.
+
+Now she could not see her way ahead. It was her constant doing things to
+"make it up to him" had made the summer bearable at all. With the
+clearing of her vision her sustaining power seemed taken from her.
+
+"And how has it gone with you this summer?" Professor Hastings asked,
+holding both of her hands for a minute in fatherly fashion as she met him
+in the hall.
+
+He scarcely heard her reply, for the thought came to him: "If he could
+only see her now!"
+
+It was her pride and her wistfulness, her courage and her appeal, the
+union of defiance and tenderness which held one strangely in the face of
+Ernestine. She was as the figure of love standing there wounded but
+unvanquished before the blows of fate.
+
+"Professor Hastings has come to see you, Karl," she said, as they entered
+the library; and as he rose she laid her hand very gently upon his arm, a
+touch which seemed more like an unconscious little movement of affection
+than an assistance.
+
+"Good for Hastings!" said Karl, with genuine heartiness.
+
+"And have a good many thought waves from me come to you this summer?" he
+asked, shaking Karl's hand with a warmth which conveyed the things he
+left unsaid.
+
+"Yes, they've come," Karl replied. "Oh, we knew our friends were with
+us,"--a little hastily. "But we've had a pretty good summer--haven't we,
+Ernestine?" turning his face to her.
+
+"In many ways it has been a delightful summer,"--her voice now had that
+blending of defiance and appeal, and as she looked at her husband and
+smiled it flashed through Professor Hastings' mind--"He knew she did
+that!"
+
+"You see,"--after they were seated--"I was really very uneducated. Isn't
+it surprising, Hastings, how much some of us don't know? Now what do you
+know about the history of art? Could you pass a sophomore examination in
+it? Well, I couldn't until Ernestine began coaching me up this summer.
+Now I'm quite fit to appear before women's clubs as a lecturer on art.
+Literature, too, I'm getting on with; I'm getting acquainted with all the
+Swedes and the Irishmen and the Poles who ever put pen to paper."
+
+"Karl," she protested--"Swedes and Irishmen and Poles!"
+
+"Isn't that what they are?" he demanded, innocently.
+
+"Well they're not exactly a lot of immigrants."
+
+"Yes they are; immigrants into the domain of my--shall I say
+intellectuality?"
+
+They laughed a little, and there was a moment's pause. "Tell me about
+school," he said, abruptly, his voice all changed.
+
+Professor Hastings felt the censorship of Ernestine's eyes upon him as he
+talked; they travelled with a frightened eagerness from the face of the
+man who spoke to him who listened. He could see them deepen as they
+touched dangerous ground, and he wondered how she could go on living with
+that intensity of feeling.
+
+"Beason is back," he said, in telling of the returnings and the changes.
+
+"Beason!"--Dr. Hubers' voice rang out charged with a significance the
+older man could not understand. "You say Beason is back?"--the voice then
+was as if something had broken.
+
+"Yes, it was unexpected. He had thought he would be West this year, but
+things turned out better than he had expected."
+
+"Yes, he told me--in April, that he would be West this year." As he sank
+back, his face in repose, Professor Hastings saw something of what the
+summer had done.
+
+Ernestine's eyes were upon him, a little reproachful, and beseeching. But
+before he could think of anything redeeming to say two other university
+men had been admitted.
+
+It was hard at first. Dr. Hubers did not rouse himself to more than the
+merest conventionality, and all the rest of it was left to his wife, who,
+however, rose to the situation with a superb graciousness. Finally they
+touched a topic which roused Karl. His mind reached out to it with his
+old eagerness and virility, and they were soon in the heat of one of
+those discussions which wage when men of active mind and kindred interest
+are brought together.
+
+Ernestine sat for a little time listening to them, grateful for the
+relaxation of the tension, more grateful still for this touch of Karl's
+old-time self. But following upon that the very consciousness that they
+saw the real Karl so seldom now brought added pain. What would the future
+hold? What could it hold? Must he not go farther and farther from this
+real self as he adjusted himself more and more fully to the new order of
+things?
+
+Watching him then, as he talked and listened, she could appreciate anew
+what Karl's eyes had meant to his personality. It almost broke her heart
+to see him lean forward and look in that half-eager, half-fretted way
+toward the man who was speaking, as though his blindness were a barrier
+between their minds, a barrier he instinctively tried to beat down.
+
+She wanted to get away, and she felt they would get along better now
+without her. So she left them, laughingly, to their cigars and their
+discussion.
+
+She wandered about the house listlessly, mechanically doing a few things
+here and there. And then, still aimlessly, she went up to her studio. She
+sat down on the floor, leaning her head against the couch. Just then she
+looked like a very tired, disappointed child.
+
+And it was with something of a child's simplicity she saw things
+then. Was it right to treat Karl that way--Karl who was so great and
+good--could do such big things? Was it fair or right that Karl should be
+unhappy--Karl who did so much for other people, and who had all this
+sweetness and tenderness with the greatness?
+
+What could she do for Karl? She loved him enough to lay down her life for
+him. Then was there not some way she could use her life to make things
+better for him?
+
+And so she sat there, her thoughts brooding over him, too tired for
+anything but very simple thinking, too worn for passion, but filled with
+the sadness of a grieving child. It was after she had been looking
+straight at it for a long time that she realised she Was looking at a
+picture on her easel.
+
+Dimly, uncaringly, she knew what the picture was. But she was thinking
+only of Karl. It was a long time before her mind really followed her eyes
+to the picture.
+
+It was a sketch of a woman's face. She remembered what a splendid model
+she had had for it. And then suddenly her mind went full upon it; her
+whole bearing changed; she leaned forward with a passionate intentness.
+
+Unsatisfied longing, disappointed motherhood, deep, deep things stirred
+only to be denied! Yes, the model had been a good one, but it was from
+her own soul the life things in that face had come.
+
+It brought them all back now--all those things she had put into it. A
+great wave of passion and yearning swept through her;--new questionings,
+sorrow touched with resentment, longing mingled with defiance. Why could
+not this have gone right with them? What it would have meant to Karl in
+these days!--sustained, comforted, kept strong.
+
+The pain of those first days was translated by the deeper understanding
+of these. Her eyes were very deep, about her mouth an infinite yearning
+as she asked some of those questions for which God had no answer.
+
+But there was something about the picture she did not like. She looked at
+it with a growing dissatisfaction. And then she saw what it was. The
+woman was sinking to melancholy. She bowed under the hand of fate. She
+did not know why, this night of all others, she should resent that. What
+did she want? What could she expect?
+
+She stirred restlessly under the dissatisfaction. It seemed too much
+fate's triumph to leave it like this. Not this surrender, but a little of
+the Spartan, a touch of sternness, a little defiance in the hunger, an
+understanding--that was it!--a submission in which there was the dignity
+of understanding. Ah--here it was!--a knowing that thousands had endured
+and must endure, but as an echo from the Stoics--"Well?"
+
+The idea fascinated her--swept through her with a strange, wild
+passion. She scarcely knew what she was doing, when, after a long
+time of looking at the picture, she began getting out her things. Her
+face had wholly changed. She too had now the understanding, stern,
+all-comprehending--"Well?"--for fate.
+
+She could work! That was the thing remained. She would not bow down under
+it and submit. She would work! She would erect something to stand for
+their love--something so great, so universal and eternal that it would
+make up for all taken away. She would crystallise their lives into
+something so big and supreme that Karl himself, feeling, understanding
+that which he could not see, would come at the end into all the
+satisfaction of the victor! Could she do greater things for him than
+that?
+
+She glowed under the idea. It filled, thrilled, intoxicated her. And she
+could do it! As she saw that a few master strokes were visualising her
+idea she came into greater consciousness of her power than she had ever
+had before.
+
+It all flowed into big new impetus for her work. A year before she had
+wanted to work because she was so happy, now with a fierce passion she
+turned to her work as the thing to make it right for their lives. Out of
+all this she would rise to so great an understanding, so supreme a power
+that they too could hurl their defiant--"Well?"--at the fate which had
+believed them conquered. In the glow and the passion and the exaltation
+of it she felt that nothing in the world, no trick of fate, no onslaught
+of God or man, could keep her from the work that was hers. She had a
+vision of hosts of men, all powers of fate, marching against her, and
+she, unfaltering, serene, confident, just doing her work! It was one of
+the perfect moments of the divine intoxication.
+
+It was in the very glow of it that the strange thing happened. The lights
+from her ruby, caught in a shaft of light, blurred her vision for an
+instant, and in that same instant, as if borne with the lights of the
+stone, there penetrated her glowing, exuberant mood--quick, piercing,
+like an arrow shot in with strong, true hand--"He loves his work just
+like this. You know now. You understand."
+
+Her mood fell away like a pricked bubble. The divine glow, that
+passionate throbbing of conscious power, made way for the comprehension
+of that thing shot in upon her like a shaft.--"He loves his work just
+like this. You know now. You understand."
+
+She had been standing, and she sank to a chair. Like all great changes it
+sapped up strength. The blood had cooled too suddenly, and she was weak
+and trembling--but, oh, how she understood! He himself did not understand
+it as she understood it now.
+
+Pushing upon him--dominating him--clamouring--crowding for outlet when
+outlet had been closed--gathering, growing, and unable to find its valve
+of escape--why it would crowd upon him--kill him! Beat it down? But it
+was the deathless in him. With human strength put out a fire that was
+divine?
+
+She covered her face with her hands to shut it out. But she could not
+shut it out; it was there--a thing to be faced, not evaded--a thing which
+would grow, not draw away. And she loved him so! In this moment of
+perfect understanding, this divine camaraderie of the soul--knowing that
+they were touched with the same touch--drew from a common fount--she felt
+within her a love for him, an understanding, which all of the centuries
+behind her, the eternity out of which she had come--had gone to make.
+
+And then, grim, stern, she put her intellect upon it. She went over
+everything he had said that afternoon. Each thought of it opened up new
+channels, and she followed them all to their uttermost. And in that
+getting of it in hand there was more than insight, knowledge, conviction.
+There was a complete sensing of the truth, a comprehending of things just
+without the pale of reason.
+
+Her face pale, her eyes looking into that far distance, she sat there for
+more than an hour, oblivious for the first time since his blindness to
+the thought that Karl might be needing her, lost to all conventional
+instincts as hostess. Hard and fast the thoughts beat upon her, and then
+at last in the wake of those thoughts, out beyond, there was born a great
+light. It staggered her at first; it seemed a light too great for human
+mind to bear. But time passed, and the light burned on, steady, fixed,
+not to pass away. And in that momentous hour which words are quite
+powerless to record, something was buried, and something born.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+
+LOVE CHALLENGES FATE
+
+The doctor hung up the receiver slowly and with meditation. And when he
+turned from the telephone his thoughts did not leave the channel to which
+it had directed them. What was it Mrs. Hubers wanted? Why was she coming
+to the office at four that afternoon? Something in her voice made him
+wonder.
+
+He had offered to go out, but she preferred coming to the office.
+Evidently then she wished to see him alone; and she had specified that
+she come when he could give her the most time. Then there was something
+to talk over. He had asked for Karl, and she answered, cheerfully, that
+he was well. "And you?" he pursued, and she had laughed with that--an
+underlying significance in that laugh perplexed him as he recalled it,
+and had answered buoyantly: "I? Oh, splendid!"
+
+It did not leave his mind all day; he thought about it a great deal as he
+drove his car from place to place. It even came to him in the operating
+room, and it was not usual for anything to intrude there.
+
+He reached the office a few minutes ahead of the hour, but she was
+waiting for him. She rose as she saw him at the door and took an eager
+step forward. Her cheeks were flushed, her eyes very bright, and her
+smile, as she held out her hand, had that same quality as her voice of
+the morning.
+
+She was so far removed from usual things that she resorted to no
+conventional pleasantries after they had entered the doctor's inner
+office, and she waited for him to attend to a few little things before
+giving her his attention. He knew by the way her eyes followed him about
+that she was eager to begin, and while there was a little timidity about
+her it seemed just a timidity of manner, of things exterior, while back
+of that he felt the force of her poise.
+
+He had never seen her so beautiful. She was wearing a brown velvet suit,
+a golden brown like some of the glints in her hair and some of the lights
+in her eyes. Her eyes, too, held that something which puzzled him. It was
+a windy day, and her hair was a little disarranged, which made her look
+very young, and her veil was thrown back from her face just right to make
+a frame for it. Why could not all women manage those big veils the way
+some women did, he wondered.
+
+He sat down in the chair before his desk, and swung it around facing her.
+Then he waited for her to speak.
+
+That little timidity was upon her for the second, but she broke through
+it, seeming to shake it off with a little shake of her head. "Dr.
+Parkman," she said--her voice was low and well controlled--"I have come
+to you because I want you to help me."
+
+He liked that. Very few people came out with the truth at the start that
+way.
+
+"I wonder if you know," she went on, looking at him with a very sweet
+seriousness, "that Karl is very unhappy?"
+
+His face showed that that was unexpected. "Why, yes," he assented, "I
+know that his heart has not been as philosophical as some of his words;
+but"--gently--"what can you expect?"
+
+She did not answer that, but pondered something a minute. "Dr. Parkman,"
+she began abruptly, "just why do you think it is Karl cannot go on with
+his work? I do not mean his lectures, but his own work in the laboratory,
+the research?"
+
+Again he showed that she was surprising him. "Why surely you understand
+that. It is self-evident, is it not? He cannot do his laboratory work
+because he has lost his eyes."
+
+"Eyes--yes. But the eye is only an instrument; he has not lost his
+brain." The flush in her cheeks deepened. Her eyes met his in challenge.
+Her voice on that had been very firm.
+
+He was quick to read beyond the words. "You are asking, intending to ask,
+why he could not go on, working through some assistant?"
+
+"I want to know just what is your idea of why he cannot. All the things
+of mind and temperament--things which make him Karl--are there as before.
+Are we not letting a very little thing hold us back?"--there was much
+repression now, as though she must hold herself in check, and wait.
+
+"I've thought about it too!" he exclaimed. "Heaven knows I've tried to
+see it that way. But my conclusion has always been like Karl's: the
+handicap would be too great."
+
+"Why?" she asked calmly.
+
+"Why? Why--because," he replied, almost impatiently, and then laughed a
+little at his woman's reason.
+
+"I'll tell you why!"--her eyes deepening. "I'll tell you the secret of
+your conclusion. You concluded he could not go on with his work just
+because no assistant could be in close enough touch with Karl to make
+clear the things he saw."
+
+He thought a minute. Then, "That's about it," he answered briefly.
+
+"You concluded that two men's brains could not work together in close
+enough harmony for one man's eyes to fit the other man's brain."
+
+"You put it very clearly," he assented.
+
+She paused, as though to be very sure of herself here. "Then, doctor,
+looking a little farther into it, one sees something else. If there were
+some one close enough to Karl to bring to his brain, through some other
+medium than eyes, the things the eyes would naturally carry; if there
+were some one close enough to make things just as plain as though
+Karl were seeing them himself, then"--her voice gathered in
+intensity--"despite the loss of his eyes, he could go right on with his
+work."
+
+"Um--well, yes, if such an impossible thing were possible."
+
+"But it _is_ possible! Oh if I can only make you see this now! Doctor,
+_don't_ you see it? _I_ am closer to him than any one in the world! _I_
+am the one to take up his work!"
+
+He pushed back his chair and sat staring at her speechlessly.
+
+"Dr. Parkman," she began--and it seemed now that he had never known her
+at all before--"most of the biggest things ever proposed in this world
+have sounded very ridiculous to the people who first heard of them. The
+unprecedented has usually been called the impossible. Now I ask you to do
+just one thing. Don't hold my idea at arm's length as an impossibility.
+Look it straight in the face without prejudice. Who would do more for
+Karl than any one else on earth? Who is closer to him than any one else
+in the world? Who can make him see without seeing?--yet, know without
+knowing? Dr. Parkman,"--voice eager, eyes very tender--"is there any
+question in your mind as to who can come closest to Karl?"
+
+"But--but--" he gasped.
+
+"I know," she hastened--"much to talk over; so many things to overcome.
+But won't you be very fair to me and look at it first as a whole? The men
+in Karl's laboratory know more about science than I do. But they do not
+know as much about Karl. They have the science and I have the spirit. I
+can get the science but they could never get the spirit. After all, isn't
+there some meaning in that old phrase 'a labour of love'? Doctor"--her
+smile made it so much clearer than her words--"did you ever hear of
+knowledge and skill working a miracle? Do you know anything save love
+which can do the impossible?"
+
+He did not speak at once. He did not find it easy to answer words like
+that. "But, my dear Mrs. Hubers," he finally began--"you are simply
+assuming--"
+
+"Yes,"--and the tenderness leaped suddenly to passion and the passion
+intensified to sternness--"I am simply assuming that it _can_ be
+done, and through obstacle and argument, from now until the end of my
+life, I am going on assuming that very thing, and furthermore, Dr.
+Parkman,"--relaxing a little and smiling at him under standingly--"just
+as soon as the light has fully dawned upon you, _you_ are going to
+begin assuming that, and you are the very man--oh, I know--to keep on
+assuming it in the face of all the obstacles which the University of
+Chicago--yes, and all creation--may succeed in piling up. There is one
+thing on which you and I are going to stand very firmly together. That
+thing,"--with the deep quiet of finality--"is that Karl shall go on with
+his work."
+
+Dr. Parkman had never been handled that way before; perhaps it was its
+newness which fascinated him; at any rate he seemed unable to say the
+things he felt he should be saying.
+
+"Dr. Parkman, the only weak people in this world are the people who sit
+down and say that things are impossible. The only big people are the
+people who stand up and declare in the face of whatsoever comes that
+nothing is impossible. For Karl there is some excuse; the shock has been
+too great--his blindness has shut him in. But you and I are out in the
+light of day, doctor, and I say that you and I have been weaklings long
+enough."
+
+He had never been called a weakling before--he had never thought to be
+called a weakling, but the strangeness of that was less strange than
+something in her eyes, her voice, her spirit, which seemed drawing him
+on.
+
+"Karl has lost his eyes. Has he lost his brain--any of those things which
+make him Karl? All that has been taken away is the channel of
+communication. I am not presuming to be his brain. All I ask is to carry
+things to the brain. Why, doctor,--I'm ashamed, _mortified_--that we
+hadn't thought of it before!"
+
+"But--how?" he finally asked, weakly enough.
+
+"I will go into Karl's laboratory and learn how to work--all that part of
+it I want you to arrange for me. After all, I have a good foundation. I
+think I told you about my father, and how hard he tried to make a
+scientist of me? And it was queer about my laboratory work. It was always
+easy for me. I could _see_ it, all right--enough my father's child for
+that, but you see my working enthusiasm and ambition were given to other
+things. Now I'll make things within me join forces, for I _will_ love the
+work now, because of what it can do for Karl. I need to be trained how to
+work, how to observe, and above all else learn to tell exactly what I
+see. I shall strive to become a perfectly constructed instrument--that's
+all. And I _will_ be better than the usual laboratory assistant, for not
+having any ideas of my own I will not intrude my individuality upon
+Karl--to blur his vision. I shall not try to deduce--and mislead him with
+my wrong conclusions. I shall simply _see_. A man who knew more about it
+might not be able to separate what he saw from what he thought--and that
+would be standing between Karl and the facts."
+
+He was looking at her strangely. "And your own work--what would be
+happening to it, if you were to do--this?"
+
+"I have given my own work up," she said, and she said it so simply that
+it might have seemed a very simply matter.
+
+"You can't do that," he met her, sharply.
+
+"Yes,"--slowly--"I can. I love it, but I love Karl more. If I have my
+work he cannot have his, and Karl has been deprived of his eyes--he is
+giving up the sunlight--the stars--the face he loves--many things. I
+thought it all out last night, and the very simple justice of it is that
+Karl is the one to have his work."
+
+She was dwelling upon it,--a wonderful tenderness lighting her face; for
+the minute she had forgotten him.
+
+Then suddenly she came sharply back to the practical, brought herself
+ruthlessly back to it, as if fearing it was her practicality he would
+question. "Besides, Karl's work is the more important. Nobody is going to
+die for a water colour or an oil painting; people are dying every day for
+the things Karl can give. But, doctor,"--far too feminine not to press
+the advantage--"if I can do _that_, don't you think you can afford to
+break through your conservatism and--you _will_, doctor, won't you?"
+
+But Dr. Parkman had wheeled his chair about so that she could not see his
+face. His eyes had grown a little dim.
+
+"You see, doctor,"--gently,--"what I am going to give to it? Not only the
+things any one else could give, but all my love for Karl, and added to
+that all those things within myself which have heretofore been poured
+into my own work. I _can_ paint, doctor, you and I know that, and I think
+you know something of how I love it. Something inside of me has always
+been given to it--a great big something for which there is no name. Now I
+am going to just force all that into a new channel, and don't you see how
+much there will be to give? And in practical ways too I can make my own
+work count. I know how to use my hands--and there isn't a laboratory
+assistant in the whole University of Chicago knows as much about colour
+as I do!"--she smiled like a pleased child.
+
+He looked at her then--a long look. He had forgotten the moisture in his
+eyes,--he did not mind. And it was many years since any one had seen upon
+Dr. Parkman's face the look which Ernestine saw there now.
+
+"Isn't it strange, doctor," she went on, after a pause, "how we think we
+understand, and then suddenly awake to find we have not been
+understanding at all? Karl and I had a long talk yesterday, and in that
+talk he seemed able to let me right into it all. All summer long I did my
+best, but I see now I had not been understanding. And understanding as I
+do now--caring as I care--do you think I can sit quietly by and see Karl
+make himself over to fit this miserable situation? Do you think I am
+going to help him adjust himself to giving up the great thing in him?
+No--he is not going to accept it! I tell you Karl is to be Karl--he is to
+do Karl's work--and find Karl's place. Why I tell you, Dr. Parkman, I
+will not _have_ it any other way!"
+
+It was a passionate tyranny of the spirit over which caution of mind
+seemed unable to prevail. His reason warned him--I cannot see how this
+and this and that are to be done, but the soul in her voice seemed
+drawing him to a light out beyond the darkness.
+
+"Doctor,"--her eyes glowing with a tender pride--"think of it! Think of
+Karl doing his work in spite of his blindness! Won't it stand as one of
+the greatest things in the whole history of science?"
+
+He nodded, the light of enthusiasm growing more steady in his own eye.
+
+"But I have not finished telling you. After our talk yesterday it seemed
+to me I could not go on at all. I didn't know what to do. In the evening
+I was up in my studio--"--she paused, striving to formulate it,--"No, I
+see I can't tell it, but suddenly things came to me, and, doctor, I
+understand it now better than Karl understands it himself."
+
+He felt the things which she did not say; indeed through it all it was
+the unspoken drew him most irresistibly.
+
+"I'll not try to tell you how it all worked itself out, but I saw things
+very clearly then, and all the facts and all the reason and all the logic
+in the world could not make me believe I did not see the truth. My idea
+of taking it up myself, of my being the one to bring Karl back to his
+work, seemed to come to me like some great divine light. I suppose," she
+concluded, simply, "that it was what you would call a moment of
+inspiration."
+
+She leaned her head back as though very tired, but smiling a little. He
+did not speak; he had too much the understanding heart to intrude upon
+the things shining from her face.
+
+"I could do good work, doctor. I've always felt it, and I have done just
+enough to justify me in knowing it. I don't believe any one ever loved
+his work more than I love mine, and last night when I saw things so
+clearly I saw how the longing for it would come to me--oh, I know. Don't
+think I do not know. But something will sustain me; something will keep
+my courage high, and that something is the look there will be on Karl's
+face when I tell him what I have done. You see we will not tell Karl at
+first; we will keep it a great secret. He will know I am working hard,
+but will think it is my own work. If we told him now he would say it was
+impossible. His blindness, the helplessness that goes with it, has taken
+away some of his confidence, and he would say it could not be done. But
+what will he say,"--she laughed, almost gleefully--"when he finds I have
+gone ahead and made myself ready for him? When _you_ tell him I can do
+it--and the laboratory men tell him so? He will try it then, just out of
+gratitude to me. Oh, it will not go very well at first. It is going to
+take practice--days and weeks and months of it--to learn how to work
+together. But, little by little, he will gain confidence in himself and
+in me, he will begin getting back his grip--enthusiasm--all the things of
+the old-time Karl, and then some day when we have had a little success
+about something he will burst forth--'By Jove--Ernestine--I believe we
+_can_ make it go!'--and that," she concluded, softly, "will be worth it
+all to me."
+
+Again a silence which sank deeper than words--a silence which sealed
+their compact.
+
+She came from it with the vigorously practical, "Now, Dr.
+Parkman,"--sitting up very straight, with an assertive little
+gesture--"you go out to that university and fire their souls! Wake them
+up! Make them _see_ it! And when do you think I can begin?"
+
+That turned them to actual issues; he spoke freely of difficulties, and
+they discussed them together calmly. Her enthusiasm was not builded on
+dreams alone; it was not of that volatile stuff which must perish in
+detail and difficulty. She was ready to meet it all, to ponder and plan.
+And where he had been carried by her enthusiasm he was held by her
+resourcefulness.
+
+"Are august dignitaries of reason and judgment likely to rise up and make
+it very unpleasant for you after I've gone?" she asked him, laughingly,
+when she had risen to go.
+
+"Very likely to," he laughed.
+
+"Tell them it's not their affair! Tell them to do what they're told and
+not ask too many questions!"
+
+"I'll try to put them in their proper place," he assured her.
+
+He watched her as she stood there buttoning her glove--slight, almost
+frail, scarcely one's idea of a "masterful woman." It struck him then as
+strange that she had not so much as asked for pledge of his allegiance.
+What was it about her--?
+
+She was holding out her hand. Something in her eyes lighted and glorified
+her whole face. "Thank you, doctor," she said, very low.
+
+For a long time he sat motionless before his desk. He was thinking of
+many things. "Nothing in which to believe," he murmured at last, looking
+about the room still warm with the spirit she had left--"nothing in which
+to believe--when there is love such as this in the world?"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+
+DR. PARKMAN'S WAY
+
+The next morning Dr. Parkman turned his automobile in the direction of
+the University of Chicago. There was a very grim look on his face as he
+sent the car, with the hand of an expert, through the crowded streets. He
+had his do-or-die expression, and the way he was letting the machine out
+would not indicate a shrinking back from what lay before him. He rather
+chuckled once; that is, it began in a chuckle, and ended with the
+semblance of a grunt, and when he finally swung the car down the Midway,
+he was saying to himself: "Glad of it! I've been wanting for a long time
+to tell that Lane what I thought of him."
+
+Inquiries over the telephone had developed the fact that through some
+shifting about, Dr. George Lane was temporary head of the department; it
+was to Dr. George Lane then that Dr. Parkman must go with the matter in
+hand this morning. That had seemed bad at first, for Lane was one man out
+there he couldn't get on with and did not want to. They always clashed;
+upon their last meeting Lane had said--"Really now, Dr. Parkman, don't
+you feel that a broader culture is the real need of the medical
+profession?" and Parkman had retorted, "Shouldn't wonder, but has it ever
+struck you, Dr. Lane, that a little more horse sense is the real need of
+the university professor?" He declared, grimly, as he finally drew his
+car to a snorting stop at the university that he would have to try some
+other method than "firing his soul," as Ernestine had bade him do. "In
+the first place," he figured it out, "he has no soul, and if he had, I
+wouldn't be the one to fire it with anything but rage." But the doctor
+was not worrying much about results. He thought he had a little
+ammunition in reserve which assured the outcome, and which would enable
+him, at the same time, to "let loose on Lane," should the latter show a
+tendency to become too important.
+
+The erudite Lane was a neatly built little fellow, very spick and span.
+First America and then England had done their best--or worst--by him.
+Just as every hair on his head was properly brushed, so Dr. Parkman felt
+quite sure that every idea within the head was properly beaten down with
+a pair of intellectual military brushes, one of which he had acquired to
+the west, and the other to the east of the Atlantic. "I suppose he's a
+scholar," mused the doctor, as he surveyed the back of the dignitary's
+head while waiting, "but what in God's name would he do if he were ever
+to be hit with an original idea?"
+
+"Ah, yes, Dr. Parkman, we so seldom see you very busy men out here. We
+always appreciate it when you busy men look in upon us."
+
+Now the tone did not appeal to Dr. Parkman, and with one of his quick
+decisions he bade tact take itself to the four winds, leaving him alone
+with his reserve guns.
+
+"I always appreciate it," he began abruptly, not attempting to deny that
+he was a busy man, "when people take as little of my time as possible. I
+will try to do unto others as I would that others do unto me."
+
+By the merest lifting of his eyebrows, Lane signified that he would make
+no attempt at detaining the doctor longer than he wished to stay. He
+awaited punctiliously the other man's pleasure, silently emphasising that
+the interview was not of his bringing about. "Thinks I'm a boor and a
+brute," mused Parkman.
+
+"What I wanted to see you about," he began, "relates to Dr. Hubers."
+
+"Ah, yes--poor Hubers. A remarkable man, in many ways. It is one of those
+things which make one--very sad. We wanted him to go on with his
+lectures, but he did not seem to feel quite equal to it."
+
+"Huh!"--that might mean a variety of things. The tone of patronage
+infuriated Karl's friend. "Jealous--sore--glad Karl's out of it," he was
+interpreting it.
+
+Then he delivered this very calmly: "Well, the fact of the matter is,
+that among all medical men, and in that part of the scientific world
+which I may call the active part--the only part of any real value--Karl
+Hubers is regarded so far above every other man who ever set foot in this
+university that all the rest of the place is looked upon as something
+which surrounds him. Over in Europe, they say--Chicago?--University of
+Chicago? Oh, yes--yes indeed, I remember now. That's where Hubers is.'"
+
+"The professor," as Dr. Parkman frequently insisted on calling him,
+showed himself capable of a rush of red blood to the face, and of a very
+human engulfing of emotion in a hurried cough. "Ah, I see you are a warm
+friend, Dr. Parkman," quickly regaining his impenetrable superiority, and
+smiling tolerantly. "But looking at it quite dispassionately, putting
+aside sympathy and all personal feeling, I have sometimes felt that Dr.
+Hubers, in spite of his--I may say gifts, in some directions, is a little
+lacking in that broad culture, that finer quality of universal
+scholarship which should dominate the ideal university man of to-day."
+
+Dr. Parkman was smiling in a knowing way to himself. "I see what you
+mean, Professor, though I would put it a little differently. I wouldn't
+call him in the least lacking in broad culture, but he is rather lacking
+in pedantry, in limitations, in intellectual snobbery, in university
+folderols. And of course a man who is actually doing something in the
+world, who stands for real achievement, has a little less time to look
+after the fine quality of universal scholarship."
+
+Perhaps Lane would have been either more or less than human, had he not
+retorted to that: "But as to this great achievement--it has never been
+forthcoming, has it?"
+
+The doctor had a little nervous affection of his face. The corner of one
+eye and one corner of his mouth sometimes twitched a little. People who
+knew him well were apt to grow nervous themselves when they made that
+observation. But as no one who knew him chanced to be present, the storm
+broke all unannounced.
+
+"For which," he snarled out, "every cheap skate of a university professor
+who never did anything himself but paddle other men's canoes, for which
+every human phonograph and intellectual parrot sends out thanks from his
+two-by-four soul! But among men who are men, among physicians who have
+cause to know his worth, among scientists big enough to get out of their
+own shadows, and, thank God, among the people who haven't been fossilised
+by clammy universities out of all sense of human values--among them, I
+say, Karl Hubers is appreciated for what he was close to doing when this
+damnable fate stepped in and stopped him!"
+
+The man of broad culture, very white as to the face, rose to his fullest
+height. It should not be held against him that his fullest height failed
+in reaching the other man's shoulder. "If there is nothing further," he
+choked out, "perhaps we may consider the interview concluded?"
+
+"No," retorted Parkman serenely, "the interview has just begun. It's your
+business, isn't it, to listen to matters relating to this department?"
+
+"It is; but as I am accustomed to meeting men of some--"
+
+"Manners?" supplied the doctor pleasantly. "As I am accustomed to men of
+a somewhat different type,"--he picked the phrase punctiliously,
+manifestly a conservative, even in war--"I was naturally unprepared for
+the nature of your remarks."
+
+"Oh well, the unexpected must be rather agreeable when one leads so cut
+and dried a life. But what I want to see you about," he went on, quite as
+though he had dropped the most pleasant thing in the world, "is just
+this. I want you to give the use of Dr. Hubers' laboratory, his equipment
+and at least one of his assistants, to Dr. Hubers' wife, that she may get
+in shape to work with him as his assistant, and enable him to carry on
+his work and do those things, which, as you correctly state, are still
+unachieved."
+
+Now the delivering of that pleased Dr. Parkman very much. He scarcely
+attempted to conceal his righteous pride.
+
+"Really, now," gasped the head of the department, after a minute of
+speechless staring, "really, now, Dr. Parkman, you astonish me."--"That's
+the truth, if he ever spoke it," thought the doctor grimly."--Dr. Hubers'
+wife, I understand you to say?"--and he of erudition was equal to a
+covert sneer--"just what has she to do with it, please?"
+
+"She has everything to do with it. In the first place, she is rather
+interested in Dr. Hubers. Then she's a remarkable woman. Needs to
+freshen up on some things, needs quite a little coaching, in fact; but in
+my judgment the best way for Hubers to go on with his work--you didn't
+think for a moment he was out of it, did you?--is for his wife to get in
+shape to work with him. That can be arranged all right?" he concluded
+pleasantly.
+
+Then Dr. George Lane spoke with the authority in him vested. "It
+certainly can not," he said, with an icy decisiveness.
+
+"But why not?" pursued Parkman, innocently.
+
+"Oh, now, don't misunderstand me, Professor. I didn't for a minute expect
+that you were to give any of your valuable time to Mrs. Hubers. Hastings
+is the fellow I'd like her turned over to. He's a friend of mine, and
+he's in sympathy, you know, with Dr. Hubers' work. All you'll have to do
+is to tell Hastings to do it," explained the doctor, expansively.
+
+The head of the department quite gleamed with the pride of authority as
+he pronounced: "Which you may be very certain I shall not do."
+
+"No?" said Parkman, leaning over the desk a little and looking at him.
+"You say--no?"
+
+"I do," replied the man in authority, with brevity, emphasis and
+finality.
+
+Dr. Parkman leaned back in his chair and seemed to be in deep thought.
+"Then the popular idea is all wrong, isn't it?"
+
+"I am at a loss to know to what popular idea you refer," said the
+professor, with a suitable indifference.
+
+"Oh merely to the popular idea that this place amounts to something; that
+it has let go of a little mediaevalism, and is more than a crude, cheap
+pattern--funny what ideas people get, isn't it? Now there are people who
+think the university here puts a value on individuality, that it would
+actually bend a rule or two to fit an individual case, in fact that it
+likes initiative, encourages originality, wouldn't in the least mind
+having a few actual achievements to its credit."
+
+"At the same time," goaded from his icy calm--"it does not propose to
+make itself ridiculous!"
+
+"And doing a rather unconventional thing, in order to bring about a very
+great thing, would be making itself ridiculous, would it?"
+
+"I fail to see how anything so preposterous could bring about good
+results," said the man in authority, introducing into that a note of
+dismissal.
+
+"Do you?" replied Parkman, not yet dismissed. "Well, if you will pardon a
+little more plain speaking, I will say that this is something I know a
+good deal more about than you do."
+
+"We have made other arrangements for the laboratory," and the professor
+picked up a paper from his desk and looked it over, nice subtilties
+evidently being lost.
+
+"So? Going to give it to some fellow who will devote himself, after the
+fashion of university men, to verifying other men's conclusions?"
+
+Then Dr. Parkman rose. "Well," he said, "you've had your chance. You had
+a chance to do something which would give this place an excuse for
+existing. I'm sorry you weren't big enough to take it.
+
+"I fear medical men may feel some little prejudice about this," he
+remarked, easily--not in the least as though dealing in heavy ammunition.
+"Hubers commands the medical men, you know. They care more for him than
+for all the rest of the fellows out here put together. About that medical
+school of yours," he said, meditatively, "that you're pushing so hard
+just now,--to whom shall I tender my resignation as chairman of the
+committee I'm on? And, at the same time, I'll just be released from the
+lectures I was to give in the winter quarter. I'm entirely too busy to
+spend my time on a place that doesn't care for anything but dead men's
+bones. Lewis and Richmond will probably want to pull out too. Of course,"
+he went on, seemingly to himself, "a thing like this will unfortunately
+be noised about, and all doctors will be a little sore about your not
+caring to stand by Hubers. But I suppose I had better see the president
+about all that. He gets home next week? And, come to think of it, I'm
+pretty close to a couple of members of the board. I operated on both
+Lessing and Tyler. Both of those fellows have a notion they owe their
+lives to me. That makes people feel rather close to one, you know. But
+then, of course, you don't know--why should you? And, dear me--there's
+that rich old patient of mine, Burley. Now isn't it strange,"--turning
+genially to Lane, as if merely interesting him in a philosophical
+proposition--"how one thing leads to another? I fear Burley may not be so
+interested in making that gift to the new medical building, if he knows
+I've cut loose from the place. The president will feel rather sore
+about that, too,--you know how the president is about such things. But
+then,"--shrugging his shoulders indifferently--"he needn't feel sore at
+me."
+
+Dr. George Lane was swallowing very hard. Though learned, he was not
+dull. Word by word he had drunk in the bitter truth that this big, dark,
+gruff, ill-mannered man was not to be put down with impunity. Call it
+bullying--any hard name you would, there was no evading the fact that it
+was power in sledge hammer strokes. "The professor" was just wise enough
+to see that there lay before him the unpleasant task of retraction.
+
+"Ah--of course, doctor," he began, striving for nonchalance, "do not take
+this as too final. You see anything so unusual as this will have to come
+before the committee. You did not present it to me--ah--very fully, but
+the more I consider it, the more I am disposed to think it is a thing
+we--may care to undertake. I--will present it."
+
+"Oh, don't bother about that," said the doctor pleasantly. "I wouldn't
+worry the committee about it, if I were you. I can get a down-town
+laboratory all right. I simply thought I would give the university a
+chance at the thing. It doesn't matter," he concluded, opening the door.
+
+"Well now, I'll tell you, doctor," said Lane, and part of his face was
+white, and part of it was red, "while you're out here, you would
+better go up and see Hastings. I'm sure I can say--speaking for the
+committee--that we will be very glad to have Mrs. Hubers here."
+
+"I fired his soul all right," thought the doctor, grimly, as he walked up
+to find Hastings. "Those little two by fours!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+
+OLD-FASHIONED LOVE
+
+Karl's new secretary was what Karl himself called "one of those
+philosophical ducks." "That is," he explained to Ernestine, "he is one of
+those fellows who has been graduated from science into philosophy."
+
+"But wouldn't you get on better with one of the scientific students who
+hadn't been graduated yet?" she laughed.
+
+"Oh, no; no, I don't mind having a graduate. Ross can do the work all
+right. I'm lucky to get him. There aren't many of them who are
+stenographers, and then he can give me most of his time. He's finishing
+up for his Ph.D."
+
+"And was he really a student of science in the beginning?"
+
+"Well, after a fashion. The kind that is graduated into philosophy."
+
+"Karl," she laughed, "despite your proud boast to the contrary, you're
+bigoted. It's the bigotry of science."
+
+"No, it's having science patronised by these fellows who don't know
+anything about it. If they'd once roll up their sleeves and do some
+actual work they'd give up that idea of being so easily graduated. But
+they want to get where they'll not have to work. Philosophy's a lazy
+man's job."
+
+"There you go again! A clear case of the scientific arrogance."
+
+"No, they amuse me; that's all. 'I had a great deal of science in my
+undergraduate work,' Mr. Ross said, 'but I feel now that I want to go
+into the larger field of philosophy.'"
+
+"Karl," she laughed, a little amused and a little indignant, "did he
+actually say that to you?"
+
+"He actually did. And with the pleasantest, most off-hand air. It was on
+the tip of my tongue to reply: 'Fortunately, science never loses anything
+in these people she graduates so easily into philosophy.'
+
+"I wonder what they think," he went on, "when we turn them upside down
+two or three times a century? It doesn't seem to worry them any. 'Give me
+some eggs and some milk and some sugar and I'll make a nice pudding,'
+they say--that's about what goes into a pudding, isn't it? And then they
+take the stuff in very thankless fashion, and when their pudding is done,
+they say--'Isn't it pathetic the way some people spend their lives
+producing nothing but eggs and milk and sugar?' And the worst of it is
+that half the time they spoil our good stuff by putting it together
+wrong."
+
+"Such a waste of good eggs and milk and sugar," she laughed.
+
+"But fortunately it is a superior kind of eggs and milk and sugar that
+can't be hurt by being thrown together wrong. The pudding is bad, but the
+good stuff in it is indestructible. And as we don't have to sit down to
+their table, why should we worry over their failures?"
+
+"Why, indeed? But then, I don't agree that all puddings are bad."
+
+"No, not all of them. But it rubs me the wrong way to see bad cooks take
+such liberties with their materials."
+
+"Because good eggs and milk and sugar aren't so easy to produce," she
+agreed.
+
+"Some of us have paid a pretty good price for them," he said.
+
+That turned them to the things always close to them, and they were silent
+for a time. It was Saturday evening, and on Monday Ernestine would begin
+her new work. Dr. Parkman had arranged it for her--she did not know how,
+but it had been done, and Professor Hastings, who would have her in
+charge, was eager to give all possible help. That day, while Karl was
+busy, she had been reading a book Dr. Parkman had given her. He would
+keep her supplied with the best things for her to read, he said,
+selecting that which was vital, so that she would not waste time
+blundering through Karl's library at random. Dr. Parkman was being so
+splendid about it all. He was a man to give himself to a thing without
+reservations; if he helped at all he made his help count to the
+uttermost. She felt him back of her as a force which would not fail. And
+she would show him his confidence was not misplaced--his support not
+given to a vain cause! Resolution strengthened within her as the way was
+cleared. Unconsciously she caught Karl's hand and held it tight in both
+of hers.
+
+"You know, liebchen," he said, caressing her hand in response, "I've done
+considerable thinking of late. Perhaps a fellow thinks more about things
+when he is not right in them, and it seemed to me to-day, when I was
+thinking over these things suggested by Ross, that the reason most people
+don't get on better with their work is just because they don't care for
+it enough. You have to love a thing to do much with it. Take it in any
+kind of scientific work; the work is hard, there is detail, drudgery, and
+discouragement. You're going to lose heart and grip unless you have that
+enthusiasm for the thing as a whole. You must see it big, and have
+that--well, call it fanaticism, if you want to--a willingness to give
+yourself up to it, at any rate. The reason these fellows want to get into
+the 'bigger field of philosophy' is because they've never known anything
+about the bigger field of science."
+
+She loved that fire in his voice, that rare, fine light which at times
+like this shone from his face. In such moments, he seemed a man set
+apart; as one divinely appointed. It filled her heart with a warm, glad
+rush to think it was she would bring him back to his own. It was she
+would reseat Karl on his throne. And what awaited him then? Might not his
+possibilities be greater than ever before? Would not determination rise
+in him with new tremendousness, and would not hope, after its rebirth in
+despair, soar to undreamed of heights? Would not the meditation of these
+days, the new understanding rising from relinquishment and suffering,
+bring him back to his work a scientist who was also philosopher?
+
+She believed that that would be true, that the things his blindness
+taught him to see would more than atone for the things shut away. And
+would not she herself come to love the work just because of what it meant
+to Karl? Care for it because of what it could do for him? Loving it first
+because he loved it, would not she come to love it for itself?
+
+A quiver of pain had drawn the beautiful light from his face. "Tell me
+about your work, dear," he said abruptly. "You haven't said much about it
+of late."
+
+She turned away her face. She was always forgetting that he could not see
+her face.
+
+"You know you must get to work, sweetheart," he went on as she did not
+answer. "I am expecting great things of my little girl."
+
+"I hope you will not be disappointed," she answered, very low.
+
+"Of course I'll not be--if you just get to work. Now when are you going
+to begin?"
+
+"I'm going to begin Monday," replied Ernestine.
+
+"Good! Painting some great picture?"
+
+She hesitated. "I hope it will be a great picture."
+
+"Tell me about it."
+
+"I can tell you better, dear, when it is a little farther along."
+
+"You love your work, Ernestine. You have the real, true, fundamental love
+for it. I always loved to see your face light up when you spoke of your
+work. Is your face lighted up now?" he asked, a little whimsically, but
+earnestly.
+
+She laughed, but the laugh caught in her throat.
+
+"Will you tell me about your picture as it progresses, dear? Don't be
+afraid to talk to me of your work, Ernestine. Things will be less hard
+for me, if I think you are happy. And it will be good to know there is to
+be some great thing come of our love, dear. I want something to stand for
+it, something beautiful and great."
+
+"There will be!" she said passionately. "There is going to be."
+
+"I know," he said gently. "I am sure of it."
+
+He stroked her face lovingly then. He loved so to do that.
+
+"Will you mind much, Karl," she began, a little timidly, "if I am away
+from you some this year?"
+
+"Away from me?" he asked, startled. "Why, what do you mean, Ernestine?"
+
+"Oh, not that I am going away," she hastened. "But, as I say, I am going
+to begin my work on Monday, and part of the time I shall be working, away
+from home."
+
+"You mean in some studio?"
+
+Her face grew troubled; she frowned a little, bit her lip, but after a
+second's hesitation, answered: "Yes."
+
+"Found some fellow to study with?"
+
+And again she answered yes.
+
+"Well now look here, liebchen, have I been such a brute that you thought
+I wouldn't want you to set foot out of the house? I didn't suppose there
+was anyone here you'd have much to gain from, but if there is, so much
+the better. I want you to go right ahead and do your best--don't you know
+that?"
+
+But there was a note of forced cheer in it. It would be hard for Karl to
+feel she was not in the house, when he had come to depend on her for so
+many things. She could not tell him why she was willing to be away from
+him. It hurt her to think he might feel she did not understand.
+
+A little later Georgia and her mother and Georgia's Mr. Tank came over to
+see them. During the summer Ernestine and Karl had been bestowing an
+approving interest on Georgia and Joseph Tank. Karl liked him; he said
+the fellow laughed as though there was no reason why he shouldn't. "He
+doesn't know everything," he told Ernestine, "but knows too much to seem
+to know what he doesn't."
+
+Georgia had been disposed to be apologetic about Mr. Tank's paper bags,
+and Karl had retorted: "Great Scott, Georgia, is there anything the world
+needs much worse than paper bags?"
+
+To-night Mr. Tank was all enthusiasm about a ball game he had attended
+that afternoon. He gave Karl the story of the game in the picturesque
+fashion of a man more eager to express what he wishes to say than to
+guard the purity of his English. "Oh, it was hot stuff, clear through,"
+he concluded. "Bully good game!"
+
+"It is sometimes almost impossible for me to tell what Georgia and Mr.
+Tank are talking about," sighed Mrs. McCormick. "They use so many words
+which are not in the dictionary. Now when people confine themselves to
+words which are in the dictionary, I am always able to ascertain their
+meaning."
+
+"I'm long for saying a thing the way I can get it said," laughed Tank.
+"And I'm long for this new spelling. I never could get next to the old
+system, and now if they push this deal through, I can pat myself on the
+back and say, 'Good for you, old boy. You were just waiting for them to
+start in right.' It would be such a good one on the teachers who bumped
+my head against the wall because I didn't begin pneumonia with a p and
+every other minute run in an i or an e I had sense enough to know had no
+business there at all. Oh, I'm long for taking a fall out of the old
+spelling book."
+
+"I do hope, Karl," admonished Mrs. McCormick, "that you will use your
+influence with scholars to see that the dictionary is let alone. It is
+certainly a very profane and presumptuous thing to think of changing a
+dictionary,"--turning to Ernestine for approval.
+
+"When I was a child," observed Georgia, "I had a sublime and
+unquestioning faith in two things,--the Bible and the dictionary. The
+Bible was written by God and the dictionary by Noah Webster, and both
+were to remain intact to the end of time. But the University of Chicago
+is re-writing the Bible, and 'most any one who feels like it can take a
+hand at the dictionary, so what is there left for a poor girl to believe
+in?"
+
+"Believe in the American dollar," said Tank cheerfully. "That's the
+solidest thing I've ever been up against."
+
+Mrs. McCormick left them to call upon a friend who lived next door, Karl
+and Mr. Tank turned to frenzied finance, and Georgia and Ernestine
+wandered away by themselves--Ernestine surmised that Georgia wanted to
+talk to her.
+
+"How goes it at _The Mail_?" she asked.
+
+"Oh--so so," said Georgia fretfully. "Newspaper work is a thankless job."
+
+"Why, Georgia, I thought you loved it so."
+
+"Oh, yes,--yes, in a way, I do. But it's thankless. And you never get
+anywhere. You break your neck one day, and then there's nothing to do the
+next, but start in and break it again. You're never any better to-day for
+yesterday's killing. Now with you--when you paint a good picture, it
+stays painted."
+
+"Why don't you get married?" asked Ernestine, innocently.
+
+"Married! Pooh--that would be a nice thing!"
+
+"Indeed it would. If you care for the man."
+
+Georgia was fidgeting; it was plain she wanted to talk about marriage, if
+she could do so without seeming to be vitally interested in the subject.
+
+"I mean it, Georgia," Ernestine went on. "If you care for him, marry
+him."
+
+"Care for whom?" Georgia demanded, and then coloured and laughed at the
+folly of her evasion. "Well, the fact of the matter is," she finally
+blurted out, "I don't know whether I do or not. Now, in a way, I do. That
+is, I want him to care for me, and I shouldn't like it if he sailed away
+to the Philippine Islands and never showed up again, but at the same
+time--well, I don't think even _you_ could get up much sentiment about
+paper bags, and besides"--tempestuously--"the name Tank's preposterous!"
+
+Ernestine laughed. "What are those terms the lawyers are so fond
+of--immaterial, irrelevant, and something else? Georgia, once when I was
+a little girl and went to visit my grandmother, I had a stubborn fit and
+wouldn't eat any dinner because the dining-room table had such ugly legs.
+And the dinner, Georgia, was good."
+
+It was Georgia who laughed then. "But Ernestine"--with a swift turn to
+seriousness--"you're not a fair sample; you and Karl are--exceptional.
+You see you have so _much_--intellectual companionship--sympathetic
+ideas--kindred tastes--don't you see what a fool I'd make of myself in
+judging the thing by you?"--she ended with a little gulp which might have
+been a laugh or might have been something else.
+
+Ernestine was giving some affectionate rubs to her brass coffee pot. When
+she raised her head it was to look at Georgia strangely. She continued to
+look, and the strangeness about her intensified. "Shall I tell you
+something, Georgia?"--her voice low and queer. "Something I _know_? You
+wouldn't be willing to fight 'till you dropped for sympathetic ideas. You
+wouldn't be willing to lay down your life for intellectual companionship.
+You wouldn't be willing to go barefoot and hungry and friendless for
+kindred tastes. Don't for one minute believe you would! The only thing
+for which you'd be willing to let the whole world slip away from you is
+an old-fashioned, out-of-date thing called love--just the primitive,
+fundamental love there is between a man and a woman. If you haven't it,
+Georgia--hold back. If you have,"--a wonderful smile of understanding
+glowed through a rush of tears--"oh, Georgia, if you _have_!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+
+LEARNING TO BE KARL'S EYES
+
+She wondered many times in the next few months why she had put it in that
+very simple, self-evident way.
+
+For there are things harder than to go barefoot and hungry and
+friendless. Those are the primitive things, to be met with one's
+endowment of primitive courage, elemental strength. But poise of spirit
+can not be wrested from elemental courage. To carry one's carefully
+wrapped up burden with the nonchalance of the day--nature forgot to make
+endowment for that; it is something then to be worked out wholly by one's
+self.
+
+Persecution she could have endured like a Spartan; but it was almost
+unendurable to be tolerated. She was sure it would have been easier if
+only they had been rude to her. To be openly jeered at would fire her
+soul. But there was so little in their manner either to kindle enthusiasm
+or stir aggressiveness. She began to think that the most trying thing in
+the world was to have people polite to one.
+
+The very first week was the worst of all. No one knew what to do with
+her; as this was her own idea, an idea no one else pretended to
+understand, it was expected she make some suggestions for the proper
+disposition of herself. But poor Ernestine did not know enough about it
+to make disposition of herself. She could only smile with a courageous
+serenity, and ask that she be shown how to help about things. And so Mr.
+Willard, who was in charge of Karl's laboratory, and who was Karl without
+Karl's genius, turned her over to Mr. Beason, his assistant. Beason would
+show her how to "help."
+
+Her sense of humour helped her there. It was amusing that one who was
+learning to "help" should be such an encumbrance. And there were many
+amusing things about Mr. Beason. He was afraid of her because she was a
+woman, for like reason disapproving of her presence in the laboratory,
+and yet there was an unconscious deference, the same kind of veneration
+he would have paid Karl's old coat, or his pipe.
+
+John Beason had never been shaken by a genuine emotion until the day he
+read that Dr. Karl Hubers had lost his eyesight and must give up his
+work. In the horror, the rage and the grief which swept over him then,
+Beason rose to the heights of a human being, never to be quite without
+humanship again. When he came back that fall, Professor Hastings was
+quick to sense the change.
+
+Beason was given a place in Dr. Hubers' old laboratory, as one of Mr.
+Willard's assistants. That first morning, after he had been in there
+about an hour, he came out to Professor Hastings, who chanced to be
+alone.
+
+"I don't know whether I want to stay in there or not," the boy jerked
+out.
+
+ He told him that Dr. Hubers would like to have him there. "You know he
+liked you," he said simply.
+
+Beason sat a long time pondering. "Well, they'll never have another man
+like him," he said at last, savagely, and choking a little.
+
+After the first few weeks his attitude toward Ernestine took on a
+complexity an analysis of which would have greatly astounded Mr. Beason
+himself. He did a great deal of pondering as to whether it would really
+be possible for Dr. Hubers to go on with his work. It seemed to him it
+would not be, but a few things Mrs. Hubers had said in a very simple way
+had opened up a great deal of speculation as to what was possible and
+what was not. And the thing which made him grow so quickly into an
+unconscious respect for her was her assumption that the most important
+thing in the world was that Dr. Hubers should go on with his work. Now
+that looked as though she had some sense, Beason admitted. Of course the
+ridiculous part was thinking _she_ was the one to bring it about, when
+anybody would know it would have to be some one--well, some one like
+himself. But then it was just like a woman to think she could do anything
+she took it into her head to do. Of course she would very soon find out
+that she couldn't, but if she proved some one else could, why then she
+wouldn't be so bad, after all.
+
+Ernestine was quick to see that the way to enlist Mr. Beason was to talk
+to him about Karl. They were alone in the laboratory for an hour each
+morning, and during that period she always managed to say something about
+Dr. Hubers to leave Beason closer to her at the end of the hour than he
+had been at the beginning. There were more ways than one of winning a
+scientific victory, she concluded, half humorously, but with a touch of
+sadness. She was beginning to see that it was a battle which demanded
+tact and diplomacy quite as much as brains and skill. She must not only
+furnish enthusiasm for herself, she must inspire all associated with her
+if she were to gain from them what they had to give.
+
+It was after she had one day spoken with unusual freedom of the suffering
+which surged beneath Karl's calm acceptance of the inevitable that Beason
+took his first firm stand in her behalf.
+
+"Well now, of course," he conceded, after a long time of turning it over
+in his mind, "you really don't have to _know_ much, do you? The great
+thing for you to learn is to tell exactly how results look. It isn't as
+if you had to reason and think,"--that was Beason's supreme rise to
+graciousness.
+
+"Why, you have the idea exactly, Mr. Beason," she replied, admiringly,
+and Beason grasped that he had manifested rare insight.
+
+"Well now,"--doubtfully--"I suppose you might practice on me. Practice is
+what you need. I haven't looked at any of those things over there. See if
+you can give me an idea of what they are."
+
+She did her best, blundering freely, and thinking with an inward smile
+that she had not counted on anything so difficult as translating things
+to Beason.
+
+Then he took the tube from her hand and explained how she had failed to
+get the significant things, and how valueless she would be unless she
+made the determining points stand out. He was very blunt and
+unflattering, but she was grateful to him from the bottom of her heart.
+"You see you do have to have some brains after all," he concluded with a
+sigh.
+
+But after that he frequently devoted his entire hour to helping her. He
+had come to accept her as one of his duties, and Beason was not one to
+neglect his appointed task. Day by day she gained a great deal from the
+uncompromising Mr. Beason.
+
+In fact, after those first uncertain weeks, she gained a great deal from
+every one. Gradually it began to systematise itself, and Ernestine's good
+sense, her earnestness, which was fairly devotion, her respect for every
+one's knowledge and gratitude for all help--to say nothing of her eyes
+and smile and voice--slowly penetrated even the conservatism of science.
+
+Dr. Parkman did not neglect her. He came out often and spent an hour in
+the laboratory, bringing things for her to work with. Perhaps the doctor
+saw that quite as much as his help, she needed the prestige his attention
+would give. It was no small thing to have the great Dr. Parkman giving
+her his time. "Upon my soul," Mr. Willard said one day, after the doctor
+had been there a long time and had seemed very much in earnest, "I don't
+believe Parkman's the man to spend his time on a wild goose chase!"
+
+"It doesn't seem so, does it?" said Professor Hastings ingenuously.
+
+"Why, think what that man's time is worth!" continued Mr. Willard,
+growing more and more impressed.
+
+"I don't know any one else out here who would get much of it," Professor
+Hastings ventured.
+
+"Well, she is a remarkable woman," Willard said then, insistently.
+
+And Professor Hastings--understanding many things about human
+beings--said he was really coming to feel that way himself.
+
+Ernestine was alone in the laboratory one bright morning in December. Mr.
+Beason had just gone away after assuring her anew that she had a very
+great deal to learn. Perhaps it was funny, but one was not always in the
+mood for humorous things. Sometimes one felt more like putting one's head
+down on the table and having a good cry. Her hands were not quite steady,
+as she went about the work Beason had patronisingly left for her to do,
+and out of the mists which blinded her there came a picture of her own
+quiet studio at home, where she had worked with her own things, things
+with which she was supreme. She saw herself at her easel, working in that
+quick, sure way of hers, no one to tell her some one else could do it a
+great deal better, and that it was extremely doubtful whether she could
+ever do anything at all. A longing to be back there doing the things she
+knew she could do, a longing to have again that sure sense of her work as
+good, swept over her then. She was accustomed to a sense of mastery; it
+was that made some of these things so hard. It was not easy to make over
+one's soul, even when it was love called one on. As she went steadily
+ahead with her task, working out painstakingly the correction Beason had
+made, she wondered whether there were as many tears back of other smiles
+as there had often been back of hers.
+
+But she had been able to smile!--that was something for which to give
+thanks. Not even Karl himself would ever know what she had gone through,
+but what she had gone through was of small consequence could she but push
+her way on to what she was confident awaited her. There was sustaining
+power in that thought: her hands did not tremble now, her eyes were
+clear; she worked on steadily and firmly.
+
+One thing which had unnerved her was that Karl had seemed to hate to have
+her go away that morning. He had followed her out into the hall. "Working
+so hard, liebchen?" he said--and was it not wistfully? Perhaps he had not
+felt like work himself and had wanted her to stay at home with him. It
+hurt cruelly to think Karl might not understand her willingness to be
+away from him so much.
+
+His presence was always with her in the laboratory. The days brought a
+very clear picture of Karl at work there, a new understanding of his
+adjustment to his work, firmer comprehension of his love for it. Often a
+sense of the terribleness and wrongness of his disaster would rush over
+her, crowding her heart with the old rebellion and bitterness. Again and
+again she lived through the hour Karl had spent there alone, facing the
+truth, and then a horror of those things with which she worked, those
+awful things which had destroyed Karl's eyes, would take hold of her as a
+physical fear, a repulsion, almost impossible to fight.
+
+She was constantly brought to see the difference between him and these
+other men; every hour she spent there brought deeper appreciation of
+Karl's greatness, clearer sense of it. And when their kindly patronage
+sometimes passed from the amusing to the insufferable, she would think
+how Karl, master of them all, took her so unreservedly into his mind and
+heart, cherishing her ideas and opinions as quite the most vital things
+in all the world, and sometimes that would help her to smile, and not
+infrequently it made her long to hurl a test-tube at the self-satisfied
+head of Mr. Beason. But always, in the end, it caused her to set her
+whole being with new persistence, more passionate stubbornness, in this
+determination to achieve.
+
+It was while she was still alone that Professor Hastings came in with a
+note he had just received for her. "It's from Dr. Parkman," she said as
+she tore it open hastily.
+
+She read a little of it and then sat down. He thought for a moment that
+she was going to cry.
+
+"Dr. Parkman wants me to come down to one of his operations this
+afternoon,"--she looked up at him appealingly. "I--I never went to
+anything like that," she added, with a tremulous laugh.
+
+"What does he say about it?" he asked, anxiously.
+
+"Merely--merely that it will be a good cancer operation, and that I had
+better begin on that part of the work. He says he would be willing to do
+that, but he thinks it will help me to be able to make some of the
+observations for Dr. Hubers myself. I--well, it sometimes makes me sick
+to see things I don't like,"--laughing a little, and plainly unnerved.
+
+"Oh, no," he assured her; "it will not be that bad." But he added,
+uneasily: "Dr. Parkman seems anxious for you to come?"
+
+"No, not particularly anxious; he simply tells me to be there at two
+o'clock."
+
+"I suppose then you'd better go," he laughed. "You won't mind much. You
+may to-day, but you'll become accustomed to it very soon. And it is
+important. Some one else might do it, but it will help your own
+understanding of the subject, make your equipment that much better. It's
+a great thing for you to have Dr. Parkman's help. And he is so pleased
+with your progress. He told me the other day that he thought it
+absolutely phenomenal the way you were getting on."
+
+"Did he?" she asked eagerly, for she had learned to seize upon all which
+would buoy her up.
+
+"We all think so," he replied earnestly. "Even Mr. Willard, who, as you
+may have observed, is not an enthusiast, said the other day that you were
+becoming really useful."
+
+She brightened, and then laughed. She had never supposed she would be
+inordinately pleased to have a man like Mr. Willard say she was really
+useful.
+
+"While Mr. Beason went so far as to assert that you had a general
+intelligence not unlike that of a man."
+
+She laughed heartily at that. "Well, I'm afraid they won't think I have
+the nerve or sense of a man when I get in the operating room this
+afternoon," she said with a wry little face.
+
+"Well, remember what it's all for," he said, in that simple way of his
+which went so far because it was so direct, "and remember that we are all
+believing in you."
+
+In response to that she went back to her work with new resolution.
+
+It was a little before two when her lagging footsteps brought her in
+sight of the hospital. "Why, I act as though I were going to my own
+execution," she told herself scornfully. Ever since receiving the note,
+she had been trying not to think about what was before her; but it was
+here now, a fact to be faced. Conquering an impulse to turn about and
+beat a hasty retreat, she advanced with a brisk and business-like air she
+was sure would deceive the most knowing of hospital attendants.
+
+They seemed to know about her in the office, and took her up to one of
+the rooms adjoining the operating room. The hospital was a very large
+place, and there were a great many odours she did not like. She hated
+herself for being so silly about things! Through the open door she saw
+many faces: white faces, thin faces, faces drawn with pain, faces robbed
+of hope, faces fretful, and faces indifferent, and she caught sight of
+one girl whose very happy eyes looked out from a face which bore the
+record of much pain. A story easy to read: she had been very ill, but now
+she was getting well. And how calm and well-ordered a place it was--
+strange how they could keep so unruffled a surface over so turbulent a
+sea!
+
+A nurse upstairs said that Dr. Parkman had told her to look after Mrs.
+Hubers. She dressed her in a white gown and talked to her pleasantly
+about operations in general. Ernestine was glad that this very rational
+being did not know how hard she was struggling to keep her teeth from
+chattering.
+
+In a minute, Dr. Parkman himself came in, he, too, in white gown, ready
+for the operation. He looked so strange; to her nervous vision,
+supernatural, a being from other worlds, holding the destiny of this one
+in those strong, supple, incisive fingers. "I don't suppose you'll enjoy
+this much," he said, "but you'd better get used to them. Karl may need
+you to do some of this for him, and you wouldn't like it not to be able
+to."
+
+"No, indeed," she replied, heartily--very heartily. "I'm so glad to
+come."
+
+He looked at her in his keen, deep-seeing way. She had an uncomfortable
+sense that he had a distinct impulse toward a smile.
+
+"Hughes, one of our young doctors, will point out a few things to you as
+we go along, and I'll go over it with you afterwards."
+
+Then they went into the operating room.
+
+She fought hard against the smell of ether, and managed to hold herself
+quite firm against it. But there was a ghastliness in the whole thing
+which frightened her.
+
+The patient was lying there on the operating table, covered with sheets,
+looking as if dead. It was a woman who was to be operated on, and
+Ernestine could not overcome the idea that it was a dreadful thing for
+her to be there alone, surrounded by strange people who were acting in so
+unconcerned a manner. They did not seem to be thinking in the least of
+what life and death meant to this woman. One young doctor was showing
+something to another, and they laughed right out loud! The woman whose
+life was at stake was not impressing them any more than--not any more
+than that terrible looking little instrument which the nurse handed to
+Dr. Parkman.
+
+Her dizzy vision got Dr. Parkman's face as he leaned over his patient.
+She had never seen such a look of concentration; he did not know anything
+in the world then save the thing he was doing. And the concentration was
+enveloped in so tremendous a coolness. But her own face must have warned
+the nurse who was looking after her, for she whispered, "Suppose you come
+over here by the window until they have started. There is no need for you
+to watch while they are making the incision."
+
+So she stood there with her back to them, looking out at a little park
+across from the hospital. Down there, men and women were moving about
+quite as usual; one girl was laughing very heartily about something.
+Strange that people should be laughing!
+
+"Now you might come over here," said the nurse, as pleasantly and easily
+as though saying, "Wouldn't you like a cup of tea?"
+
+She tried then with all her might to take it as the rest of them were
+taking it. But they were operating on the stomach, and her first glimpse
+caused an almost uncontrollable sinking in the knees. Her ears began to
+pound, but by listening very hard she could hear what Dr. Hughes was
+saying. He was saying something about its being a very nice case, and she
+wondered if the woman were married, and if she had any children, and then
+she knew how irrelevant and unprofessional that was. Dr. Hughes was
+telling her to look at something, and she did look, and she saw Dr.
+Parkman's hands, only it seemed they were not human hands at all,
+but some infallible instrument, an instrument with an unconquerable
+soul,--and then everything was dancing before her eyes, her ears were
+pounding harder and harder, her knees sinking, everything swaying, some
+one had hold of her, and some one else, a great many miles away was
+saying--"Take her out!"
+
+When she opened her eyes, she was lying on a couch in an anteroom, the
+nurse bending over her. The attendant smiled pleasantly, no more agitated
+than before. "Too bad," she said; "a good many of us take it like that at
+first."
+
+But Ernestine was not to be comforted. It meant too much to her. The
+tears were running down her face, but suddenly she brushed them angrily
+aside, and sat up. "I'm going back," she said resolutely.
+
+"Oh, but you mustn't," protested the nurse,--"not today. It really
+wouldn't do. And anyway they must be almost through. Dr. Parkman works so
+rapidly."
+
+It was a very disheartened Ernestine who sat there then alone. "What will
+Dr. Parkman think of me?" she bewailed to herself. "He will never want to
+have anything more to do with me. He will be so disgusted that he will
+let me alone now. And how am I to get along without him? Oh, _why_ am I
+such a fool?"
+
+The whole day had been hard, she was tired out when she came, and this
+was too much. So she just lay back on the couch and cried. It was so that
+Dr. Parkman found her when he came briskly in at the close of the
+operation.
+
+"Why, what's the matter?" he demanded. "Heard some bad news?"
+
+"_Bad_--news!" she choked out; "no, I haven't heard any bad news--except
+that I'm an utterly worthless, weak-minded fool!"
+
+"And where did you hear that?" he pursued.
+
+"Oh, doctor--I'm so ashamed! But if you'll only give me another chance!
+If you'll just not give me up for a little while yet!"
+
+"Give you up! Now what kind of reviving fluid did Miss Lewis produce for
+you? What in the world are you talking about? Do you think you're any
+grand exception in not seeing your first operation through? Hum! Ask some
+of these nurses around here. Some of the doctors too, only they won't
+tell the truth. My first day in the dissecting room was a day of about
+thirty minutes. So you see you have plenty of company in your
+weak-mindedness."
+
+She brightened then to the extent of looking willing to be comforted.
+"But it's humiliating, doctor, to think you're going to accomplish some
+big thing and then be absolutely overcome by a little incidental thing
+that doesn't happen to appeal to your senses. It's awful to have your
+senses get ahead of your soul like that," she laughed.
+
+"Hum!"--Dr. Parkman had a "hum" all his own. "There's nothing unique in
+that experience, either. The spirit is willing, but the stomach is
+weak--to put it in exact terms. As a matter of fact, that's what life is
+made up of--having great purposes overthrown by minor inconveniences.
+Many a man can get hold of a great idea, but very few of them can stick
+by it through the things that make them uncomfortable. That's the reason
+most dreamers fail--they're not willing to come down out of the clouds
+and get to work at things that turn their stomachs!"
+
+"Well, I'm not like that!" she flashed back at him.
+
+"You? I know you're not. Some ancestor of yours gave you a big bump of
+stubbornness--for which you should look back to him with gratitude.
+Stubborn people aren't easily put out of the race. Now I'll tell you why
+I wanted you to come down here," he went on, more seriously. "I want you
+to see the thing just as it is. I want you to get the conception of it as
+a whole. I don't want you to become short-sighted. Some people look so
+much through the microscope that they forget how to look any other way.
+That's the difference between Karl and some of those fellows you're
+associated with now. That Willard and Lane and young Beason are the
+scientific kind, too abominably scientific to forge ahead. Don't lose
+sight of what you are doing. All these things you are doing now are
+simply a means to an end. You are to be one of the instruments
+employed--as you put it yourself one day--but make yourself such a
+highly-organised, responsive instrument that you're fairly alive with the
+idea yourself. See? That's where your real value will come in. You
+know,"--it was Dr. Parkman now who breathed the enthusiasm which draws
+one to a light out beyond obstacle and difficulty--"I'm beginning to see
+the thing more and more as actual fact. I caught the idea from the first,
+and then it seemed it simply had to be done because it was such a great
+thing to do, but I'm getting it more and more now just as a practical,
+matter-of-fact thing. And it isn't so far away,--not so very. You see,
+after all, Mrs. Hubers, you don't have to do it all. It would be stupid
+to set a race horse at a job that could be just as well accomplished by a
+plug. Any well-trained man can do certain things for Karl--but it's the
+touch of the artist--the things that make it real--it's making the blind
+man see--doing the impossible!--that's your work. Why, I can fairly see
+the whole thing," he went on--"Karl and you and some good assistant.
+He'll get both points of view then--he can't miss anything. The other
+fellow can give him certain technicalities you might miss--and then
+you'll turn in and bring it to his vision. A clear statement of facts
+could never make a blind man see. And then it will be your business to
+keep the spirit right--that's the real point, after all. Why, I can see
+it just as clearly as I could see that work to be done in there!"--
+pointing to the operating room.
+
+It was another Ernestine now. She rose to it as the warrior to the
+trumpet call. He knew that the right word had been said.
+
+"Now I don't think it will hurt you to see some of these operations," he
+went on, in more business like way. "Not only to help with observations
+for Karl, but--well, just to see it for yourself. Nothing will make this
+quite so real and vital to you as to see it actually breaking down human
+organisms, destroying life. I want you to get an eye for the thing as a
+whole:--see it as it is now, see the need of making it some other way.
+You must have more than a desire to help Karl--you must have an
+enthusiasm for the thing itself. You'll get so then that when you see an
+operation like this you won't see just some broken-down, diseased tissue
+that makes you feel weak-kneed, but you'll see something to get in and
+fight. Oh, it's a battle--so get your fighting blood up! Remember that
+you'll have to have enough for two. You know, what you must do for Karl
+is not only give him back the weapons with which to fight, but you must
+rouse his soldier's blood,--see what I mean?"
+
+It was a joy to watch the response. He could see weariness and
+discouragement slipping from her as she spoke.
+
+He was thinking to himself that she was superb, but aloud he said, "This
+is a good specimen in here. If you'll just come into the next room I'd
+like to go over it with you. I think I can make a few things clear."
+
+She was radiant then, happy that he had so soon forgotten her first
+failure, appreciating his assumption that she was ready even now to go on
+with the fight.
+
+"She will carry it through," thought Dr. Parkman, as he finally left the
+hospital. "And, by the good Lord, I believe that Karl Hubers is going to
+get back in the game and win! Nasty blow to the woman haters," he mused,
+as he looked in upon an office full of waiting patients,--"a very nasty
+blow."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+
+WITH BROKEN SWORD
+
+He wished that Ernestine would come home. He had let Ross go at four, and
+it was lonesome there alone. In spite of the fact that she was away so
+much, Ernestine was almost always there when he wanted her most. That was
+just one of the wonderful things about Ernestine. Something must have
+detained her to-day.
+
+He reached over on the table for his copy of "Faust." It had become his
+habit to pick it up when he did not care to sit face to face with his own
+thoughts. It seemed to hold some word for everything in life. Its
+universality made it a good friend.
+
+It was becoming easier to read with his fingers, but he had never come
+into the old joy in reading that there had been in the days when he could
+_see_ it. And it seemed to him that there was an unnecessary clumsiness
+about the whole thing. He had worked out a little idea of his own for
+which he was going to have a model made. He believed it might help
+some--at any rate he had enjoyed working it out. "If a fellow feels like
+inventing, he simply must invent something, whether it amounts to
+anything or not," he had explained to Ernestine.
+
+He did not read consecutively to-night, but just a line here and there,
+getting a little of wit, a little of philosophy, a dash or two of
+sarcasm, an occasional gleam of sentiment; he liked to take it that way
+at times like this; it seemed if not one thing, then surely another, must
+keep him from the things into which it would be so easy to slip to-night.
+
+"Restless activity proves the man!"--several times his fingers went over
+that, and his responsive face told that to his mind it brought a poignant
+meaning, and to his heart an understanding and a sadness. He closed the
+book, and sat there thinking. He seemed very self-contained--quiet,
+poised, but the understanding eye would have known that he was thinking
+deep thoughts, facing hard truths.
+
+Once at a horse race he had seen a horse which had just been lamed tied
+near the track. It heard the ringing of the gong, heard the music of the
+other horses' feet, heard, saw, smelled, sensed in every way the race
+that was going on. A weakness in one foot could not kill the spirit of a
+race horse. Tied there beside the track, watching others struggling for
+the race! He had wondered about that horse, then, had been sure from the
+quivering of its nostrils, the pawing of its foot, the passionate
+trembling of its whole superb body that it suffered. Thinking back to it
+to-night he had good reason to know that he had been right that day.
+
+It was queer about life. In some ways so incomprehensively great and
+superb, and yet so easy to be overthrown. Great purposes seemed very
+great, but was a thing really great when it was so easily undermined? Was
+there not a dizzying instability about it all?
+
+He smiled a little as he lighted his pipe. He seemed to be doing a great
+deal of speculating these days. What if he too were to be graduated into
+the bigger field of philosophy? But he shook his head, still smiling a
+little. If he ever entered the bigger field of philosophy he was sure he
+would not be carried there in other men's elevators, that he would not
+arrive in the jaunty, well-groomed state of Ross and his sort. No, if he
+ever found the bigger field of philosophy, it would be after he had
+scaled slippery crags and forded great rivers, after he had pushed his
+way through brambles and across sharp stones, after he had many times
+lost his footing, and had many times stopped to rest, believing he could
+go no farther. It was after some such quest that he might perhaps find
+his way up into the bigger field of philosophy. But he would not find
+Ross there. Ross and his fellows were down in a nice little garden that
+had been fixed up for them. That was it: the garden of philosophy,--a
+garden made by man, in which there were little artificial lakes and
+shrubbery set out in attractive designs. A very nice garden indeed, where
+the sun shone and where it was true pretty flowers would grow--but ah,
+one did not feel the wind upon one's face down in that sheltered garden
+as he believed one would feel it up there on the lonely heights to which
+one had climbed alone! And the garden of philosophy--he was smiling at
+his fancy, but it interested him--was electric lighted, while up there on
+the big wide sweep, one came very close to the stars.
+
+What was philosophy, anyway? With Ross it seemed a matter of speaking the
+vocabulary of philosophers. It was so, he knew, with many men. And yet,
+as to the thing itself, it was not a mere learning a system of thought,
+acquiring the easy use of a peculiar kind of words. It was not fair,
+after all, to judge a thing by the people least fitted to understand it.
+Perhaps philosophy was conquering life. Perhaps it was learning to take
+life in good part, making up one's mind to write good text-books if it
+seemed certain the writing of text-books were to be one's part. Perhaps
+it was just holding one's place. The mere thing of holding one's place
+seemed a bigger thing now than it once had. He wondered. He was wondering
+about many things these days, and perhaps he had already scaled a crag or
+two, for he was able sometimes, in spite of the deep sadness of his face,
+to smile a little in his wonderings.
+
+Ernestine was her sweetest self when she came in a little later. "I'm
+glad you were late," he said, after her affectionate protestations
+regarding her shortcomings, "you haven't been this nice for a long time."
+
+She threw aside her hat and coat and took her favourite place on the low
+seat beside him. "Don't you remember, liebchen, how it was over there in
+Europe--after you'd treated me badly, you were always so nice, that I
+used to be quite tempted to make you be horrid?"
+
+"I never was horrid to you," she protested.
+
+"You're never horrid any more," he said, and, strangely enough, he said
+it sadly.
+
+"Well, do you _want_ me to be?"
+
+"Yes! I wish you'd turn in once in a while and call me an old brute, and
+say you wished you'd never seen me, and didn't know how in heaven's name
+you were going to go on living with me!"
+
+"Karl," she gasped--"are you going _crazy_?"
+
+"No--at least I hope not. But you're just nice to me all the time,
+because--because I'm blind! I don't like it! I wish you'd _swear_ at me
+sometimes!"
+
+"Well, in the first place," laughing, but serious too,--it had come so
+heatedly, "it isn't my way to swear at any one. I never did swear at you.
+Why should I begin now?"
+
+"Oh, swear was figurative language," he laughed.
+
+"And of all things for a man to harrow up his soul about! Not liking it
+because his wife is never horrid to him!"
+
+"It's not as crazy as it sounds. Are you and I a couple of plaster
+saints? Well, hardly! Then why don't we have any quarrels? It's just
+because you're sorry for me! I'll not have you being sorry for me!" he
+concluded, almost angrily.
+
+But when she kissed him, he could not resist a smile. "You don't know
+much, do you, Karl? Don't you know that we don't quarrel about little
+things, because we've had so many big things on hand? We don't swear at
+each other, because--"
+
+"Because we have so many other things to swear at," he finished for her.
+
+"That's it. All our fighting emotion is being used up."
+
+"Oh, you're such a genius for making things seem right! Now looking at it
+that way, I'm quite reconciled to your being nice to me. Still I want you
+to promise that if you ever feel like swearing, you will."
+
+"I promise," she responded solemnly.
+
+"Don't do things--or not do things--because you're sorry for me,
+Ernestine."
+
+"We are 'sorry for' people who are unequal to things. I'm sorry with you,
+not for you, Karl."
+
+"Ernestine,"--with an affectionate little laugh--"is there _anything_ you
+don't understand?"
+
+"You might play a little for me," he said after a silence. "Play that
+thing that ends in a question."
+
+"Of Liszt's?"
+
+"Yes; the one that leaves you wondering."
+
+At first she had resented bitterly her not being able to play more
+satisfyingly. If only music were her work! It seemed an almost malicious
+touch that fate, in taking away Karl's own work, had also shut him out
+from hers. Resentment at that had made it hard for her to play for him at
+all, at first. But she had overcome that, and had been able to make music
+mean much to them both. They loved especially the music which seemed to
+translate for them things within their own hearts.
+
+But to-night when Ernestine had left him pondering a minute the question
+he said Liszt always left with him, she turned, eagerly it seemed, to
+lighter things. She played a little Nevin, played it with a lightness,
+gladsomeness, he had never felt in her touch before. He said Nevin helped
+him to see things, that he could see leaves moving on their branches,
+could see the shadows falling on the hillsides where the cattle were
+grazing, as he listened to Nevin. But it did not bring the pictures
+to-night. It opened up new fears.
+
+"Ernestine," he said abruptly, "come here."
+
+"Are you ever frightened, Ernestine?" he asked of her, still in that
+abrupt, strange manner.
+
+"Frightened--about what?"
+
+"Frightened about having to live all your life with me!"
+
+For a moment she did not answer. Then, her voice quiet with the quiet
+that would hold back anger: "Karl, do you think you are treating me very
+kindly to-night? Saying these strange things I cannot understand?"
+
+"But, Ernestine--look here! You're young--beautiful--love life. Doesn't
+it ever occur to you that you're not getting enough fun out of things?"
+
+"Karl,"--and there was a quivering in the voice now--"do you think I have
+been thinking lately about 'getting fun out of things'?"
+
+"No, but that's just it! You _ought_ to be thinking about it!
+Ernestine--_think_ of it! How are you going to go on forever loving a
+blind man?"
+
+For answer, she knelt down beside him, her arms about his neck, her cheek
+against his.
+
+"Yes--I know--in that way. But in the old way of the first days? I was so
+different then. How _can_ you love me now, the way you did then? What do
+I do now but sit in a chair and try to be patient? Look at a man like
+Parkman! That's life. Ernestine"--drawing her close, a sob in his
+voice--"liebchen,--_can_ you?"
+
+She longed to tell him then; it would mean so much to tell him now,--Karl
+was so troubled to-night. But the time was not ripe yet; she must not
+spoil it all. And so instead she talked to him of how real power
+comprehended more than activity, how depth of understanding, great things
+of the soul, were more masterful than those outer forces men called
+"life." Ernestine seldom failed in being convincing when she felt things
+as she now felt this.
+
+"You always have the right word," he said at last. "You can always get
+ahead of the little blue devils."
+
+"Oh, Karl," she murmured, very low, her heart too full to resist
+this--"some day I can show you better what I expect of life."
+
+"Of course," he mused, after a silence, "you have your work."
+
+"Yes," replied Ernestine, and something in her voice puzzled him, "I have
+my work."
+
+He would have been startled could he have seen her face just then. For
+Ernestine was so happy to-night. She had come away from the hospital with
+a song in her heart; a song of resolution and of triumph. She had never
+foreseen the future so clearly; the time had never seemed so close at
+hand; it had never been this real before. Just in front of her as she sat
+there beside Karl was the Gloria Victis, that statue for which he had
+cared so little at first, but which in these later days she often found
+him dwelling upon with his hands in lingering touch of appreciation. To
+her the statue had come to hold many meanings; she looked at it now with
+shining eyes. Karl had held so tight to the broken sword--how splendid
+then that he should win the fight despite it all.
+
+And she felt she had never risen so completely to the idea of Karl's
+greatness as she did to-day. What was there in the afternoon had meant so
+much to her? Was it actually seeing things as they were, or was it the
+things Dr. Parkman had said to point the way anew? There was to-night a
+new tide of appreciation, a larger understanding, more passionate
+response to this thought of Karl as greatest of them all. Looking at
+his face as he sat there in deep thought, she saw the marks of his
+greatness upon it just as plainly as she saw those other marks of his
+suffering.--This man stop work? Such as he out of the race?
+
+She remembered the letters they had received when the news of his
+blindness had gone out. She had wept over them many times, but it seemed
+she had never grasped their significance before. They were from men of
+science, from doctors, from students, and from many plain people unknown
+outside their small communities, who wrote to say they were sorry. They
+had seen about him once or twice in the magazines, they said, or perhaps
+their own doctor at home had told them of him, and they were so
+interested because their wife or husband or mother had died of cancer,
+and they knew what an awful thing it was. It should have been some one
+whom the world needed less than it needed him, these plain people said.
+
+Her eyes filled with a rush of tears. This was her Karl--he with whom all
+the world grieved! She recalled the editorials in the scientific papers,
+telling of the things he had done, the things it had been believed by
+them all he would achieve. This was her Karl!--this man whose withdrawal
+from active participation had been told of by great scientists everywhere
+as a world-wide calamity. How quiet and unassuming and simple he had been
+about it all--he whose stepping-out had been felt around the world!
+
+And, now, some day before long she would come to him with: "Karl, I have
+found a new way of fighting with broken swords; take a good grip on the
+sword, a good strong grip, and let us turn back to the fight!"
+
+She turned to him with that quick passionateness he loved in her so well.
+"I love you," she said, and though she had said it many times in other
+days, it had never sounded just like that before.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+
+UNPAINTED MASTERPIECES
+
+Georgia was to be married. It was the week before Christmas, and on the
+last day of the year she would become Mrs. Joseph Tank. She had told Joe
+that if they were to be married at all they might as well get it over
+with this year, and still there was no need of being married any earlier
+in the year than was necessary. She assured him that she married him
+simply because she was tired of having paper bags waved before her eyes
+everywhere she went, and she thought if she were once officially
+associated with him people would not flaunt his idiosyncrasies at her
+that way. And then Ernestine approved of getting married, and Ernestine's
+ideas were usually good. To all of which Joe responded that she certainly
+had a splendid head to figure it out that way. Joe said that to his mind
+reasons for doing things weren't very important anyhow; it was doing them
+that counted.
+
+Yesterday had been her last day on the paper. She had felt queer about
+that thing of taking her last assignment, though it was hard to reach
+just the proper state, for the last story related to pork-packers, and
+pork-packing is not a setting favourable to sentimental regrets. It was
+just like the newspaper business not even to allow one a little
+sentimental harrowing over one's exodus from it. But the time for gentle
+melancholy came later on, when she was sorting her things at her desk
+just before leaving, and was wondering what girl would have that old
+desk--if they cared to risk another girl, and whether the other poor girl
+would slave through the years she should have been frivolous, only to
+have some man step in at the end and induce her to surrender the things
+she had gained through sacrifice and toil. As she wrote a final letter on
+her typewriter--she did hate letting the old machine go--Georgia did
+considerable philosophising about the irony of working for things only to
+the end of giving them up. She had waded through snowdrifts and been
+drenched in pouring rains, she had been frozen with the cold and
+prostrated with the heat, she had been blown about by Chicago wind until
+it was strange there was any of her left in one piece, she had had front
+doors--yes, and back doors too, slammed in her face, she had been the
+butt of the alleged wit of menials and hirelings, she had been patronised
+by vapid women as the poor girl who must make her living some way, she
+had been roasted by--but never mind--she had had a beat or two! And now
+she was to wind it all up by marrying Joseph Tank, who had made a great
+deal of money out of the manufacture of paper bags. This from her--who
+had always believed she would end her days in New York, or perhaps write
+a realistic novel exposing some mighty evil!
+
+"Ah, well--it's all in the day's work!"--she had been saying that to
+herself as she covered her typewriter, and then, just as she was fearing
+that her exit would be a maudlin one, Joe called up to say that he did
+not think it would be too cold for the machine, and why not spin out
+somewhere on the North Shore for a good dinner? Now that had been nice of
+Joe, for it tided her over the good-byes.
+
+To-day she was engaged in the pre-nuptial rite of destroying her past,
+indulging in the letter destroying ceremonial which seems always to
+attend the eve of matrimony. It was so that Ernestine found her when she
+stopped on her way from the university that afternoon.
+
+Mrs. McCormick was sewing yards upon yards of lace on something when
+Ernestine came in. "She's right in there," she said, referring to Georgia
+in a sepulchral tone which might fittingly have been employed for: "The
+remains have been laid out in the front room."
+
+Georgia herself, though not sepulchral, was subdued. "My, but I'm glad
+you've come," she said, brushing aside several hundred letters that
+Ernestine might have a place to sit down. "I'm having the most terrible
+twinge of conscience."
+
+"Why, what about?"
+
+Georgia pointed to the clock. "Think of my not being at the office! I
+ought to be hanging around now for an afternoon assignment."
+
+"You'll get over that," Ernestine assured her, cheerfully.
+
+"Oh, I suppose so. One gets over everything--even being alive. Meanwhile,
+behold me,"--with a great sweep of her arms--"surrounded by my blighting
+past."
+
+"That one looks like Freddie Allen's writing," said Ernestine, giving an
+envelope at her foot a little shove.
+
+"It is," said Georgia, with feeling; "yes--it is. Poor Freddie--he was
+such a nice boy."
+
+"I suppose he's nice still," observed Ernestine.
+
+"Oh, I suppose so. I'm sure I don't know. He's way back there in the dim
+past."
+
+"Well, do you want him up here in the sunny present?" Ernestine inquired,
+much entertained.
+
+"No, oh no--if I had wanted him I would have had him," with which
+reversion to the normal Georgia they laughed understandingly.
+
+She shook herself free of the dust of her past then, piled up the pillows
+and settled herself on the bed. "But we had some good times back there in
+the dim past, didn't we, Ernestine?"
+
+"Some of them were good times," replied Ernestine, a little soberly.
+
+"Of course our college life would have been happier if we had been able
+to pull down that sophomore flag. I've always thought Jack Stewart might
+have done a little better with that. But as long as we kept Jim Jones
+away from every party in his junior year, perhaps we should be
+satisfied." Georgia sighed heavily. "And it is a joy to think back to
+your telling the dean he didn't have the courage of his convictions when
+he let them fire Stone for heresy. Oh there are a good many things to be
+thankful for. You always had lots of nerve when it came to a show-down.
+You looked so lady-like, and yet you really weren't at all."
+
+"Well, I don't know whether I like that or not."
+
+"I mean not so lady-like that it interfered with anything you wanted to
+do. You'd speak up in the pleasantest, most agreeable voice and say the
+most dreadful things. I'll never forget the day you told "Prof" Moore in
+class that you had always had a peculiar aversion to the Pilgrim
+Fathers."
+
+"I always did," Ernestine said fervently.
+
+"Then one day when we had spent an hour trying to tell what Shakespeare
+meant by some line you said you thought quite likely he put it in just
+because there had to be another line. And "Prof" Jennings conditioned you
+on the whole year's work--remember?"
+
+"I have reason to," laughed Ernestine.
+
+"The funny part of it was that you never seemed to think you were saying
+anything startling. Like the day you contended in ethics that you thought
+frequently it was better to be pleasant than truthful. Kitty Janeway was
+so shocked at that. I wonder if Kitty Janeway is any happier with her
+second husband than she was with her first?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know," said Ernestine in a rather far-away voice.
+
+"I'll send all the girls cards," said Georgia, and again she sighed
+heavily. "The cards are going to look very nice," she added, a little
+more hopefully.
+
+"Ernestine?"--after a little pause.
+
+"Yes?"
+
+"You and I are hanging right over the ragged edge of thirty."
+
+"Horrors!--Georgia; is this your idea of furnishing pleasant
+entertainment for a guest?"
+
+"But I was just thinking how many things have happened to us since we
+were twenty-two."
+
+"I was thinking of that a minute ago myself."
+
+"To you, especially. Now, I never supposed when we were in college that
+you were going to marry Karl Hubers."
+
+"No," laughed Ernestine, "neither did I."
+
+"I mean I never associated you two with one another. And now I can't
+think of you separately. And then your father and mother, and then Karl
+losing--heavens, but I'm cheerful! Now, isn't it just like me," she
+demanded, angrily, "to act like a fool just because I'm going to be
+married? If I keep on I'll find myself weeping because Socrates is dead.
+And I never do weep, either. I tell you that Joe Tank's a terrible man,"
+she laughed, brushing away some tears.
+
+"I don't think you're going to have much to weep about, Georgia. I know
+you're going to be happy."
+
+"Well, if I'm not it won't be Joe's fault. Unless it is his fault on
+account of its _not_ being his fault. What I mean is that good-natured
+people are sometimes aggravating."
+
+"Oh he'll not always be good-natured," she reassured her.
+
+Ernestine said then that she must go, and was standing at the door when
+Georgia burst forth: "Oh Ernestine--I'm so glad I remembered. You really
+must go down to the Art Institute and see those pictures by that
+Norwegian artist--I shouldn't dream of pronouncing his name. They go away
+this week, and it would be awful for you to miss them."
+
+A wistfulness, fairly pain, revealed itself for an instant in Ernestine's
+face. And then, as if coming into consciousness of the look: "I know,"
+she said briefly. "I read about them. I've been--thinking about it. I did
+see some of them in Europe, but of course I should love to see them
+again."
+
+"I wish you would, my dear; perhaps"--a little fearfully--"they'd
+make you feel like getting to work yourself. Ernestine,"--gathering
+courage--"it's awful for you to let your work go this way. Every one
+says so. I was talking to Ryan the other day--you know who he is? He
+asked all about you, and if you were doing anything now, and when I told
+him I was afraid not he fairly flew into a rage, said that was just the
+way--the people who might be great didn't seem to have sense enough to
+care to be."
+
+That brought the quick colour. "Perhaps Mr. Ryan does not understand
+everything in life," she said, coolly.
+
+"Now, Ernestine--he was lovely about you. Would he have shown any feeling
+at all if he didn't care a great deal for your work? Does any one fly
+into a rage at _my_ not painting? He said you were _one_ American woman
+who was an artist instead of 'a woman who paints.' It seems he saw the
+Salon picture. Oh, he said beautiful things about you."
+
+Ernestine did not answer. She was standing there very quietly, her hand
+on the knob. "Now, Ernestine," Georgia went on, after the manner of one
+bound to have it out, "I've tried all winter to cultivate repression. I
+don't know what it is you are trying to do over there in the laboratory.
+You asked me to do two things--not to ask you about it, and not to
+mention it to Karl. I haven't done either, but I want to tell you right
+now if you have any idea of giving up your own work I think it's time for
+your friends to inquire into your mental workings! The very fact you
+don't want Karl to know about it shows you know very well _he_ won't
+think it's right. Anything that relates to his work can be done by people
+who do that kind of work a great deal better than you can. Really,
+Ernestine, the thing is positively fanatical. And anyway,"--this with the
+air of delivering the overpowering--"I don't think it is at all nice the
+way you are taking other men into your confidence and deceiving Karl."
+
+She met that with a little laugh. "Dear me--what laudable sentiment. I've
+always heard there was no one half so proper as the girl about to be
+married. Never mind, Georgia,"--a little more seriously, a little as if
+it would not be hard to cry--"Karl will forgive me--some day."
+
+"But, Ernestine, I want you to work! Can't you see how awful it is for
+you not to--express yourself?"
+
+"I am going to express myself," she answered, lightly enough, but after
+she had gone Georgia wondered just what she had meant by that.
+
+She decided, when she came out of the apartment building, that she would
+take a little walk. It was just cold enough to be exhilarating, and she
+felt the need of something bracing. She was wishing as she walked along
+very fast, responding to the keen, good air, that Karl were with her now.
+Karl did not exercise enough, and when he did yield to her supplications
+and go for a walk with her he did not seem to enjoy it as she wished he
+might. "After a while, liebchen," he would say. "I'll be more accustomed
+to things after a while. And meanwhile there's plenty of fresh air right
+here in our back yard." "But it isn't just getting the fresh air," she
+would protest, "it's enjoying it while you're getting it."--"Wait till
+spring comes," he would sometimes answer. "I'm going to get out more
+then."
+
+When she saw she was near one of the stations of the Illinois Central she
+stopped, a little confused. Could it be she had meant all the time to
+come here? Looking to the south, she saw that at the next station, not
+three blocks away, the train which would take her to the city in ten
+minutes was just arriving. The Art Institute was only two blocks from the
+Van Buren Street station;--those facts associated themselves quickly in
+her mind. She looked at her watch: not quite three. Karl had said he
+would be busy with Mr. Ross until five. She stood there in hesitation.
+She had seen no pictures since--oh it was too long ago to remember. What
+harm could it do her? And anyway--this with something of the uprising of
+the truant child--it was Christmas time! Every one else was taking a
+vacation, why--but here it was all swept into the imperative
+consciousness that she had no time to lose, and she was at the ticket
+window before she was quite sure that she had made up her mind.
+
+It was all so strange then; exhilaration mounted high for a little while,
+but there followed a very tense excitement. She tried to laugh at
+herself, contend that she was coming for enjoyment, relaxation, that it
+was absurd to go to pieces this way; but things long suppressed called
+for their own, and the man to whom she gave her admission fee wondered
+for a long time after she had passed him just what it was about her
+seemed so strange.
+
+How good it was! How good to be back among her own kind of things! In the
+laboratory every one knew more than she did; there she was repressed,
+humble even, gratefully accepting the crumbs of knowledge falling from
+their tables. It was good to feel for a little while that she was some
+place where she knew a great deal about things. She wished Mr. Willard or
+Mr. Beason would happen along that she might give them some insight into
+the colossalness of their ignorance.
+
+She turned down the corridor leading to the room where she would find the
+special exhibit. She stopped before many of the pictures--reverting to
+that joy of the spirit in dominance. There was exultation, almost
+rapture, in this quick, firm rush of understanding; deep joy in just
+knowing the good from the bad.
+
+But when she reached the pictures she had come to see it was different.
+She walked to the middle of the room, and in one slow sweep of glance,
+punctuated with long pauses, took them in. And she responded to them with
+a warm, glad rush of tears.
+
+They fell upon her artist's soul as the very lovely rain upon the thirsty
+meadow. They drew her to them as the mother the homesick child, and like
+the homesick child, back at last after weary days, she knew only that she
+had come home. In this first overflowing moment there was no thought of
+colour--brush work--this or that triumphant audacity; it was a coming to
+her own, a home-coming of the spirit--the heart's passionate
+thankfulness, the heart's response.
+
+A few minutes of reverent pause, a high delight, deep response, and
+then--the inevitable. Clear as a bell upon the midnight air was that call
+from soul to kindred soul. Assurance and longing and demand possessed her
+beyond all power to stay. The work she stood before now called to her as
+naturally and inevitably as the bird to its mate, as undeniably as the
+sea to the river, as potently as spring calls upon earth for its own, as
+autumn calls to summer for harvest time.
+
+It frightened her. It seemed something within her over which she had no
+control. It surged through her as far beyond all reason as the tides of
+the sea are beyond the hand of man. It was procreative power demanding
+fulfillment as the child ready for birth demands that it be born.
+
+She was conscious of some one's having come into the room. That her face
+might not be seen she turned away and sat down before one of the
+pictures. She was quivering so passionately that it seemed almost
+impossible to hold herself within command.
+
+The girl who had come in was moving restlessly from one picture to
+another; at last she walked over and sat down on the seat by Ernestine.
+
+"I think I like this one best," she said, abruptly, nodding to the
+picture before them.
+
+Ernestine nodded in reply. She was not sure what would happen were she to
+speak. The girl she supposed to be one of the students there.
+
+"I would give anything in the world--just anything in the world--if I
+could do it too!"
+
+At the passion of that she turned quickly and looked at the girl. In
+spite of the real feeling of her tone a fretful look was predominant in
+her face.
+
+"Do you--work hard?" she asked, merely to relieve the pause.
+
+"Work--yes; but mere work won't do it. I can't do anything like
+this,"--it was in bitterness she said it.
+
+"Very few can, you know," murmured Ernestine.
+
+"Yes--but I want to! I don't care anything about life--I don't care
+anything about anything--if I can't paint!"
+
+It struck her immediately as so entirely wrong. She looked at the girl,
+and then again at the pictures. All the great things they conveyed were
+passing her by. She missed the essence of it. The greatness of the work
+merely moved her to anger because she was not great herself. It was an
+attitude to close the soul.
+
+"But you should care for life," she said, in her very gentle way. "Do the
+best you can with your own work, but work like this should, above
+everything else, make you care for life."
+
+The girl moved impatiently. "You don't understand. I guess you are not an
+artist," and she rose and went away.
+
+Ernestine smiled a trifle, but the strange little interview had opened up
+a long vista. The girl represented, in extreme measure, but
+fundamentally, the professional attitude. Most artists saw work in
+relation to themselves. Pictures were either better or worse than they
+could do. They came to the great things like these, seeking something,
+usually some mechanical device, to take away to their own work. She could
+see so plainly now the shallowness of that.
+
+Her own mood had changed,--broken. Perhaps it was the consciousness that
+she too had been seeing it in relation to herself, or it may have been
+but natural reaction. The big uprising was dying down; the heat of the
+passion had passed; it was all different now, and in the wake of her
+brimming moment there came the calm that follows storm, the sadness of
+spirit which attends the re-enthronement of reason, but also the
+understanding, far-seeingness, which is the aftermath of great passion
+like that.
+
+There had come to her, as she sat there beside the girl, a throbbing
+determination to do both things. The thought had come before, but always
+to be banished. It came now with new insistence just because anything
+else seemed so impossible. There had never come, even to the outermost
+edge of her consciousness, the thought of giving up the work she was
+going to do for Karl. Her hardest hour had never even suggested the
+possibility of surrender. Her love had seen its way; her life had been
+consecrated. But now, when it seemed no longer within her power to deny
+the work for which she had been ordained, it seemed that to fulfill both
+things was the one thing possible. But in this after-moment of unblurred
+understanding she saw she could do both things only by taking from the
+things she gave to Karl. It would mean giving her soul to the one, and
+what she had left to the other. And she knew that she could never do what
+she meant to do for Karl unless she gave everything within herself to
+that cause. The chief aim of her struggle in the laboratory had not been
+to acquire knowledge and usefulness--that she could do, she knew; her
+real aim had been to give to Karl's work the things she had always given
+to her own. With a divided soul she could do no more for him than any
+other assistant. She was seeking to give him herself. Oh no--it was
+simple enough; she had no thought of offering Karl an empty vessel.
+
+Her mind saw it all, her will never wavered, but the bruised, conquered
+spirit quivered under the pain. A long time she sat there, and as the
+hour went by a strange thing happened. The pictures were healing the
+spirit which they had torn. As they had first moved her to the frenzy
+for achievement, had then left her with the pain of relinquishment,
+they were bringing her now something of the balm of peace. How big they
+were!--first passion, then pain, then understanding, now strength.
+
+Ernestine came in that hour to see a great truth. It was something she
+worked out for herself, something taught her by life and her own heart,
+and that is why it reached her soul as it could never have done had she
+but read it in books. She came to see that the greatest thing in life was
+to be in harmony with the soul of the world. She came into the
+understanding that to do that, one need not of necessity paint great
+pictures, one need not stand for any specific achievement, one need only
+so work out one's life that one made for harmony and not for discord. The
+greatest thing pictures could do was to draw men into this world harmony.
+These pictures were great because they reached the soul, and she came to
+see, and this is what few do see, that the soul which is reached is not
+less great than the soul which has spoken. She too could have been one of
+the souls to speak; she accepted that in the simplicity with which we
+receive the indisputable, but it was good to think that she would not
+have failed utterly in fulfilling herself, if at the end, no matter
+through what, she made for harmony, and not for discord.
+
+She grew so quiet then: the quiet of deep understanding. A long time
+she sat before a picture of light out beyond some trees. Oh what a
+world--with the light coming through the trees like that, and men to see
+it, and make it seen! She wished Karl might see these pictures; she
+looked at them with a new intentness,--she would tell Karl all about
+them; he would be so glad she had come.
+
+She rose to go. Once more she looked around at the pictures, and to her
+eyes there came a dimness, and to her spirit a deep and tender yearning.
+There would be joy in having done such work as this. But there were other
+things! To work out one's life as bravely and well as one knew how, to do
+what seemed best, to be faithful and unfailing to those who were nearest
+one, to be willing to lay down one's life for one's love,--perhaps when
+the end of the world was reached, and all things translated in terms of
+universal things, to have done that would itself mean the painting of a
+masterpiece. Perhaps the God of things as they are would see the
+unpainted pictures.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+
+EYES FOR TWO
+
+"This day smells as though it had been made in the country," Karl said,
+leaning from the dining room window which Ernestine had thrown wide open
+as she rose from the breakfast table.
+
+"Yes, and looks that way," she responded, leaning out herself, and taking
+a long draught of the spring.
+
+"Let's take a walk," he said abruptly.
+
+"Except when you asked me to marry you--you never proposed a more
+delightful thing," she responded with gayer laugh than he had heard for a
+long time.
+
+"Suppose we walk down through the park and take a look at the lake," he
+suggested.
+
+"I call that a genuine inspiration!"--losing no time in getting Karl's
+things and her own.
+
+Nothing could have pleased her more than this. It seemed beginning the
+spring right.
+
+"I can fancy we are in Europe," he said, after they had gone a little
+way, and she laughed understandingly;--this seemed closer to the spirit
+of the old days than they had come for a long time.
+
+Her guiding hand was on his arm, but more as if she liked to have it
+there, than as though necessary. "Your little finger could pilot me
+through Hades" he said, lovingly, gratefully, as a light touch told him of
+a step to go down, and again she laughed; it was very easy to laugh this
+morning.
+
+The winter, full of hard things for them both, had gone now, and spring,
+as is spring's way, held promise. In the laboratory they no longer
+treated Ernestine with mere courteous interest. That day in December when
+she went down to Dr. Parkman's operation had marked a change. Since then
+there had been a light ahead, a light which shed its rays down the path
+she must go.
+
+What did it matter if she were a little stupid about this or that, if Mr.
+Beason was unconsciously rude or Mr. Willard consciously polite? For she
+_knew_ now--and did anything matter save the final things? With her own
+feeling of its not mattering their attitude had seemed to change; she
+became more as one with them--she was quick to get that difference.
+"You're arriving on the high speed," Dr. Parkman had assured her when he
+visited the laboratory a few days before.
+
+So she knew why she was happy, for added to all that was it not a
+glorious and propitious thing that Karl felt like taking a walk? Did it
+not argue a new interest in life--a new determination not to be shut off
+from it? And Karl--why did he too seem to feel that the spring held new
+and better things? Was it just the call of spring, or did Karl sense the
+good things ahead? Could it be that her soul, unable to contain itself
+longer, had whispered to his that new days were coming?
+
+"Why, even a fellow on his way to the penitentiary for life would have to
+get some enjoyment out of this morning," he said, after they had stood
+still for a minute to listen to the song of a bird, and had caught the
+sweetness of a flowering tree.
+
+"And oh, Karl," she laughed, joyously, "you're _not_ on your way to the
+penitentiary for life."
+
+"No," he said, and he seemed to be speaking to something within himself
+rather than to her,--"I'm _not_!"
+
+They had reached Jackson Park, and sat down for a little rest before they
+should wend their way on to the lake. "Oh, Ernestine," he said, taking it
+in in long breaths, feeling the dew upon his face, and hearing the murmur
+of many living things,--"_tell_ me about it, dear. I want to see it too!"
+
+"Karl--every tree looks as though it were just as glad as we are! Can't
+you feel that the trees feel just as we do about things? The leaves
+haven't all come out yet, some of them are holding themselves within
+themselves in a coy little way they have--although intending all the time
+to come out just as fast as ever they can. And it's that glorious,
+unspoiled green--the kind nature uses to make painters feel foolish. Oh,
+nature's having much fun with the painters this morning. Right over
+there,"--pointing with his finger--"is such a beautiful tree. I like it
+because all of its branches did not go in the way they were expected to
+go. Several of them were very perverse children, who mother trunk thought
+at one time were going to ruin her life, but you know lives aren't so
+easily ruined after all. 'Now you go right up there at an angle of
+twenty-two degrees,' she said to her eldest child. 'Not at all,' said the
+firstborn, 'I intend to lean right over here at whatsoever angle will
+best express my individuality.' And though the mother grieved for a long
+time she knows now--Karl--how foolish we are! But listen. You hear that
+bird who is trying to get all of his soul into his throat at once? He's
+'way up there on the top branch, higher than everything else, and so
+pleased and proud that he is, and he's singing to a little blue cloud
+straight above him, and I tell you I never saw such blue--such blue
+within blue. Its outside dress is a very filmy blue, but that's made over
+an under dress of deeper blue, and there's just a little part in it where
+you can see right into the heart, and that's a blue so deep and rich it
+makes you want to cry. And oh, Karl--the heart itself has opened a little
+now, and you can get a suggestion, just a very indefinite suggestion--but
+then all inner things are indefinite--that inside the heart of the cloud
+is its soul, and you are permitted one fleeting glimpse to tell you that
+the soul of the cloud is such a blue as never was dreamed of on land or
+on sea."
+
+"I can see that cloud," he said,--"and the bird looking up at it, and the
+tree whose eldest child was so perverse and so--individual."
+
+"And, Karl," she went on, in joyous eagerness, "can't you see how the
+earth heaved a sigh right here a couple of hundred centuries ago--now
+_don't_ tell me the park commissioners made them!--and that when it
+settled back from its sigh it never was quite the same again? It was
+a sigh of content--for the little slopes are so gentle. Gentle little
+hills are sighs of content, and bigger ones are determinations, and
+mountains--what are mountains, Karl?"
+
+"Mountains are revolutionary instincts," he said, smiling at her
+fancifulness--Ernestine was always fanciful when she was happy.
+
+"Yes, that's it. Sometimes I like the stormy upheavals which change the
+whole face of the earth, but this morning it's nice to have just the
+little sighs of content. And, dear--now turn around and look this way.
+You can't really see the lake at all--but you can tell by looking down
+that way that it is there."
+
+"How can you tell, liebchen?" he asked, just to hear her talk.
+
+"Oh, I don't know _how_ you can. It's not scientific knowledge--it's--the
+other kind. The trees know that the lake is there."
+
+"Let's walk down to the lake," he said. "I want to feel it on my face.
+And oh, liebchen--it's good to have you tell about things like this."
+
+As they walked she told him of all she saw: the people they met, and what
+she was sure the people were thinking about. Once she laughed aloud, and
+when he asked what she was laughing at, she said, "Oh, that chap we just
+passed was amusing. His eyes were saying--'My allowance is all gone and I
+haven't a red sou--but isn't it a bully day?'"
+
+"There's no reason why I should be shut out from the world, Ernestine,"
+he said vigorously, "when you have eyes for two."
+
+"Why, that's just what I think!" she said, quickly, her voice low, and
+her heart beating fast.
+
+The shadows upon the grass, the nursemaids and the babies, the boys and
+girls playing tennis, or just strolling around happy to be alive--she
+could make Karl see them all. And as they came in sight of the lake she
+began telling him how it looked in the distance, how it seemed at first
+just a cloud dropped down from the sky, but how, upon coming nearer, it
+was not the stuff that clouds are made of, but a live thing, a great live
+thing pulsing with joy in the morning sunshine. She told him how some of
+it was blue and some of it was green, while some of it was blue wedded to
+green, and some of it too elusive to have anything to do with the
+spectrum. "And, dearie--it is flirting with the sunlight--flirting
+shamefully; I'm almost ashamed for the lake, only it's so happy in its
+flirtation that perhaps it is not bothered with moral consciousness. But
+it seems to want the sunlight to catch it, and then it seems to want to
+get away, and sometimes a sunbeam gets a little wave that stayed too long
+and kisses it right here in open day--and isn't it awful--but isn't it
+nice?"
+
+In so many ways she told how the lake seemed to her--how it seemed to her
+eyes and how it seemed to her heart and how it seemed to her soul, how it
+looked, what it said, what it meant; what the clouds thought of it, and
+what the sunlight thought of it, what the wind thought of it, what the
+dear babies on the shore thought of it, and what it thought of itself.
+She could not have talked that way to any one else, but it was so easy
+for her heart to talk to Karl's heart. One pair of eyes could do just as
+well as two when hearts were tuned like this!
+
+And then, when she did not feel like talking any more, they stood there
+and learned many things from the voice of the lake itself. "Ernestine,"
+he said, when they turned from it at last, "it seems to me I never saw
+Lake Michigan quite so well before."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+
+SCIENCE AND SUPER-SCIENCE
+
+"Insubordinate children who play off from school in the morning must work
+in the afternoon," Karl said at luncheon, and they went to their work
+that afternoon with freshened spirit.
+
+When the McCormicks gave up their flat at Christmas time, Beason had come
+to live with the Hubers. Ernestine prided herself upon some cleverness in
+having rented two rooms without Karl's suspecting it was a matter of
+renting the rooms. When he engaged Ross as his secretary in the fall she
+said it would be more convenient for them all for Mr. Ross to have his
+room there. They had an extra room, so why not? She did not put it the
+other way--that she felt the house more expensive than they should have
+now. Of course Karl would make money in his books--that had been settled
+in advance, but things had changed for them, and Ernestine felt the need
+of caution. Then as to Beason, she said there was that little room he
+could have, and it would do the boy good to be there. "You like John,"
+she said to Karl, "and as he has not yet been graduated into philosophy,
+he may be more companionable than Mr. Ross." And Karl said by all means
+to have Beason if it wouldn't bother her to have him around.
+
+She was glad of that for more reasons than a reduced rent; Beason had
+become a great help to Ernestine. After he came there to live they fitted
+up some things for her in her studio, and she managed to get in a number
+of extra hours when Karl thought she was busy with her pictures.
+
+In her glow of spirit this afternoon--that walk in the park had meant so
+much as holding promise for the future--Ernestine was even willing to
+admit, looking back upon it, that the winter had not been nearly so bad
+as one would suppose. Mr. Beason and Mr. Ross were both, in their
+differing ways, alert and interesting, and there had been some good
+wrangles around the evening fire. Other people had found them out, and
+they had drawn to them an interesting group of friends. So the days had
+flowed steadily on, a brave struggle to meet life in good part, keep that
+good-fellowship of the spirit.
+
+One of the hardest things of all had been deceiving Karl. Her reason
+justified it, but it hurt her heart. They had been able to do it,
+however, better than she would have believed possible. Mr. Ross was with
+him most of the time when she was not, and had frequently been forced to
+intercept some caller who was close to an innocent remark about Mrs.
+Hubers being over at the university. Several times Karl had caught the
+odour of the laboratory about her, and she had been forced to explain it
+as the odour of the studio; and more than once, in the midst of a
+discussion, her interest had beguiled her into some surprisingly
+intelligent remark, and she had been obliged to invent laughing reasons
+for knowing anything about it. It hurt her deeply to take advantage of
+Karl's blindness in keeping things from him, even though the motive was
+all love for Karl, and determination to help. She would be so glad when
+all that was over, and she thought as she worked along very hard that
+afternoon that perhaps it would not be many days now until Karl should
+know.
+
+That would be for Dr. Parkman to say; so many vital things seemed left to
+Dr. Parkman. "Did you ever think," she said, turning to Mr. Beason, who
+was busy at the table beside her, "what the doctor really counts for in
+this world?"
+
+"Yes--in a way," said Beason, adjusting his microscope, "but then I never
+was sick much."
+
+"Well, I didn't mean just taking one's pulse," she laughed. "It seems to
+me they mean more than prescriptions. For one thing, I think it's rather
+amusing the way they all practice Christian Science."
+
+"Why--what do you mean?" he demanded, aroused now, and shocked.
+
+"Oh, I've come to the conclusion that a modern, first-class doctor is a
+Christian Scientist who preserves his sanity"--she paused, laughing a
+little at Beason's bewildered face, and at the thought of how little her
+formula would be appreciated in either camp. "I've noticed it down at Dr.
+Parkman's office," she went on. "It's quite a study to listen to him at
+the telephone. He will wrangle around all sorts of corners to get
+patients to admit something is in better shape than it was yesterday, and
+though they called up to say they were worse, they end in admitting they
+are much better. He just forces them into saying something is better, and
+then he says, triumphantly, 'Oh--that's fine!'--and the patient rings off
+immensely cheered up."
+
+"That's a kind of trickery, though," said Beason.
+
+"Pretty good kind of trickery, if it helps people get well."
+
+"Well I shouldn't care to be a practicing physician," Beason declared,
+"just for that reason. That sort of business would be very distasteful to
+me."
+
+Ernestine was about to say something, and then relegated it to the things
+better left unsaid; but she permitted herself a wise little smile.
+
+"I don't think it's such an awfully high grade of work," he went on. "In
+a way it is--of course. But there's so much repetition and routine; so
+much that doesn't count scientifically at all--doesn't count for anything
+but the patient."
+
+"But what is science for?" she demanded, aggravated now. "Has medical
+science any value save in its relation to human beings?"
+
+"Oh yes, I know--in the end," he admitted vaguely.
+
+"All this laboratory work is simply to throw more power into the hands of
+the general practitioner. It's to give him more light. It's just because
+his work _is_ so important that this work has any reason for being. Dr.
+Hubers saw it that way," she concluded, with the air of delivering the
+unanswerable.
+
+"But even that wasn't just what I meant," she went on, after they had
+worked silently for a few minutes. "What I was thinking about was the
+superdoctor."
+
+Beason simply stared.
+
+"No, not entirely crazy," she laughed. "For instance: what can a man do
+for nervous indigestion without infusing a little hope? Think of what
+doctors know--not only about people's bodies, but about their lives.
+Cause and effect overlap--don't they? Half the time a run down body means
+a broken spirit, or a twisted life. How can you set part of a thing right
+when the whole of it's wrong? How _can_ a doctor be just a doctor--if
+he's a good one?"
+
+But nothing "super" could be expected of Beason. His very blank face
+recalled her to the absurdity of getting out of focus with one's
+audience.
+
+She herself felt it strongly. It seemed to her that Dr. Parkman's real
+gift was his endowment in intuition. When all was going well she heard
+nothing from him; but let things begin to drag, and the doctor appeared,
+rich in resources. He seemed to have in reserve a wide variety of
+stimulants.
+
+He looked in upon them often. Whenever in their neighbourhood he stopped,
+and though frequently he could not so much as take time to sit down,
+the day always went a little better for his coming. "If the end of the
+world were upon us, Dr. Parkman could avert the calamity for a day or
+two--couldn't he, Karl?" Ernestine had laughed after one of his visits.
+
+This proved to be one of the days of his stopping in, and he arrived just
+as Karl was dictating a few final sentences to Mr. Ross. While they were
+finishing--he said he was not in a hurry today--he took a keen look at
+Karl's face. His colour was not good--the doctor thought; in fact several
+things were not to his liking. "Too many hard times with himself," he
+summed it up.--"Droopy. Needs a bracer. Needs to get back in the
+harness--that's the only medicine for him."
+
+He had been thinking about that very seriously of late. Ernestine was at
+least in position now to show the possibilities of the situation, and
+working with Karl would do more for her in a month than working along
+this way would do in five. Why not? No matter how long they waited it was
+going to be hard at first. The deep lines in Karl's face furnished the
+strongest argument against further waiting.
+
+"What have we here?" he asked, picking up one of the embossed books lying
+open on the table near Karl.
+
+"I presume that's my Bible," Karl replied.
+
+"Has it come to this?" the doctor asked dryly.
+
+"Didn't we ever tell you the story of my Bible?"
+
+"No. You never did. I never suspected you had one."
+
+"Oh yes; the Bible was the first book of this sort I had. It was sent to
+me by some home missionary society, some woman's organization--"
+
+"Fools!" broke in Parkman.
+
+"They saw in the paper about my eyes and so they said to themselves--'Now
+here is a good chance to convert one of those ungodly scientists.' So
+they sent the Bible along with a nice little note saying that now I
+would have time to read it, and perhaps all of this was the hand of
+God leading me--you can construct the rest. Well." he paused with a
+laugh--"Ernestine was mad."
+
+"I should hope so!" growled Parkman.
+
+"She was so divinely angry that in having fun with her I overlooked being
+enraged myself. Oh, if I could only give you any idea of how incensed she
+was! I think she intended notifying the Chicago police. Really I don't
+know to what lengths she would have gone had it not been for my
+restraining influence. And then she constructed a letter. It was a
+masterpiece--I can tell you that. She compared me to them--greatly to
+their disadvantage. She spoke of the various kinds of religious
+manifestation--again greatly to their disadvantage."
+
+"Did she send it?" laughed the doctor.
+
+"No. I persuaded her that well-intentioned people should receive the same
+kindly tolerance we extend to the mentally defective. The writing of the
+letter in itself half way contented her--it was such a splendid
+expression of her emotions. Poor old girl," he added musingly, "she was
+feeling pretty sore about things just then."
+
+"But the sequel is the queer part," he went on. "I began to read their
+Bible, and I like it. It's part of the irony of fate that I haven't
+gotten from it the things they intended I should; but I tell you part of
+this Old Testament is immense reading. You know, Parkman, I suppose we're
+prejudiced ourselves. We don't see the Bible as it is itself. We see it
+in relation to a lot of people who surround it. And because we don't care
+for some of them we think we shouldn't care for it. Whereas the thing in
+itself," he concluded cheerfully, "is just what we'd like."
+
+"And how go your own books?" Dr. Parkman asked him.
+
+Karl shrugged one shoulder in a nervous little way he had acquired.
+"Oh--so, so. Pretty fair, I guess." His face settled into a gloom then,
+but almost immediately he roused himself from it to say, in a voice more
+cheerful than spontaneous: "They'll be finished in a couple of weeks. I'm
+both glad and sorry. Don't know just what I'll go at then."
+
+Again he seemed to settle into the gloom which the doctor could see was
+ever there waiting to receive him. But again he roused himself almost
+immediately. Was it this way with the man all the time? A continuous
+fight against surrendering? "But I'm mighty thankful I've had the books,"
+he said. "They've pulled me through the winter, and they've enabled me to
+make a living. Lord, but a man would hate not to make a living!" he
+concluded, straightening up a trifle, more like the Karl of old.
+
+The sheer pathos of it had never come home to the doctor as it did with
+that. A man who should have stood upon the very mountain peaks of fame
+now proudly claiming that he was able to make a living! But if it brought
+home the pathos of the situation it also brought new sense of the manhood
+of Karl Hubers. It was great--Parkman told himself--great! A man who felt
+within himself all the forces which make for greatness could force
+himself into the place of the average man, and thank the Lord that he was
+able to make a living!
+
+"Here's a little scheme I've worked out," Karl said, and opening one of
+the drawers of the library table, pulled out the model for the idea he
+had worked out for reading and writing in Braille.
+
+It was the first Dr. Parkman had heard of it; he wanted to know all about
+it, and Karl explained how it had seemed to him as soon as he learned how
+the blind read and wrote that the thing could be simplified and vastly
+improved. So he had worked this out; he explained its points of
+difference, and wanted to know what Parkman thought of it.
+
+"Why, man," exclaimed the doctor, "it strikes me you've revolutionized
+the whole business. But--why, Karl--nobody ever thought of this before?"
+
+"The usual speech," laughed Karl.
+
+"But in this case it seems so confoundedly true."
+
+"Well I believe it will help some, and I'll be glad of that," he added
+simply. "Oh I have some more schemes. If I've got to be blind I'm going
+to make blindness a better business."
+
+"Our old friend the devil didn't do so well then after all," said Dr.
+Parkman quietly. "He closed up one channel, but he didn't figure on your
+burrowing another."
+
+Karl laughed. "Oh this won't worry him much; it came so easily I can't
+think it amounts to a great deal. But as long as I was used to scheming
+things out it--amused me, exercised a few cells that were in pretty bad
+need of a job. And I have other ideas," he repeated.
+
+Parkman asked what Karl intended to do with his model, offering some
+suggestions. The doctor was more than interested and pleased; he
+was deeply stirred. "Why, confound the fellow," he was saying to
+himself,--"they _can't_ knock him out! They knock him down in one place,
+and he bobs up in another!" The ideas of this brain were as difficult to
+suppress as certain other things in nature. Dam up one place--they find
+another.
+
+They smoked their cigars and talked intermittently then; they were close
+enough together to be silent when they chose. And all the while the
+undercurrent of Dr. Parkman's thought flowed steadily on.
+
+He was thinking that after all there were better things to do with fate
+than damn it. If ever a man would seem justified in spending his soul in
+the damning of fate, that man, it seemed to him, was the friend beside
+him. And while he had done some of it, perhaps a great deal more than any
+one knew, it had not been his master-passion. His master-passion had been
+to press on--press on to be knew not what--there was the glory of it! It
+was easy enough to work toward a goal sighted ahead; but it took a Karl
+Hubers to work on through the darkness.
+
+And ah, there was a good time coming! The doctor's sombre face relaxed to
+a smile. His own life seemed almost worth living now just because he had
+been able to take a hand--yes, and play a few good cards--in this little
+game. Those things Karl had shown him today made it seem there was all
+the finer joy in bringing him back to the things which were his own. He
+had been thrust from out the gates, but he had not sat whimpering outside
+the wall. He had gone on and sought to find a place in that outer world
+in which he found himself. And now he should come back to his own through
+gates of glory.
+
+Karl asked him about Ernestine then. How was she looking; was she
+thin--pale? Her face felt pale to him, he said. He had urged her to work,
+because he knew she would be happier so, but Parkman must see to it she
+did not overwork. Had he seen the picture on which she was working so
+hard? He asked that wistfully; and the doctor's face was soft, and a
+gentleness crept into his voice as he said he believed he was to see the
+great picture very soon now. And then, after a silence, Karl said,
+softly, very tenderly--"Bless her gamey little heart!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+
+THE DOCTOR HAS HIS WAY
+
+It was in response to the doctor's telephone message that Ernestine went
+down to his office one afternoon a few days later. Dr. Parkman had been
+detained at the hospital, they told her, but would be there very soon,
+and so she sat down in the waiting room, which was already well filled.
+Were there always people there waiting for him--and did they not
+sometimes grow impatient and want to find a doctor who would not keep
+them waiting so long?
+
+The woman sitting near her looked friendly, and so she asked: "Don't you
+get very tired waiting for Dr. Parkman?"
+
+"Oh, yes," sighed the woman, "very tired."
+
+"Then why don't you go to some doctor who would attend to you more
+quickly?" she pursued, moved chiefly by the desire to see what would
+happen.
+
+The woman stared, grew red, and replied frigidly: "Because I do not wish
+to."
+
+All the other patients were staring at Ernestine, too. "Why don't you do
+that yourself?" asked a large woman with a sick-looking small boy.
+
+"I guess if there was anything much the matter with you, you'd be willing
+to wait," said a pale woman with a weary voice.
+
+And then a man--she was sure that man was a victim of cancer--said
+loftily: "A doctor you never have to wait for isn't the doctor you want."
+
+"The only thing seems queer to me," said a meek looking woman, taking
+advantage of the outbreak, "is that he don't look at your tongue. Down in
+Indiana, where I come from, they always look at your tongue. There's a
+lot of questions he don't ask," she ventured, looking around for either
+assent or information.
+
+"He asks all there's any need of," the first woman assured her. "I guess
+_you_ aren't very sick," turning, witheringly, to Ernestine.
+
+And then they went back to their waiting; those who had rocking chairs
+rocking, those who had magazines reading, or turning leaves at least,
+some just sitting there and looking into space. It must take away all
+sense of freedom to feel that people like this, sick people for whom
+everything was hard, were always waiting for one.
+
+She would tell the doctor how she had been well-nigh mobbed by loyal
+patients. They were like a great family; she knew well enough they did
+considerable grumbling, but her remark put her without the fold, and from
+her as an alien, criticism was not to be brooked. By the glare with which
+the first woman still regarded her she was sure she was suspected of
+being an agent sent there by some inferior doctor to try and get Dr.
+Parkman's patients away from him.
+
+Ernestine was tired, and she believed she would have to admit that she
+was nervous. She had been working harder, she supposed, than she should,
+but the further she went the more she saw to do, and something from
+within was eternally pushing her on.
+
+As she waited, her mind turned to the stories that office must hold.
+How much of anxiety and suffering and sorrow and tragedy--and occasional
+joy--it must know. The mothers who brought children whom others had
+declared incurable--how tense these moments of waiting must be for them!
+The husband and wife who came together to find out whether she would have
+to have the operation--how many of the crucial moments of life were lived
+in such places as this! The power in these doctors vested! The power of
+their voice, their slightest glance, in holding men from the brink of
+despair! Who could know the human heart better than they? They did not
+meet the every day men and women well groomed with restraints and
+pretence. For it was an hour when the soul was stripped bare that the
+doctor looked in upon it. Men were various things to various people, but
+to the doctor they came very close to being themselves. Too much was at
+stake to dissemble here. When phantoms of fear and death took shape in
+the shadows one sought the doctor--and told the truth.
+
+She had a fancy which moved her then. She saw the men like Dr. Parkman
+fighting darkness down in the valley, while from the mountain peak
+adjacent men like Karl turned on, as with mighty search-lights, more, and
+ever more, of the light. And what were the search-lights for if not to be
+turned down into the valley?
+
+"What time did you go to bed last night?" he demanded, after they had
+shaken hands in the inner office.
+
+"Why--did you see the light?" she faltered;--she had made a promise
+against late hours.
+
+"The light--no; but I see your face now, and that's enough. Was it
+two--or worse?"
+
+"Just a mere trifle worse. And truly, doctor--I didn't mean to. But don't
+you know it's hard to stop when you feel just right for a thing? Why, one
+can't always do things at the proper time," she expostulated.
+
+"No, and one can't always keep an abused nervous system from going to
+pieces either. Did you ever stop to think of that?"
+
+"But you'll look after the nervous system," she replied ingenuously.
+
+"Now that's where a lot of you make the mistake. I can't do anything at
+all without the cooperation of common-sense."
+
+"Well I'm intending to be real good from this on," she laughed. "But it
+is so important that I know everything!"
+
+He laughed then too. "A very destructive notion."
+
+"Tell me," he said, when he had settled himself in his chair in the
+particular way of settling himself when he intended having a talk with
+her, "have you been rewarded in all this by any pleasure in it
+whatsoever? I don't mean," he made clear, anticipating her, "just the
+pleasure of doing something for Karl. But has your work given you any
+enthusiasm for the thing in itself?"
+
+"Doctor--it has. And that was something I was afraid of. But you should
+have heard me talking to Mr. Ross the other day when he made one of his
+patronising remarks about mere science. I believe that when you work hard
+at almost anything you develop some enthusiasm for it."
+
+"Um--a rather doubtful compliment for science."
+
+"It was rather Beasonish," she laughed. "But you see in the beginning my
+face was turned the other way."
+
+He gave her one of those concentrated glances then. "And how about that?
+Never feel any more like heading the other way?"
+
+She smiled, and the smile seemed to be covering a great deal. "Oh
+sometimes the perverse side of me feels like turning the other way. There
+are many sides to us--aren't there? But never mind about that," she
+hastened. "That is just something between me and myself. I can suppress
+all insurrections."
+
+There was a pause. She leaned back in the big chair and was resting;
+he had seen from the first that she was very tired. "No desire to back
+out?"--he threw that out a little doubtfully.
+
+She sat up straight. She looked, first angry, and then as if she were
+going to cry. "Doctor--tell me! Am I _that_ unconvincing? Hasn't the
+winter--"
+
+"This winter," he interrupted gently, "has proved that you knew what you
+were talking about when you came to me last fall. Could I say more than
+that? I only asked the question," he explained, "because this is the last
+chance for retreat."
+
+And then he told her, watching the changing expressions of her responsive
+face. But at the last there was a timidity, a sort of frightened
+fluttering.
+
+"But doctor--am I ready? _Can_ I really do it? There is so much I don't
+know!"
+
+"The consciousness of which is excellent proof of your progress. My idea
+is this. In any case it is going to be hard at the first. You might go on
+another year, and of course be in better shape, but I don't know just
+what Karl would be doing in that year; he's in need of a big rousing up,
+and as for you, after working the year with him, you'll be a long way
+ahead of where you would be alone. So it argues itself that way from both
+standpoints. I made up my mind when I was out the other day that Karl
+needs just what this is going to give."
+
+"You think he looks badly?" she flew at that, relinquishing all else.
+"You think Karl's not well?"
+
+"I didn't mean that. But he needs the hope, the enthusiasm, activity,
+this is going to give."
+
+"Hasn't he been splendid this winter?" she asked softly, those very deep
+warm lights in her eyes. "Did you ever see anything like it, doctor?"
+
+"I thought I knew something about courage," he replied shortly, "but Karl
+makes me think I didn't."
+
+"I don't believe there are many men could turn from big things to smaller
+ones, and grow bigger instead of smaller," she said, with a very tender
+pride.
+
+"They say scientists are narrow and bull-headed. Wonder what they would
+say to this? And there's another thing to remember. We have seen the
+results of the victories. Only Karl Hubers knows of the fights."
+
+"I know of some of them," said Ernestine, simply.
+
+"Yes," he corrected himself--"you. And before we quite deify Karl we must
+reckon with you. He could not have done it without you."
+
+"He would not have tried," she said--and the man turned away. That look
+was not his to see.
+
+When she recalled herself it was with a sense of not having been kind.
+Why did she say things like that to Dr. Parkman after Karl had told
+her--? "And you, doctor," she said in rather timid reparation, "I wonder
+if you know what you have done for us both?"
+
+"Oh, I haven't counted for much," he said almost curtly. "It would have
+worked itself out without me." But even as he spoke he was wishing with
+all his heart that there was some way of showing her what they had meant
+to him. He did not do it, for a soul which has been long apart grows
+fearful of sending itself out, fearful of making itself absurd.
+
+They talked it all out then, going at practical things in a very
+matter-of-fact way. "And now," said the doctor, "I have a suggestion. It
+is more than a suggestion. It is a request. A little more than a request,
+even; a--"
+
+"Command?" she smiled at him.
+
+"You know," he began, "how it is with the athletes. Sometimes they become
+overtrained, which is the worst thing could happen to them. A good
+trainer never puts overtrained men in the game. Now, my dear enthusiastic
+friend,"--she was looking at him in that intent way of hers--"I've
+noticed two or three times that you've about jumped out of your chair at
+some meaningless noise in the other room. Your eyes tell the story;--oh
+there are various ways of reading it. You're a little overtrained. Before
+you tell Karl the great secret I want you to go away by yourself for a
+couple of weeks and rest."
+
+"You mean that I should leave Karl?" she demanded.
+
+"I do. I want you to have change, rest, and for that matter a little
+lonesomeness won't be a bad thing. You'll be in just the right mood then
+to put it all to him when you come back. He'll be in just the right mood
+to take it."
+
+"Oh, but, doctor--you don't understand! I can't leave Karl. There are
+things I do for him no one else could do. Why you must remember he's
+blind!" she concluded, passionately.
+
+She was not easy to win, but he stated his case, and one by one met her
+arguments. Yes--Karl would be lonely. But when she came back he would be
+so glad to see her that he would be a much better subject for enthusiasm
+than he was now. She also would be in better mood. "If you tell him now,"
+he said, "and he makes some objections, says it can't be done--ten to
+one, as you are now, you will begin to cry. A nice termination for your
+whole winter's work! You must go to him just as you came to me in the
+beginning--overwhelm him, take him whether or no. And you're not right
+for that now. It's just because I'm bound this thing shall go through,
+that I insist you do as I say."
+
+"Couldn't Karl go with me?" she asked, quite humbly, her eyes pleading
+eloquently.
+
+He showed her, kindly, but very decisively, that that would not make the
+point at all. There followed then but a few final protestations. Where
+would Karl think she was? What in the world would he think of her--going
+away and leaving him like that? Who would look after him? What if he
+needed some help he didn't get? Suppose he grew so lonesome and depressed
+he just couldn't stand it?
+
+On all of which points he somewhat banteringly reassured her. Other men
+had been lonesome now and then, and it had not quite killed them. Beason
+and Ross were in the house, and there was a good maid, who adored Dr.
+Hubers. "As to where he thinks you are, I'll tell him half the truth.
+That you are a little nervous and I have prescribed change and rest."
+
+But she would not agree to that. "Karl would worry," she said. "We'll
+tell him instead that I have to go to New York to see about my picture.
+It will be easier for Karl if he thinks it is about my work."
+
+He yielded to her judgment in that, and agreed to the further compromise
+that if she found she could not possibly stay away two weeks she might
+come back in one.
+
+It was the change, the going away, the getting lonesome the doctor wanted
+most of all. He wanted to lift her clear up to her highest self that she
+might have all that was hers to give when she told her story to Karl.
+
+"And of course, doctor," she asked anxiously, "when the time comes you
+will talk to him too--tell him you feel I can do it?"
+
+"Trust me for that," he said briefly.
+
+"But where is it I am to go?" she laughed, as she was ready to leave.
+
+He told her then of a place in Michigan. An old nurse of his had married
+and was living there, and he frequently sent patients to her as boarders.
+"I have written to her and she wants you to come," he said.
+
+"Well--upon my word! Before I so much as said I would go?"
+
+"Why certainly," he answered, looking a trifle surprised. "For three
+days, perhaps five, I want you to sleep. You'll find you're very
+tired--once you let go. Then you can walk in the woods--I think it's
+going to be warm enough for browsing around. And you can think of Karl,"
+he said with a touch of humour, and a touch of something else, "and of
+all this is going to mean. I've thought a great many times of what you
+said about the statue. There's something mighty stirring in that idea of
+unconquerableness."
+
+"There is!" she responded.
+
+"A great thing, you know, is worth making a few sacrifices for. You've
+made some pretty big ones for this, now make this one more. Haven't you
+been laying claim to great faith in my judgment?"
+
+"Oh yes--as a matter of judgment; only--"
+
+"Very well then, be lonesome--if you must be lonesome. I hope you will
+be--it's part of the treatment. And then you'll come back and in your
+first bursts of delight tell Karl just what you've done. When he says
+it's impossible, you'll just laugh. You'll get him to try and then the
+day is yours."
+
+Out on the street she stopped half a dozen times in the first block,
+thinking she would go back and tell Dr. Parkman she couldn't possibly
+leave Karl. "Why, he's a terrible man," she mused, half humorously, half
+tearfully, "sending wives away from husbands like this--wanting people
+to be lonesome, just because he thinks it's good for them! I'll not do
+it--I'll go back and tell him I _won't!_" But she did not go back. She
+felt Dr. Parkman might look unpleasant if a patient came back to say: "I
+won't."--"No one would ever get up courage enough for that," she
+concluded mournfully, "so I'll just have to go."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXIII
+
+
+LOVE'S OWN HOUR
+
+It was Sunday, and Ernestine was going away next morning. She had told
+Karl the day before; it alarmed him at first, for he telephoned Dr.
+Parkman, asking him to come out. When the doctor arrived he demanded the
+truth as to Ernestine. Had anything happened? Was she not well? He was so
+relieved at the doctor's assurance that Ernestine was perfectly well, and
+was going away because of her work, that he accepted the situation more
+easily than she had anticipated. "Perhaps it will do me good, liebchen,"
+he told her. "I fear I'm getting to be a selfish brute--taking everything
+for granted and not appreciating you half enough."
+
+But that afternoon it was Ernestine herself who was forced to fight hard
+for cheerfulness. She did not want to go away. She was curiously
+depressed about it, and resentful. More than once she was on the point of
+telephoning to Dr. Parkman that she could not leave Karl.
+
+Georgia and Joe and Mrs. McCormick came in about five and Georgia's
+spirit seemed to blow through the house like a strong, full current of
+bracing air. She and Joe had returned from California the night before,
+and there were many things to tell about their trip. Mrs. McCormick said
+it was indeed curious how some people always had so many more adventures
+than other people had. She wondered why it was she never met any of these
+amusing persons Georgia was always telling about.
+
+Their visit did Ernestine much good. It was impossible to feel blue or
+have silly forebodings in the presence of so much naturalness and cheer
+as always emanated from Georgia. Those hearty laughs had cleared the
+atmosphere for her.
+
+"Look here, liebchen," said Karl, emerging from a brown study, "we must
+fix up a code."
+
+"A code, dear?"
+
+"For your writing to me. You see Ross will have to read the letters, and
+how can you say in every other line you love me, with that duffer reading
+it out loud?"
+
+"Oh, Karl--how stupid of me not to learn writing the other way! You see
+it never occurred to me I would be away from you. Couldn't I take that
+manual, and make it out from that?"
+
+"Well--you might, but we'll do both; it will be fun to have a code. Now,
+when you say--'I am a trifle tired,' you mean--'Oh, sweetheart, I am so
+lonesome for you that I am never going away again!'"
+
+"But won't Mr. Ross think it strange if I say in each letter that I am a
+trifle tired?"
+
+"What do we care what he thinks? They're not his letters, are they? And
+when you say--'New York seems most attractive,'--you mean--'Oh, dearest,
+I never dreamed I loved you so much! I am finding out in a thousand new
+ways how much I care, and never, never, shall we be separated again.'"
+
+"And when I say, 'I send you my love'--it will be perfectly proper for
+Mr. Ross to read that, I mean--'Dear love--I send you a thousand kisses,
+and I would give the world for one minute now in your arms.'"
+
+And so they arranged it,--revising, enlarging, going over it a great many
+times to have it all certain--there was such a tender kind of fun in it.
+As to the other side of it, Karl of course could write to her on his
+typewriter.
+
+It was a beautiful evening they had sitting there before the fire. She
+saw pictures for him, and he even saw some pictures for her,--he said a
+blind man could see certain pictures no one else could possibly see. They
+spoke of how they had never been separated since their marriage, of how
+strange it would seem to be apart, but always of how beautiful to be
+together again. There was such a sweetness, tenderness, in the sadness
+which hung about their parting. They made the most of their pain, as is
+the way of lovers, for it drew them together in a new way, and each kiss,
+each smallest caress, had a new and tender significance.
+
+"You'll be back in time for your birthday, Ernestine?"
+
+"Oh, yes; I'm only going to stay a week."
+
+"I thought you said, perhaps two?"
+
+"Did I? Well I've decided one will be enough."
+
+"Ernestine, what have you been painting? Tell me, dear. That's one thing
+I'm a little disappointed in. I do so want to keep close to your work."
+
+"Well, Karl," after a silence, "that picture I have been working on this
+winter is hard to tell about because it is in a field all new to me. It
+is a picture which emphasises, or tries to, what love means to the
+world,--a picture which is the outgrowth of our love. I am not sure that
+it is good in all its technical features, but I believe there is
+atmosphere in it, poetic feeling, and, back of that, thought, and soul,
+and truth. I think there is harmony and richness of colour. Some people
+will say it is very daring, and no one will call it conventional, but I
+am hoping,"--Ernestine's voice was so low and full of feeling he could
+scarcely get the words--"that it is going to be a very great picture--the
+greatest I have ever done. Some of it has been hard for me, dear. In
+truth I have been much discouraged at times. But great things are not
+lightly achieved, Karl, and if this is anything at all, it is one of the
+great things. As to the subject, detail, I am going to ask you to wait
+until I come back. I have been keeping it for you as a little surprise.
+Perhaps it will help some of your lonely hours, dear"--her voice
+quivered--"to think about the beautiful surprise. And if it seems strange
+sometimes that I could bring myself to go away from you, will you not
+bear in mind, Karl dear, that I am doing it simply that the great
+surprise may be made perfect for you? It is a whim of mine to keep this a
+great secret; in the end I know you will forgive the secrecy. And when I
+come back"--her voice was stronger, fuller now--"I am going to make you
+see it just as plainly as you ever saw anything in all your life!"
+
+"You must! I couldn't bear it to be shut out from your work."
+
+"You are not going to be shut out from my work!"--she said it with an
+intensity almost stern.
+
+"I want your life to be happy, Ernestine," he said, after a time, and the
+words seemed to have a new meaning spoken out of this mood of very deep
+tenderness. "I don't want it to be darkened. I want my love to make you
+happy--in spite of it all."
+
+"It does," she breathed,--"it does."
+
+"But I want you to be--as you used to be! I haven't been fair in letting
+this make such a difference with us."
+
+"Karl--how can you talk like that, when you have been so--splendid?"
+
+"But you see I don't want to be splendid," he said whimsically. "I'd
+rather be a brute than be splendid. And I want you to love me always as
+you did at first--just because you couldn't help yourself."
+
+"I can not help myself now," she laughed. "I am just as helpless as I
+ever was."
+
+And then a long and very precious silence. She was filled with many
+things too deep for utterance, even had she been free to speak. She
+thought of her birthday night a year before, their happiness then, all
+that had come to them since, all that love had meant, the great things it
+was to do for them. She looked at Karl's face--his fine, strong face
+which seemed the very soul of the mellow fire-light. How would that dear
+face look when she told him what she had done? Convinced him that great
+things were before him now? Would it not be that his determination not to
+fail her would stir fires which, even in his most triumphant days, had
+slumbered?
+
+But from exultation in all that, she passed to the heart's pain in
+leaving him. She moved a little closer, took his hand and rested it
+lovingly against her cheek. She had never been away from Karl. Tears came
+at the thought of it now.
+
+And he must have been thinking of what Ernestine had meant to him
+in the last year, for of a sudden he stooped down and with his old
+abandonment, with all the fullness of the first passion and the tender
+understanding of these later days, gathered her into his arms. "Oh,
+Ernestine," he whispered--breathing into her name all that was in his
+heart--"_Ernestine!_"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXIV
+
+
+ALMOST DAWN
+
+She found that in the beginning at least it was as Dr. Parkman had said.
+It was good to sleep. It was good to go to bed at night with the sense of
+nothing to do in the morning, good to wake at the usual time only to feel
+she might go back to that comfortable, beautiful sleep. For Ernestine was
+indeed very tired. Since that day when the great idea had come to her
+there had been no time when she was free from the sense of all that lay
+before her. But now she could rest.
+
+Strangely enough she did not worry greatly about Karl. Her first waking
+thoughts were of him, but fuller consciousness always brought the feeling
+that it was all right with Karl; he was missing her, of course, but she
+was going back to him very soon and bring him the things he had believed
+shut away forever;--bring him the light!--that was the way she had come
+to think of it. The deliciousness of her rest was in the sense of its
+being right she should take it; she could best serve Karl by resting
+until she was her strongest self.
+
+Her room was so quiet and restful, the bed so comfortable, and Mrs.
+Rolfe, Dr. Parkman's old nurse, so good to her. It was soothing to be
+told to close her pretty eyes and go to sleep, sustaining to be met
+with--"Now here is something for our little lady to eat." After many days
+of responsibility it was good to be "mothered" a little.
+
+But after the first revel in sleep had passed she did a great deal of
+languid, undisturbed thinking. She seemed detached from her life, and it
+passed before her, not poignantly, but merely as something to look upon,
+quietly muse about. Soon she would step back into it, but now she was
+resting from it, simply viewing it as an interesting thing which kept
+passing before her.
+
+From the very first it came before her, from those days when she was a
+little girl at home, and she found much quiet entertainment in trying to
+connect herself of those days with herself of the now. "Am I all one?"
+she would want to know, and in thinking that over would quite likely fall
+asleep again.
+
+She thought a great deal about her father and mother; they were more real
+to her than they had been for a long time; but it was hard to connect the
+Ernestine of that home with the Ernestine who belonged to Karl. There was
+Georgia, to be sure, who extended clear through. Dear Georgia--how well
+she had looked Sunday in that beautiful black gown. She remembered such a
+funny thing, and such a dear thing, Georgia had done once. They had
+become chums as freshmen and when they were sophomores Georgia came to
+their house to live, and one night she inadvertently said something
+which started one of those terrible arguments, and ended in the saying
+of so many bitter things that Ernestine could not bear it--especially
+before Georgia, and as soon as she could she left the table and went
+up to her room. She did not cry, her mother cried so much that it seemed
+enough for the family, but she sat there very still looking straight
+ahead--denying herself even the luxury of tears. And then, just when
+that atmosphere of unhappiness and bitterness seemed pressing down
+upon her--crushing her--there had come a wild shriek from
+Georgia--"Ernestine--Ernestine--get your things quick--let's go to the
+fire!"
+
+That was not to be resisted even by a nineteen-year-old girl. She
+remembered tumbling into her things, running two blocks, and then
+gasping--"Where is it?" and Georgia replied, gasping too--"Don't
+know--small boys--said so." And then after running all over town they
+found there was no fire at all, and that had so overcome them with
+laughter that she forgot all about those other things which would have
+given her so miserable an evening. She had had just a little suspicion
+then, and now she had a firm conviction, that Georgia never heard small
+boys say anything about fire that night. Bless Georgia's big heart--she
+loved her for just such things as inventing fires for unhappy people to
+go to.
+
+As she lay there resting, away from the current of her life, she thought
+a great deal about a little grave over in France, such a very, very small
+grave which represented a life which had really never come into the world
+at all. She could fancy her baby here with her now--patting her face,
+pulling her hair--so warm and dear and sweet. Her arms ached for that
+little child which had been hers only in anticipation. And what it would
+have meant to Karl!--the laughter of a very small voice, the cuddling of
+a very small head.... Deep thoughts came then, and deeper yearnings, and
+when Mrs. Rolfe came in at one of those times she was startled at the
+look in the deep brown eyes of her patient, a look which seemed to be
+asking for something which no one could give, and when Ernestine smiled
+at her, as she always did, the woman could scarcely keep back the
+answering--"Never mind, dearie--never you mind."
+
+And through all of her thoughts there was Karl--his greatness, his work,
+his love. She would be so happy when she did not have to keep things back
+from Karl. It seemed it would be the happiest moment of her life when she
+could throw her soul wide open to him with--"There is never going to be
+another thing kept back from you!" She could not bear the thought of
+Karl's believing she was in New York. But soon there would be no more of
+that, and Karl himself would tell her she had done it because she cared
+so much.
+
+And most beautiful of all things to think about was the hour when she
+would tell him! How would he look? What would he say?
+
+On the fifth morning she awakened feeling quite different. Those
+birds!--What were they singing about? She got up and raised the curtain,
+and then drew in a long breath of delight. For it was a radiant spring
+morning, breathing gladness and joy and all beautiful things. Oh how
+beautiful off there in the trees!--the trees which were just coming back
+to life after their long sleep. She too had been asleep--but it was time
+now to wake up and be glad!
+
+She felt very much awake and alive this morning.--Oh, how those birds
+were singing! She laughed in sheer happiness, and began to sing too. She
+would dress and go out of doors. To remain in her room one hour longer
+would be unbearable bondage. For all the world was awake and glad! She
+could scarcely wait to get out there among the birds and trees.
+
+She had never felt so alive, so well tuned to life, so passionately eager
+for its every manifestation as when, after a hurried breakfast, she
+started up the beautiful green hill to the trees where all the birds were
+singing--the soft breath of the spring enfolding her, her spirit lifting
+itself up to meet the caress of the spirit of spring. She walked with
+long, swinging step, smiling to herself, humming a glad little air, now
+and then tossing her head just to get the breath of spring upon her face
+in some new way. Mrs. Rolfe watched her from the kitchen door, smiling.
+
+On the hill-top she stopped, standing straight, breathing deep, revelling
+in the song of the birds--they were fairly intoxicated with joy at
+this morning--listening to the soft murmur of the spring beneath it
+all--happy--oh so happy, as she looked off to the far distances. The long
+winter had gone, and now the spring had come again--the dear spring she
+had always loved!
+
+It was with her too almost an intoxication--the throwing off of gloom,
+the taking on of joy. On such a morning nature calls unto her chosen, and
+they hear her call, and are glad. As she stood there on her hill-top her
+spirit lifted itself up in lyric utterance; her whole being responded to
+the songs of the returning birds.
+
+How well Dr. Parkman had planned it! She would go back now and tell Karl
+what a great thing it was to be alive, how the spirit was everything, and
+could conquer all else. It seemed very easy now. It was all a matter of
+getting the spirit right;--how good of Dr. Parkman to think it out like
+this.
+
+But there was something a little wrong. She stopped for a minute,
+pondering. Now she knew! Karl!--why could he not be here too? All in an
+instant she saw it so clearly that she laughed aloud. She was rested
+now--ready to tell him--and _this_ the place! She would send for him! Mr.
+Ross--or perhaps the doctor himself--would come with him, and here where
+it was all so beautiful, where the call of the spring reached them and
+made them glad--she would tell him! And then, his spirit strong as hers
+was now strong, he would respond to it, be made ready for the fight.
+
+How simple and how splendid! How stupid not to have thought of this
+before! And then again she laughed. It would be fun to improve on Dr.
+Parkman's idea. That was all very well--but this a thousand times better.
+Karl's spirit too needed lifting up;--what could do it as this? It was
+true he could not see it with his eyes--but there were so many other ways
+of being part of it: the singing of the birds, the scent of the budding
+trees, the rich breath of spring upon one's face. And even the vision
+should not be lost to him. She would make him see it! She would make him
+see the sunlight upon the trees, the roll of that farther hillside--one
+did not need to try to forget the park commissioners here!--and then she
+would say to him: "See, Karl--even as I can make you see the trees and
+that little brook there in the hollow, just as plainly as I can make you
+see the sky and the hill come together off there--so plainly will I make
+you see the things in the laboratory which belong with your work." She
+would prove to him by the picture she drew of these green fields in
+spring-time that she could make plain to him all he must see. How
+glorious to prove it to him by the spring-time!
+
+And then, both of them uplifted, gladdened, both of them believing it
+could be done, loving each other more than they had ever done before,
+newly assured of the power of love, they would go back and with firm
+faith and deep joy begin the work which lay before them.
+
+She turned to walk back to the house. She would send a telegram
+to Dr. Parkman that Karl must come. Perhaps he could be here
+to-night;--to-morrow, surely. Dear Karl--who needed a vacation more than
+he? Who needed the rejuvenation of the spring as Karl needed it?
+
+She had walked but a little way when she stopped. Someone was coming
+toward her, walking fast. Had the sun grown a little dim--or was
+something passing before her eyes? The world seemed to darken. She looked
+again at Mrs. Rolfe, coming toward her. How strange that she shivered!
+Was it a little chilly up here on the hill-top where a minute before it
+had been so soft and warm? She wanted to go to meet Mrs. Rolfe, but she
+did not; she stood strangely still, waiting. And why was it that the
+figure of Mrs. Rolfe was such a blur on the beauty of the hillside?
+
+But when at last she saw her face she did run to meet her. "What is the
+matter?"--her voice was quick and sharp.
+
+The woman hesitated.
+
+"Tell me!" demanded Ernestine. "I will not be treated like that!"
+
+"Dr. Parkman wants you to come home," the woman said, not looking
+Ernestine in the face.
+
+"Why?--Karl?"--she caught roughly at the other woman's arm.
+
+She knew then that she could not temporise nor modify. "Dr. Hubers was
+taken sick yesterday. He was to have an operation. The telegram should
+have been delivered last night."
+
+She thought Ernestine was going to fall--she swayed so, her face went so
+colourless, her hands so cold. But she did not fall. "That--is all you
+know?"--it came in hoarse, broken whisper.
+
+And when the woman answered, yes, Ernestine started, running, for the
+house.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXV
+
+
+"OH, HURRY--_HURRY!_"
+
+That train!--She would go mad if it kept stopping like that. She kept
+leaning forward in her seat, every muscle tense, fairly pushing the train
+on with every nerve that was in her. Never once did she relax--on--on--it
+must go on! She would _make_ it go faster! When it stopped she clenched
+her hands, her nails digging into the flesh--and then when it started
+again that same feeling that she, from within herself, must push it on.
+At times she looked from the window. Now this field was past--they
+were so much nearer. Soon they would be over there where the track
+curved--that was a long way ahead. They were going faster now. She would
+lean forward again--pushing on, trying through the straining of her own
+nerves to make the train go faster.
+
+Mrs. Rolfe had wanted to come with her, but she said no. It seemed she
+could get there faster by herself. There had been an hour's wait for the
+train; it made her sick, even now, to think back to that hour. At least
+this was doing something, getting somewhere. She had telegraphed to every
+one she could think of, but no reply had come up to the time the train
+started. She reasoned that out with herself, now for good, now for bad.
+And then--if he were better, if there were anything good to tell--
+
+Her temples were thumping more loudly than the train thumped. Her heart
+was choking her. Her throat was so tight she could not breathe. Again and
+again she went over it to herself. Dr. Parkman had operated on Karl. Of
+course Dr. Parkman would do it right. He would not dare to operate on him
+without her being there unless he was absolutely sure it would be all
+right. And then close upon that--he would have waited for her if--
+
+Appendicitis--that was what those quick operations were. And most of
+them--especially with Dr. Parkman--came out all right. And Karl was the
+doctor's best friend! Would not a man save his best friend when he could
+save every one else? And Karl himself--his will, his power, his love for
+her--why Karl would _know_ that nothing must happen while she was away!
+But close upon that came awful visions--Oh _why_ had Dr. Parkman sent
+her away and then done this thing? She would tell him when she got
+there--she would tell him--
+
+It would all be right when she got there. If only the train would hurry!
+There was smoke off there. Was it?--It _was_ the smoke of Chicago!
+Nothing had ever looked so beautiful before. Very soon now! Why, perhaps
+within a few hours she and Karl would be laughing at this! "Isn't it
+great the way I got on, liebchen?" he would say. "Isn't Parkman a dandy?"
+
+They were passing those houses on the outskirts. Oh why was Chicago so
+big! But she must be calm--very calm; she must not excite Karl in the
+least. How sorry he would be that she had been frightened like this! They
+were passing larger buildings, coming closer to the city. She gritted her
+teeth hard, clenched her hands.
+
+Karl was at the hospital--the telegram told that. She would get off at
+the stop just this side of the main station--that was a little nearer the
+hospital, she believed. She would take a cab--if only there were an
+automobile!--but the cabman would surely go very fast if she told him why
+she had to hurry like this.
+
+Long before the train came to its stop she was standing at the door. She
+would not have waited for the standstill if the porter had not held her
+back. Oh how she must hurry now!
+
+She ran to the nearest cabman. Would he hurry very fast?--faster than he
+ever had before? It was life and death, it was--"Yes--yes, lady," he
+said, putting her in. "Yes, I understand. I'll hurry."
+
+"But faster," she kept saying to him--"oh _please_, faster!"
+
+She saw nothing either to the right or left. She saw only the straight
+line ahead which they must travel. And still everything from within her
+was pushing her on--oh if the man would only _hurry_!
+
+A big building at last--the hospital. Only two blocks now, then one, and
+then the man had slowed up. She was out before he stopped, running up the
+steps--somebody in the hospital would pay--and up the stairs. The
+elevator was there--but her own feet would take her faster.
+
+"Dr. Hubers?--Where is he?" she said in choked voice to a nurse in the
+hall.
+
+The nurse started to speak, but Ernestine, looking ahead, saw Dr. Parkman
+standing in the door of a room. She rushed to him with outstretched hand,
+white, questioning, pleading face. Her lips refused to move.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXVI
+
+
+WITH THE OUTGOING TIDE
+
+He simply took her into the room, and there was Karl--alive. That was all
+she grasped at first; it filled her so completely she could take in
+nothing else. He was lying there, seemingly half asleep, looking much as
+he always did, save that of course it was plain he was very sick. She
+stooped down and kissed him, and his face lighted up, and he smiled a
+little. "Ernestine," he murmured, "did they frighten you?"
+
+It was as she had known! His thought was of her. And oh how sorry Karl
+would be when he was quite well and she told him all!
+
+She nestled her head close to him, her arm thrown about him. The
+tears were running down her cheeks. Of the blessedness of finding Karl
+here--breathing, smiling upon her, sorry she had been frightened! She
+took his hand and it responded to her clasp. That thrilled her through
+and through. Those awful fears--those never-to-be-forgotten fears--that
+Karl's hand might never close over hers again! She leaned over him that
+she might feel his breath upon her face. In all her life there had never
+been so blessed a joy as this feeling Karl's breath upon her cheek.
+Nothing mattered now--work, eyes, nothing. She had him back; she asked
+nothing more of life. What could anything else matter now that those
+awful fears had drawn away? She was sobbing quietly to herself. Again his
+hand closed over hers.
+
+Then something made her look up, and at the foot of the bed she saw Dr.
+Parkman. One look at his face and she grew cold from head to foot; her
+throat grew painfully tight; strange things came before her eyes. She
+could not move. She simply remained there upon her knees, looking at Dr.
+Parkman's face, her own frozen with terror.
+
+The doctor came to her, took her hands, and helped her to rise. Two
+nurses and another doctor were bending over Karl--doing something. Dr.
+Parkman led Ernestine into an adjoining room.
+
+She did not take her eyes from his face; the appeal, terror, in them
+seemed to strike him dumb. It was as though his own throat were closed,
+for several times he tried vainly to speak.
+
+"Ernestine," he said at last, "Karl is very sick."
+
+"How--sick?" she managed to whisper.
+
+"How--sick?" she repeated as he stood there looking at her helplessly.
+
+And, finally, he said, as if it were killing him to do it--"So sick
+that--"
+
+"Don't say that!"--she fairly hissed it at him.
+
+"Don't _dare_ say that! You _did_ it--you----" And then, sinking down
+beside him, catching hold of his hand, she sobbed out, wildly,
+heartbreakingly--"Oh, Dr. Parkman--oh, please--_please_ tell me you
+_will_ save Karl!"
+
+Her sobs were becoming uncontrollable. "Ernestine," he said, sharply--"be
+quiet. Be quiet! You have got to help."
+
+The sobs stopped; she rose to her feet. He pulled up a chair for her, but
+she did not sit down. A few sobs still came, but her face was becoming
+stern, set.
+
+"Tell me," she said, holding her two hands tight against her breast, and
+looking him straight in the face.
+
+And then he jerked it out. Karl had been taken ill--pain, fever, he
+feared appendicitis. He had two other doctors see him; they agreed
+that he must be operated on immediately. They brought him here. They
+found--conditions awful. They did all that surgery could do--every known
+thing was being done now, but--they did not know. He had rallied a little
+from the operation; now he seemed to be drooping. He was in bad shape
+generally,--heart weakened by the shock of his blindness, intestines
+broken down by lack of exercise, whole system affected by changed
+conditions--all these things combined against him. He told the short
+story with his own lips white, swaying a little, seeming fairly to age as
+he stood there.
+
+Her face had been changing as she listened. He had never seen a human
+face look as hers did then; he had never heard a human voice sound as
+hers sounded when she said: "Dr. Parkman, you are mistaken." She looked
+him straight in the eye--a look which held the whole force of her being.
+"I say you are mistaken. We will go back in here now to Karl. You and I
+together are going to save him."
+
+There was the light from higher worlds in her eye as she went back, in
+her voice a force which men have never named or understood. And something
+which emanated from her took hold of every one who came into that room.
+There was more than the resources of medical science at work now.
+
+On her knees beside the bed, her arm about him, passionately shielding
+him from the dark forces around him, her face often touching his as if
+reassuring him, Ernestine spoke to Karl, quietly, tenderly, forcefully,
+love's own intuition telling her how much to say, when to speak. By her
+warm body which loved him, by her great spirit which claimed him, she
+would hold him from the outgoing tide. Her voice could rouse him where
+other stimulants failed; the only effort he made was the tightening of
+his hand over hers, and sometimes he smiled a little as he felt her close
+to him.
+
+Two hours went by; the lines in Dr. Parkman's face were deepening. They
+worked on unfalteringly--hypodermics, heat, rubbing, oxygen, all those
+things with which man seeks to deceive himself, and for which the foe,
+with the tolerance of power, is willing to wait. But their faces were
+changing. The call of the outgoing tide, that tide over which human
+determination has not learned to prevail, was coming close. They worked
+on, for they were trained to work on, even through the sense of their own
+futility.
+
+Looking about her Ernestine saw it all, and held him with a passionate
+protectiveness. If all else failed, her arms--arms to which he had ever
+come for help and consolation--could surely hold him! The cold fear crept
+farther and farther into her heart, and as it crept on her arms about him
+tightened. Not while she held him like this! Oh not while she held him
+like this!
+
+And then a frenzy possessed her. That she should sit here
+powerless--weeping--despairing, surrendering, while Karl slipped
+from her! She must do something--say something--something to hold him
+firm--call him back--make him understand that he must fight!
+
+Suddenly a light broke over her face. She looked at Dr. Parkman, who was
+bending over Karl. "I will tell him," she whispered--"what I did--the
+secret--about the work."
+
+He hesitated; medically his judgment was against it; and then, white to
+the lips with the horror of the admission he faced the fact that this had
+passed beyond things medical. Let her try where he had failed. Through a
+rush of uncontrollable tears he nodded yes.
+
+And she did tell him,--in words which were not sentences, with
+sharp flashes of thought--such flashes as alone could penetrate the
+semi-consciousness into which she must reach; after a moment of pause in
+which to gather herself together for the great battle of her life, with
+concentration, illumination, with a piercing eloquence which brought hot
+tears to every cheek, and deep, deep prayers to hearts which would have
+said they did not know how to pray--a woman fighting for the man she
+loved, human love at its whitest heat pitted against destiny--she told
+him.
+
+"Karl," at the last--"you _understand?_--That's the great
+secret!--_That's_ the great picture! I've not painted one stroke this
+winter! I've been working for _you_--working in your laboratory every
+day--studying day and night--getting ready to be your eyes--going to give
+you back your work--oh, Karl--_Karl_--won't you--" but the sobs could
+hold back no longer.
+
+She had reached him. He took it in, just a little at first, but
+comprehension was growing, and upon his face a great wondering, a
+softening.
+
+"Old man,"--it was Dr. Parkman now--"you get that? See what you've got
+ahead? God, man--but it was splendid! She came to me with the idea--_her_
+idea--thought it all out herself. Karl was not happy--Karl must have his
+work. Karl--Karl--it was nothing but Karl. She was closer to him than any
+one in the world. She could make him see what others could not. Then
+_she_ would be his eyes. Man--do you know that this woman has fairly made
+over her soul for love of you? Do you know that she has given up becoming
+one of the great painters of the world to become your assistant? Do you
+get it, Karl? So help me God it was the pluckiest fight I've ever seen or
+heard of. And she's won! I'm no fool--and I say she can do what she says
+she can. She's ready. She's ready to begin to-morrow. What do you say,
+old man? What do you think of Ernestine now? Isn't she worth taking a
+good brace and living for?"
+
+And then he got it all; he was taking it in, rising to it, understanding,
+glowing. And a look that was very wonderful was growing upon Karl's face.
+
+"Ernestine," he whispered, dwelling long upon the name, his voice a voice
+of wonder, "you did that--for me?"
+
+"I did it because I love you so!" she whispered, and it seemed that
+surely death itself could not withstand the tenderness of it.
+
+And then his whole face became transfigured. His blind eyes were opened
+to the light of love. His illumined face reflected it as the supreme
+moment of his life. In that moment he triumphed over all powers set
+against him. He rose out of suffering on wings of glory. He transcended
+sorrow and tragedy, blindness--yes, in that moment, death. He saw behind
+the veil; he saw into the glory of a soul; he comprehended the wonder of
+love. Compensation for suffering and loss--understanding, victory, peace;
+it was the human face lighted with divine light. They did not dare to
+move or breathe as they looked upon the wonder of his face.
+
+"Ernestine--little one," he whispered, the light not going from his
+face--"you loved me--like that?"
+
+"You see, Karl,"--it was this must reach him--"what you have to live for
+now?"
+
+But he did not get that. He was filled with the wonder of that which he
+was seeing.
+
+"You see, old man," said Parkman, sharply, "what you've got ahead of
+you?"
+
+But he only murmured, happily, faintly, as one about to fall asleep: "She
+loved me--like that."
+
+It terrified her; it seemed, not as though the great idea were holding
+him, but as though he were taking it away with him, even as though well
+content to go, having this to take with him from life.
+
+"Karl--Karl!" she sobbed--"don't you _see _how I love you?--don't you see
+you _must _live now--for me?"
+
+But he had far transcended all sense of suffering or loss, even her
+suffering and loss. Her plea--she herself--could not reach him. He and
+the great idea were going away together. And that light did not leave his
+face.
+
+It was so that he sank into a sleep. He did not hear Ernestine's sobs; he
+knew nothing of her pleading cries. In a frenzy of grief she felt him
+going out to where she could not reach him. She called to him, and he did
+not answer. She pressed close to him, and he did not know that she was
+there.
+
+But the great idea was with him. It lighted his face to the last. It was
+as if that were what he was taking with him from life. It was as if that,
+and that alone, he could keep.
+
+"Karl--Karl!" she cried, terrorised--"look at me! Speak to me! I am here!
+Ernestine is here!"--And then, the strongest word of woman to man--"I'm
+frightened! Oh take care of me--Karl--take care of me!"
+
+Dr. Parkman tried to take her away, but she resisted fiercely, and they
+let her stay. And during the few hours which followed she never ceased
+her pleading--to him to come back to her, to them to help. Crazed with
+the consciousness of his slipping from her, wild beyond all reason with
+the thought that her kisses could not move him, her arms could not hold
+him, her passion lashed to the uttermost in the thought that she must
+claim him now or lose him forever, she pleaded with all the eloquence of
+human voice and human tears. She could not believe it--that he was there
+beside her and would not listen to her pleadings. Again and again she
+told him that she was frightened and alone; that--surely that--he must
+hear. It could not be that he was there beside her, breathing, moving a
+little now and then, and did not hear her call for help.
+
+And when at last she heard some one speak a low word, and saw some one
+bend over him to close his eyes, she uttered one piercing, heartbreaking
+cry which they would bear with them so long as they lived. And then,
+throwing herself upon him, shielding him, keeping him, there came the
+wild, futile call of life to death--"Karl!--Karl!--_Karl!_"
+
+
+
+
+PART THREE
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXVII
+
+
+BENEATH DEAD LEAVES
+
+The cold March rain drove steadily against the car window. His thoughts
+were like that,--cold, ugly, driving thoughts. Looking out at the bleak
+country through which they were passing he saw that dead leaves were
+hanging forlornly to bare trees. His hopes were like that,--a few dead
+hopes clinging dismally to the barren tree of experience. So it seemed to
+Dr. Parkman as he looked from the car window at the country of hills and
+hollows through which he was passing. The out-lived winter's snow still
+in the hollows, last summer's leaves blown meaninglessly about, denied
+even the repose of burial, the cheerless wind and the cheerless rain--it
+matched his mood.
+
+Almost a year had gone by, and Dr. Parkman was going out to see
+Ernestine. Every mile which brought him nearer, brought added uncertainty
+as to what he should say when he reached her. What was there for him to
+say? The dead leaves of her hopes were all huddled in the hollow. Was he
+becoming so irrational as to think he could give life to things dead? Was
+she not right in wishing to cover them up decently and let them be? Was
+anything to be gained in blowing them about as last summer's leaves were
+being blown about now by the unsparing, uncaring winds of March?
+
+She was out where she had lived as a girl,--living in the very house
+which had once been her home. He had understood her going. It was the
+simple law of living things. The animal wounded beyond all thought of
+life seeks only a place of seclusion.
+
+But when Georgia returned from her visit to Ernestine the month before,
+she came to him with:
+
+"Dr. Parkman, you _must_ do something for Ernestine!" And after she had
+told him many things, and he questioned still further, she said, in
+desperate desire to make it plain--"She is becoming a great deal like
+you!"
+
+And from then until the time of starting on this trip he had had no
+peace.
+
+He understood; understood far more deeply than she who would have him
+see. Was any one better qualified to understand that thing than he?
+
+Well,--what then? What now? Was there any other thing to expect? Was he,
+of all men, going to her with platitudes about courage and faith? And
+even so, would sophistry avail anything? Did he not know Ernestine far
+too well far that?
+
+His own face bore the deep marks of hard and bitter things. But the loss
+and the sorrow showed themselves in strange ways, little understood as
+manifestations of grief. He ran his automobile faster, showed even less
+caution than before in his business ventures, had less and less to say,
+was called more and more strange by those associated with him. And the
+thing which mocked him most of all was that the year had been attended
+with the greatest professional successes of his life. He never heard his
+plaudits sounded without a curse in his heart.
+
+"It went mighty hard with Parkman not to be able to save Hubers," medical
+men said with growing frequency as the year advanced. But there were none
+of them who dreamed into what deep and vital things the cut had gone.
+With his own will and his own skill he patched it up on the surface, not
+the man to leave his wound exposed to other eyes. But he knew its
+hopelessness too well ever to try and reach the bottom of the wound. It
+was not a good, clean, straight cut such as time expects to heal. Indeed
+it was not a cut at all; nothing so wholesome and reachable as that. It
+was a destroying force, a thing burrowing at the springs of life, a thing
+which made its way through devious paths to vital sources. Did a patched
+up surface mean anything to a thing like that?
+
+The evening of the day he had seen Georgia, and she told him of
+Ernestine, he sat a long time in his office alone. The grey ashes of his
+own life seemed spread around him. And it was he, who was asked, out of
+this, to rekindle a great flame? And what flame? What was there left for
+Ernestine? Ask her to come back--to what? Fight--for what?
+
+He did not know, or at least he said he did not know, and yet he, like
+Georgia, saw it as all wrong, unendurable, not to be countenanced, that
+Ernestine should shut herself out from life.
+
+Perhaps he was going to her because he knew so well the desolation of
+ashes. Was it because he had lived so long among them that he hated to
+see another fire go out? Could it be that a man who had dwelt long among
+ashes knew most surely the worth of the flame?
+
+He had reached the end of his journey. He had come to the western college
+town for which he had set out. From the window he could see some of the
+college buildings. Yes, this was the place.
+
+He rose and put on his coat. A few minutes later he was standing on the
+station platform, watching the on-going train. Then he turned, with
+decision, in the direction Georgia had bade him go.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXVIII
+
+
+PATCHWORK QUILTS
+
+And now that the first ten minutes had passed he felt anew the futility
+of his errand. His first look into her face made him certain he might
+better have remained in Chicago. The thing which cut off all approach was
+that she too had done some work on the surface.
+
+It seemed to him as he sat there in utter silence that he had been
+brutal, not alone to her heart, but to his own, that he asked too much,
+not only of her command, but of his. He had come to talk of Ernestine and
+the future; the things about him drew him overmasteringly to Karl and the
+past.
+
+She had taken him to her little sitting room up stairs, forced to do so
+because the fire down stairs had gone out. He understood now why it was
+she had faltered so in asking him to come up here. Here was Karl's big
+chair--many things from their library at home. It was where she lived
+with her past. She wanted no one here.
+
+She would make no attempt at helping him. She sat there in silence, her
+face white, almost stern. In her aloofness it was as though she were
+trying to hold herself, from the consciousness of his presence.
+
+He too remained silent. For he was filled with the very things against
+which he had come to protest.
+
+It was Karl who was very close; it was the thoughts of Karl's life which
+filled him. His heart had never been so warm for his friend, his
+appreciation had never been so great as now. Karl, and all that Karl
+meant, had never been so close, and so dear. And the words he finally
+said to Ernestine, words of passionate tenderness spoken in utter
+unconsciousness of how far he had gone from his purpose, were: "I do not
+believe any of us half appreciated Karl!"
+
+Startled, she gave him a long, strange look. "No, Dr. Parkman,"--very
+low--"neither do I."
+
+"I have been looking into it since. I wanted to throw Karl's results to
+the right man. He was head and shoulders above them all."
+
+There was a slow closing of her eyes, but she was not shrinking from him
+now;--this the kind of hurt she was able to bear.
+
+"If he had been left to work out his life--" but he stopped, brought
+suddenly to a sense of how far he had lost himself.
+
+She too saw it. "Dr. Parkman,"--with a smile which put him far from
+her--"_this_ is what you came to say? You think _I_ need any incitement?
+You needn't, Dr. Parkman,"--with rising passion--"you needn't. Every
+time I leave this room two things are different. I have more love for
+Karl--more hate for his destroyers. And those two passions will feed upon
+me to the end of my life!"
+
+Instinctively he put out a protesting hand. It was too plain that it was
+as she said.
+
+"More love for Karl--more hate for his destroyers,"--she repeated it with
+a passionate steadfastness as though it comprehended the creed of her
+life.
+
+"His--destroyers?" he faltered. "What do you mean--by that?"
+
+And she answered, with a directness before which dissembling and evasion
+crumbled away: "Read the answer in your own heart.
+
+"And if you cannot look into your own heart," she went on, unsparingly,
+"if your own heart has been shut away so long that it is closed even to
+yourself, then look into your looking-glass and read the answer there.
+Let the grey hairs in your own head, the lines in your own face,--yes,
+the words of your own mouth--tell you what you would know of Karl's
+destroyers."
+
+He drew in his lips in that way of his; one side of his face twitched
+uncontrollably. He had come to reach her soul, reach it if must be
+through channels of suffering. He had not thought of her reaching his
+like this.
+
+But she could not stop. "And if you want to know what I have gone
+through, look back to what you have gone through yourself--then make
+some of those hours just as much stronger as love is stronger than
+friendship--and perhaps you can get some idea of what it has been to me!"
+
+He was dumb before that. Putting it that way there was not a word to say.
+
+He saw now the real change. It was more than hollowed cheeks and eyes
+from which the light of other days had gone, more than soft curves
+surrendered to grief and youth eaten out by bitterness. It was a change
+at the root of things. A great tide had been turned the other way. But in
+the days when happiness softened her and love made it all harmonious he
+had never felt her force as he felt it now. Reach this? Turn this? The
+moment brought new understanding of the paltriness of words.
+
+It was she who spoke. "Dr. Parkman,"--looking at him with a keenness in
+which there was almost an affectionate understanding--"you did not say
+what you intended to say when you came into this room. You intended to
+speak of me--but the room swept you back to Karl. Oh--I know. And it is
+just because you _were_ swept back--care like this--that I am going to
+tell you something.
+
+"Doctor,"--blinded with tears--"we never understood. None of us ever knew
+what it meant to Karl to be blind. After--after he had gone--I found
+something. In this book"--reaching over to Karl's copy of Faust--"I found
+a letter--a very long letter Karl wrote in those last few days, when he
+was there--alone. I found it the day I went out to the library alone--the
+day before they--broke it up. Oh doctor--_what it told!_ I want you to
+know--" but she could not go on.
+
+When she raised her head the fierce light of hate was burning through the
+tears. "Can you fancy how I hate the light? Can you fancy with what
+feelings I wake in the morning and see it come--light from which Karl was
+shut out--which he craved like that--and could not have? Do you see how
+it symbolises all those other things taken from him and me? He talked of
+another light--light he must gain for himself--light which the soul must
+have. And Karl was longing for the very light I was ready to bring! He
+would have believed in it--turned to it eagerly--the letter shows that.
+Do you _wonder_ that there is nothing but darkness in my soul--that I
+want nothing else? Look at Karl's life! Always cut off just this side of
+achievement! Every battle stopped right in the hour of victory! Made
+great only to have his greatness buffetted about like--_held up for
+sport!_--I _will_ say it! "--in fierce response to his protesting
+gesture--"It's true!"
+
+He tried to speak, but this was far too big for words which did not come
+straight from the soul.
+
+"Do you know what I am doing now?" She laughed--and none of it had told
+as much as that laugh revealed. "I am making patchwork quilts! Can
+you fancy anything more worthless in this world than a patchwork
+quilt?--cutting things up and then sewing them together again, and making
+them uglier in the end than they were in the beginning? Do you know
+anything more futile to do with life than that? Well that's where my
+life is now. My aunt had begun some, and I am finishing them up. And
+once--once--" but the sob in her voice gathered up the words.
+
+He wanted to speak then; that sob brought her nearer. But she went on:
+
+"I sit sewing those little pieces together--a foolish thing to do, but
+one must be doing something, and as I think how useless it is there comes
+the thought of whether it is any more useless than all the other things
+in life. Is it any more useless than surgery? For can a great surgeon
+save his best friend? Is it any more useless than science--for can
+science do anything for her own? Is it any more useless than ambition and
+purpose and hope--for does not fate make sport of them all? Is it any
+more useless than books--for can books reach the hearts which need them
+most? Is it any more useless than art--for does art reach realities? Is
+it any more useless than light--for can light penetrate the real
+darkness? Is it,"--she wavered, quivered; she had been talking in low,
+quick voice, her eyes fixed on something straight ahead, as though
+reading her words out there before her. And now, as she held back, and he
+saw what she saw and could not say, he asked for her, slowly: "Is it any
+more useless than love?"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXIX
+
+
+ASH HEAP AND ROSE JAR
+
+As she broke then to the sobs for which he had hoped, something of
+tremendous force stirred within the man; and he felt that if he could
+bring her from the outer darkness where she had been carried, back to the
+things which were her soul's own, that his own life, his whole life, with
+all of the dark things through which it had passed, would have found
+justification. He had tried to save Karl, and failed. But there was left
+Ernestine. And it seemed to him--he saw it simply, directly,
+unquestioningly--that after all he would not have failed Karl if he could
+do what it was in his heart to do now for her.
+
+Looking at her bowed head he saw it all--the complete overthrow, the rich
+field of life rendered barren waste. Barren waste--but was that true for
+Ernestine? Did there not remain for her the scent of the field? The
+memory of that glorious, luxuriant growth? With _him_ barren waste--but
+for her did there not grow in the field of life some things which were
+everlasting? With the quickness with which he saw everything he saw that
+it was the picture of his own barrenness could show her most surely the
+things which for her remained.
+
+He drew back from the thought as one draws away from the rude touch upon
+a wound. Lay bare the scars of his life that another profit by their
+ugliness? Years of habit were against it; everything fundamentally
+himself was against it. But he was a man who had never yet shrunk from
+the thing he saw was right to do. The cost of an accomplishment never
+deterred him from a thing he saw must be accomplished. With each second
+of listening to her sobs, he was becoming once more the man who masters,
+the man ruthless and unsparing in his purposefulness.
+
+"Ernestine," he began, and his voice was very strange, for it knew it was
+to carry things it had never carried before, "you and I are similarly
+placed in that we have both lost the great thing of life. But there is
+something remains to each of us. Life has left something to us both. To
+you it has left a rose jar. To me--a heap of ashes."
+
+It came with the moment's need. It comprehended it so well the channels
+long closed seemed of themselves to open. In the clearness with which he
+saw it, the fullness with which he felt it, he lost himself.
+
+"Do you know that you have no right to cry out against life? Do you know
+that there are men and women who would lay down their lives--yes, and
+give up their immortal souls--for hours which you have had? Do you know
+that you have no right to say Karl Hubers was mocked by fate, made sport
+of, buffetted about? Do you know,"--his face went white as he said this,
+slowly--"that I would be a thousand times willing to give up my two
+eyes--yes, and lay down my life--just to _know_, as he knew, that love
+was great and life was good?"
+
+The tears remained undried upon her cheek. He held her.
+
+"Look deeper. There is another way to read Karl's life--a deeper truth
+than those truths you have been seeing.
+
+"Ernestine, we all dream of love; we all desire it. It is only at rare,
+rare times it comes as it came to you. And I say to you--and I mean it
+from the bottom of my heart--that if you had been forced to give up your
+love in the first hour of its fulfillment, for all that you should thank
+God through the remainder of your life that it had been yours. For you
+_had_ it!--and nothing, loss, death, defeat, disappointment of every
+kind, can strip from your soul the consciousness that once, no matter for
+how short a time, love in its fullness and perfection was yours. Long,
+lonely years may come, and all hard things may come, but through it all
+the thing to keep your soul in tune is the memory of some one perfect
+hour."
+
+Stillness followed that, the stillness which was silence. She had not
+moved.
+
+"You dreamed your dream,"--and in his voice now the beautiful things of
+appreciation and understanding. "I know your dream. You dreamed of
+growing old together; of taking from life everything there was together;
+of achieving to the uttermost; of rejoicing in each other's victories,
+growing more and more close together. I know your dream--a beautiful
+dream. Giving up some things as the changing years do their work, and
+taking on the other things, the more quiet, in fact finer things, that
+come with the years. Oh, yes--don't think I do not know that dream. To
+walk together down the years, meet them fearlessly, gladly, in the
+thought that they but add to the fullness of your love--I know--I know.
+And now that it is not to be as you thought, you say life has left
+nothing to you; that you hate it; will have none of it. Oh, Ernestine, if
+you could only know how rich you are!"
+
+Then harshly, rudely, the change; the voice which had seemed to caress
+each word was now like a lash.
+
+"Suppose you didn't have the luxury of giving yourself up to your own
+heart? Suppose that every day and night of your life, you had to fight
+memory, knowing it held nothing for you but jeers and mockery and things
+too damnable for words! Suppose you had to fairly forbid yourself to
+think of the beautiful things of life! Suppose that what had been the
+most beautiful moments of your life were made, by memory, the most
+hideous! Suppose the memory of his kiss always brought with it the
+consciousness of his falseness; that his words of love never came back to
+you without the knowledge that he had been laughing at you in his heart
+all the time! Suppose you could never get away from the damning truth
+that what you gave from the depth of your heart was tossed aside with a
+laugh! Suppose you had given the great passion of your life, the best
+that was in you, to a liar and a hypocrite! Suppose you had been made a
+fool of!--easy game! _Then_ what of life?--your belief in love?--thoughts
+of fate? Great God, woman, can't you see what you have got?"
+
+After the throbbing moment which followed that there came a great quiet;
+slowly passion settled to sadness. He seemed to have forgotten her, to be
+speaking instead to his own heart, as he said, very low, his voice
+touched with the tenderness of unrelinquished dreams: "To have had one
+hour--just one perfect hour, and then the memory of that untarnished
+forever--it would be enough."
+
+Her heart rushed passionately to its own defence; she wanted to tell him
+no! She wanted to tell him it was cruel to be permitted to live for a
+time in a beautiful country, only to be turned out into the dark. She
+wanted to tell him that to know love was to need it forever. But his head
+had fallen to his hand; he seemed entirely lost to her, and even now she
+knew his answer to what she would say. "But you _had_ it," he would
+reply. "The cruel thing would be to awaken and find no such country had
+ever existed." They would get no closer than that, and with new
+passionateness her heart went out to Karl. Karl would understand it as it
+was to her!
+
+He too felt that they could come no closer than this. They sat there in
+the gathering twilight with their separate thoughts as souls sit together
+almost in the dark, seeing one another in shadow, across dim spaces.
+
+The tearing open of his heart had left him weakened with pain. Perhaps
+that was why he was so very tired, and perhaps it was because he was so
+tired that this thought of growing old came back to him. It seemed to him
+now, leaning back in his chair and filled with the things of which he had
+spoken, that almost as great as a living presence with which to share the
+years, would be that thing of growing old with a beautiful memory. It
+would be a supreme thing to have a hand in your hand, a face against your
+face, a heart against your heart as you stepped on into the years; but if
+that could not be, and perfection is not given freely in this life,
+surely it would keep the note of cheer in one's voice, the kindly
+gleam in one's eye, to bring with one into old age the memory of a
+perfect love. It would be lonely then when one sat in the twilight and
+dreamed--but what another loneliness! If instead of holding one's self
+away from one's own heart, one could turn to it with: "She loved me like
+that. Her arms have been about my neck in true affection; her whole being
+radiated love for me; she had no words to tell it and could tell it only
+with her eyes and with the richness and the lavishness of her kisses. She
+would have given up the world for me; she inspired me to my best deeds;
+she comforted me in my times of discouragement and rejoiced with me in my
+hours of cheer. She is not here now, and it is lonely, but she has left
+me, in spirit, the warmth of her presence, the consciousness that she
+loved me with a love in which there was no selfishness nor faltering, and
+the things she has left me I can carry through life and into eternity."
+
+And all of that was Ernestine's could she but see her way to take it!
+
+He knew that it was growing late. "I must go," he said, but still he sat
+there, knowing he had not finished what he had come to say. But need he
+say it? Would it avail anything? Must not all human souls work their own
+way through the darkness? And when the right word came, must it not come
+from Karl himself, through some memory, some strange breath of the
+spirit? _He_ knew, but she would have to see it for herself. That each
+one's seeing it for one's self was what made life hard. Would there not
+surely come a day, somewhere in the upward scale, where souls could reach
+one another better than this?
+
+But he had stirred her; he knew that by the way she was looking at him
+now. Finally she asked, tremblingly, a little resentfully: "Dr. Parkman,
+what is it you would have me do?"
+
+"Do something with your life," was his prompt reply. "Help make it right
+for Karl."
+
+She caught that up breathlessly. "Make it right for Karl?"
+
+"You say he was always cut off just this side of achievement. Then you
+achieve something which will at least show what he was able to inspire."
+
+That sunk so deep that her face went very white.
+
+"But you do not understand," she whispered passionately. "You mean that I
+should paint--and I tell you I _cannot_. I tell you it is _dead!_"
+
+"Not necessarily that you should paint. Not just now, if you cannot. But
+come back into touch with life. Do something to force yourself back into
+it, and then let life itself show you that the other things are not dead
+after all."
+
+"But I do not want to!" came bitterly from her.
+
+"Sometimes," he said, with more of his usual manner, "we do things we do
+not want to, and through the doing of them, we get to want to. Do
+something!--whether you want to or not. Stop doing futile things and
+dwelling on the sense of their futility. Why, Ernestine, come up to the
+hospital and go to work as a nurse! Heaven knows I never expected to
+advise you to do that, but _anything_--painting pictures or scrubbing
+floors--that will bring you back to a sense of living--the obligations of
+life--show you that something is _yours_ that life and death and _hell_
+can't take from you!"
+
+And still he sat there, thinking. In just a moment he must go--go away
+leaving her alone with the years which awaited her. For just an instant
+it seemed as though all of the past and all of the future were in his
+keeping. What word leave with her? He knew by her passionate breathing
+that he had reached her. And now he was going away. Could he have done
+more--reached deeper? In this, too, had he failed? What word leave with
+her? His heart was so full of many things that his mind did not know what
+to choose. He remembered the day she had come to him filled with the
+spirit to ride down an adverse fate and win triumph from defeat. Her
+splendid spirit then! Would that spirit ever come again? Could it?
+
+Karl was very close in those final moments, and even more close than Karl
+was the spirit of love. Many precious things seemed in his keeping just
+then.
+
+"Ernestine," he said at the last, and his face was white and his voice
+trembled, "you have known. It came to you. You had it. It came to you as
+June to the roses,--in season, right. I grant you it was short. I grant
+you it was hard to see it go. But you _had_ it! Say that to yourself when
+you go to sleep at night. Say it to yourself when you wake in the
+morning. And some day you will come to see what it means just to know
+that you know, and then your understanding and your heart will go out to
+all who have never known. You will pity all who scoff and all who yearn,
+and you will say to yourself: 'The world needs to know more about love.
+More than knowledge or science or any other thing, the world needs more
+faith in love.' Then some day you will see that you not only know but
+have power to make it plain, and you will not hold back any longer then.
+And _there_ is to be the real victory and completion of Karl Hubers'
+life!--there the real triumph over fate--that triumph of the spirit of
+love. I see it now. I see it all now. And my good-bye word to you is just
+this--I do not believe you are going to withhold from Karl the
+immortality which should be his."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XL
+
+
+"LET THERE BE LIGHT"
+
+Hours had passed, and still she could not master the sobs. It seemed no
+one had ever been as cruel as Dr. Parkman had been to her that afternoon.
+Karl would understand!--and in her passionate need of Karl's
+understanding she turned at last to the letter of which she had spoken,
+the letter which always seemed a little like Karl's voice speaking from
+out the silence.
+
+Old and worn and blurred with the grief spent upon it, the letter bore
+upon itself the record of the year's desolation. It had lived through
+things never to be told,--never to be comprehended.
+
+"Lonesome days, liebchen,"--he had written. "It would seem almost like a
+rush of light to feel you standing in the doorway now.
+
+"My letters which I send you will tell you I am well, getting along all
+right, that I love you. These are some other things. If I think they will
+hurt you, I will not let you see them. But I will feel better to get them
+said, and of course the easiest way to say them is to say them to you.
+
+"I can't write. I wish I could. There are things 'way back in my thoughts
+I should like to say, and say right. For I've done some thinking this
+year, liebchen--while I sat here writing text-books there came a good
+many thoughts.
+
+"Text-books--any fool can write them! Lectures on what other men have
+done--what do I care about them? I'll do it, for I have to, but I want
+somebody to know--I want _you_ to know that I know it doesn't amount to a
+hill of beans!
+
+"Liebchen, you hear a lot of talk about the beauties of resignation.
+Don't you ever believe any of it. We don't get resigned to things that
+really count. But what we do get, is courage to bear them. I'm not
+resigned and I don't want to be! But I will try to be game about it, and
+we can't be game while we are sore. I know that because the times I've
+been least game are the times I was most sore. Wonder if anybody can make
+any sense out of that?
+
+"Life's queer--you can't get around that. Making us one thing and then
+making us be another. What are we to think of it, liebchen? Seems as if
+we could get on better if we could just get a line on the scheme of
+things, understand what it is all about, and the why. Or isn't there any
+why? I like a why for things. It gives them their place. I don't like
+disorder, and senselessness, and if there isn't any why--why then--See
+what I'm getting at?
+
+"What are you going to do when your force pushes you on to a thing which
+is closed to you? Stop the force? Well, doesn't that stop yourself? Turn
+it somewhere else? Easy to say in working out a philosophy,--not so easy
+to do.
+
+"Where's the end of it?--that's what I want to know. I'm one of those
+practical chaps who wants to see an end in sight.
+
+"Ernestine, light's a great thing. Light's _the_ great thing. I never
+knew that until I went blind. You have to stay a long time in the
+darkness to know just what it is light means.
+
+"They call great men 'great lights.' 'And then came the light,' they say,
+regarding the solving of some great thing. 'He brought the light'--that's
+what I wanted to do! They tell about science bringing the light. I know
+now what a tribute they pay when they say that. Light of understanding,
+light of truth--and ah, mein liebchen, the light of love--and well do I
+know how that light can shine into the darkness!
+
+"'More light'--Goethe said, when he was going out into the dark. A great
+thing to ask for. I know how he felt!--'And God said--Let there be
+light'--I don't wonder that story has lived a long time.
+
+"My books are finished. Now what?--more books?--lectures?--some kind of
+old woman's make-shift? Sit here and watch my red blood dry up? Sit here
+like a plant shrivelling away in the darkness? Be looked after and fussed
+over and have things made as easy for me as possible? I don't know--I
+can't see--
+
+"There, liebchen--I've taken a brace. I took a long drink of courage, and
+I'm in better shape. Often when I get like that I've been tempted to take
+a long drink of something else--but I never have. Whiskey's for men who
+feel good; men who haven't much to fight. Not for me--not any such finish
+as that.
+
+"I'm making bad business of this letter. I wanted to tell things, tell
+what light was and what darkness was; but I can't do it. Many things have
+been circling around my thoughts and I thought I might get hold of a few
+of them and pull them in. But I can't seem to do it. I never was much
+good at writing things out; it's hard to get words for things that aren't
+even full-born thoughts.
+
+"My work was great, liebchen--great! A constant piercing of the darkness
+with light--a letting in of more light--new light. I can understand now
+why I loved it; where the joy was; what it was I was doing.
+
+"Is life like that? Don't we understand things until we are out of them?
+By Jove, is it true that we have to _get_ out of them, in order to
+understand them? And if that's true, is it the understanding that's the
+goal? Is it--oh, I don't know--I'm sure I don't know.
+
+"But look here, liebchen,--is it true that while I had the light, I
+didn't have it at all,--didn't know what it meant? Did I have to lose it
+in order to get it? For isn't it _having_ a thing to understand it--more
+than it's having it to really have it and not understand? See what I
+mean? Those are some of the things circling around on the outside.
+
+"Sometimes I think so. Sometimes I think the light was shut out that the
+greater light might come. Sometimes I think we scientists haven't the
+right line on the world at all. Why, Ernestine, sometimes I think it's
+miles deeper than we ever dreamed! A hodge-podge--this letter. Like my
+life, starting out one thing, and ending up another, or rather not ending
+up anything at all--a going to pieces in the midst of my philosophy--a
+not being sure of anything--a constant 'perhaps.'"
+
+"I'm lonesome. I'm tired. I don't feel well. The old ladies would say I'm
+'under the weather.' Why, I can't even keep feeling right when you're
+away.
+
+"I want you. I want you--here--now. I can't talk to you on this infernal
+machine, my hands groping around just as senselessly as my thoughts. I
+tell you, liebchen, blindness is bad business. It sounds well in a poem,
+but it's a bad thing to live with. It's bad to wake up in the night
+sometimes and think that it will be daylight soon and then remember that
+it will never be daylight for you again!
+
+"I wish you were here. I'm just in the mood for talking--not talking,
+perhaps, but having you close to me, and understanding.
+
+"There's one thing that there's no perhaps about. That's you. There's no
+perhaps when it comes to our love. There's no perhaps--
+
+"Now, that made me fall a-dreaming. I stopped writing and lighted my pipe
+and sat a long time, thinking of you. It's 'our hour'--I know that,
+because I heard the clock strike. Where are you? Why aren't you here?
+
+"I want you. Believe I said that before, but if I said it a thousand
+times, I couldn't make it strong enough. I don't know why I want you like
+this--this soul want. It isn't just your kisses, your sweetness, the dear
+things about you. I want you to be here to understand--for you would--you
+do.
+
+"My light in the darkness, my Ernestine! I shall never let you go away
+again. The darkness is too dark without you.
+
+"Evening now, for again I stopped; too tired, too quiet, someway, to feel
+like writing. I am going to bed. I wish you were here for your good-night
+kiss. I wish you were here just to tell me that you understand all these
+things I have not been able to say. I wish you were here to tell me--what
+in my heart I know--that you are going to bring me the light, that love
+will light the way. I wish you were here to tell me that what my eyes
+cannot tell you, as they used to, you can read now just by the beating of
+my heart, just through the fullness of our silences.
+
+"Oh, little one--your eyes--your dear eyes--your lovely hair--your
+smile--your arms about my neck--your whispered word in my ear--your soft
+cheek against mine--your laugh--your voice--your tenderness--I want it
+all to-night--and the Ernestine of the silences--the Ernestine who
+understands without knowing--helps without trying.
+
+"Soon you will be back. That will be sunrise after long darkness.
+
+"Good-night. It's hard to leave you--so lonesome--wanting you so. Again,
+good-night, dear girl for whom my arms are yearning. Bless you,
+sweetheart--God bless you--and does God, Himself, know what you have been
+to me?"
+
+She read the last of it, as always, with sobs uncontrollable. Dr.
+Parkman--everything--was forgotten. It was Karl alone in the library,
+longing for her, needing her--and she not there.
+
+"Oh, Karl--Karl!" she sobbed across the black chasm of the year--"if I
+could only have had that hour!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XLI
+
+
+WHEN THE TIDE CAME IN
+
+But the days which came then were different. Dr. Parkman had stirred her
+to a discontent with despair.
+
+She had come West with Georgia and Joe. For five days they had been at
+this little town on the Oregon coast. Through the day and through the
+night she listened to the call of the sea. It stirred her strangely. At
+times it frightened her.
+
+She did not know why she should have wished to come. Perhaps it was
+because it seemed a reaching out to the unknown. After she had known
+she was to go, she would awaken in the night and hear the far-off
+roll of the Pacific, and would lie there very still as if listening
+for something from the farther unknown. Her whole being was
+stirred--drawn--unreasoningly expectant. There were moments when she
+seemed to just miss something to which she was very close.
+
+To-day she had walked clear around the bend. The little town and pleasant
+beach were hidden from view, and there was only the lighthouse out among
+the rocks, and the sea coming in wild and mighty to that coast to which
+no mariner would attempt to draw near.
+
+It was the hour of the in-coming tide, and as the sea beat against the
+rocks it seemed as omnipotent and relentless as that sea of fate against
+which nothing erected by man could hope to prevail.
+
+There was no human being in sight. Man, and all to which man blinded one,
+were far away. She was alone with things as they were, alone with the
+forces which made the world and life, and as the tides of the sea brought
+close to her wave after wave, so the mind's tides were bringing close to
+her wave upon wave of understanding.
+
+Fate had washed them away just as this ocean would wash away the child's
+playhouse built upon the sands. They had believed they could make their
+lives, that it was for their spirit to elect what they should do, their
+hands build as they had willed; and all that the spirit had willed to do,
+and all that the hands set about to achieve, was washed away by just one
+of those waves of fate which rolled in and took them with no more of
+regret, no more of compassion, than the sea would have in washing away
+the play-house built upon the sands. And if the sea were chidden for
+having taken away the house upon the sands, which meant much to some one,
+it would quite likely answer grimly: "I did not know that it was there."
+
+She laughed--and Karl would have hated life for bringing Ernestine to
+that laugh. But she laughed to think how she had looked fate in the face
+with the words: "I will prevail against you!" Would the child, building
+its house upon the sand and saying to the ocean: "I will not let you take
+my house!" be more absurd than she?
+
+What she had believed to be the tremendous force of her spirit had been
+as one grain of sand against the tides of ocean. What was one to think of
+it all then--of human love which believed itself created for eternity, of
+dreams which one's soul persuaded one would come true, of aspirations
+born in a hallucination of power, of that spark within one which played
+one false, of believing one could master fate only to find one had
+erected a child's house upon the sands, and that what had been achieved
+in consciousness of great power could be swept away so easily that the
+ocean was not even conscious of having taken it unto itself?
+
+Very sternly, very understandingly, their lives swept before her
+anew.... Just one little wave from the tide of fate had lapped up,
+unknowingly, uncaringly, that house upon the sand which a delusion of the
+spirit had made seem a castle grounded in eternity. Why blind one's self
+to the truth and call life fair? For what had they fought and suffered
+and believed and hoped? Just to hear the mocking voice of the outgoing
+tide?
+
+The fury of the sea was creeping into her blood. Rage possessed her. All
+of her spirit, mightier than ever before, went out to meet the spirit of
+the sea--hating it, defying it, understanding its own futility, and the
+more hot from the sense of impotence. That died to desolation. She had
+never been so wholly desolate--the sea so mighty, she so powerless. Fate
+and human souls were like that.
+
+Karl--where was he? Swept out by the ocean of fate. To what shore had he
+been carried? What thought he of the tide which had carried him out from
+her? Was his soul, like hers, spending itself in the passion of
+rebellion--so mighty as to shake the foundations of one's being, so
+futile as to prevail against not one drop of water in that sea of fate?
+
+Time passed; the tide was still coming in, nearing its height. But to the
+sea there had come a change. The spirit of it seemed different. For a
+long time she sat there dimly conscious of a difference, and then it
+seemed as though the sea were trying to reach her with something it had
+to bring.
+
+She tried to shake herself free from so strange a fancy, but it held her,
+and for a long time she sat there motionless, looking out at the sea with
+all her eyes, reaching out to it with all her soul, becoming more and
+more still,--a hush upon her whole being,--moved, held, unreasoningly
+expectant.
+
+The sea seemed trying to make her ready. Each wave which beat upon the
+rocks beat against her consciousness, driving against her mood and
+spirit, as if clearing a way, making her ready, open, to what would come.
+
+It seemed finally to have cleared her whole being, driven away all which
+might impede. It seemed now as though she could take in things not seen
+or heard. There was that strange openness of the spirit, that hush, that
+unreasoning expectancy.
+
+All at once it rushed upon her, filling her overwhelmingly. It said that
+there was a sea mightier than what she called the sea of fate; it told of
+a sea of human souls over which fate only seemed to prevail. A great rush
+of truth filled her with this--It was the belief in the omnipotence of
+fate which was the real delusion of the spirit.
+
+Over and over again, with steadily rising tide, it told her that,--no
+more to be reasoned away than the sea, resistless as the tide.
+
+She never knew in after years just what it was happened in that hour. She
+could not have told it, for it was not a thing for words to compass. But
+after that great truth had rushed full upon her, sweeping away the
+philosophy of her bitterness, Karl's spirit, something sent out from him
+to her, seemed to come in with the tide. He pleaded with her. He asked
+her to stop fighting and come back to the soul of things. He asked her to
+be Ernestine--his Ernestine. He told her that his own spirit could not
+find peace while hers was waging war and full of bitterness. He wanted
+her to make a place for them both in that great world-harmony of their
+belief. He told her that out where souls see in wider sweeps, they know
+that there is a spirit over which death and fate cannot prevail.
+
+Darkness came on, but she had no thought of fear. And before she turned
+away something had risen from the dead. Out of woe and despair, defeat
+and bitterness, out of loneliness and a broken heart, something was born
+again. Karl asked that she make it right with the world. Karl asked for a
+child of their love. And at the last it was the call of the child to the
+mother which she heard. It was the maternal instinct of the spirit which
+answered.
+
+Very late that night, after she had sat long at her window, looking up at
+the stars, waiting, a great light seemed to appear, and shimmering
+against the sky, high above the tides of the sea, she saw the picture
+which she would paint.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XLII
+
+
+WORK THE SAVIOUR
+
+For more than three years then they saw nothing of Ernestine. She left
+this note for Georgia: "I am sorry to seem erratic, but I cannot wait for
+you. I am going away at once. I am going first to New York, and then, I
+think, to Paris. I am going to do something which I can do better there
+than anywhere else. Thank you, Georgia, for everything. It must be
+satisfying to feel one has succeeded as beautifully in anything as you
+have succeeded in being a friend to me. Do not worry. There is nothing
+now to worry about. You will be glad to know that I am going back to my
+work."
+
+A little later Dr. Parkman had this from her from New York: "I am sailing
+for Paris. I am going to work. I see it all now; all that you would have
+me see, and more. Some day I will try to show you just how well I see it.
+
+"I do not know how I am going to bear part of it--the going back where we
+were so happy. But I _will_ bear it, for nothing shall keep me from the
+work I see before me.
+
+"Thank you--for all that you have done, and most of all for all that you
+have been. My idea is all comprehended in this: To the very uttermost of
+my power, I am going to make it right for Karl."
+
+Six months later she wrote him this:
+
+"Dear Doctor: Thank you for attending to those things for me. It
+infuriated me at first to think that the only thing in money left by the
+work of Karl's great life was the money from those books which I resented
+so bitterly. But how wrong to see it that way--for Karl would be so happy
+to know that the brave work he did after his blindness was helping me
+now. But I never spend a dollar of this money without thinking of the
+mood--the circumstances--out of which it was earned.
+
+"No--no money for the work he did for the blind. Karl intended that as a
+gift. He would be so glad to know of its usefulness. He thought it all
+wrong that books for the blind were so expensive, and so many of the
+great things not to be had.
+
+"Karl used to repeat a little verse of Heine, which he translated like
+this:"
+
+
+'At first I did not even hope,
+And to a hostile fate did bow--
+But I learned to bear the burden--
+Only do not ask me how.'
+
+
+"I have learned to bear it here in Paris--only do not ask me how. I could
+not say. I do not know.
+
+"But I want to tell you of a few of the good things. You would not
+believe what that work in the laboratory has done for me. It has given me
+a new understanding of colour--new sense of it, new power with eye and
+hand, a better sense of values. Would you have thought of that? And do
+you not see the reasons for my being glad?
+
+"What I have done so far is but leading up to what I am going to do. That
+is so vital that it must not be done too quickly. I must get my hand in,
+gain what there is to be gained here, that the work I am going to do for
+Karl may have the benefit of it all. But I have made innumerable
+sketches, and it is growing all the time. There need be no fear of my
+losing it. I could no more lose it than I could lose my own soul. It
+grows as I grow. Sometimes I think I should wait ten years--but I shall
+not.
+
+"Yes, the critics like the picture of which you speak. Of course I am
+painting all the time--other things--various things. But it all seems
+like practice work to me--a mere getting ready."
+
+And then, after a long time, this:--"This is my birthday;--a day linked
+more closely than I could ever tell with Karl, our life and work and
+love. If I had looked forward from one happy birthday I had and seen what
+was ahead--how it would be with me now--I never could have gone on. We go
+on by not knowing what is waiting for us, and day by day we bear what we
+would have said, looking ahead, we never could endure--and that is human
+life.
+
+"I have been so lonely to-day that I must write this little word to one
+who will understand. I turn to you as one close to us in those dear days,
+one who cared for and appreciated Karl, understood something of the kind
+of love that was ours. Doctor--it was so wonderful! So wonderful that it
+seems to me sometimes the universe must have existed through the
+centuries just that our love might be born. I think of it as the one
+perfect flower of creation.
+
+"I want you to know that I have come to see the worth--pricelessness--of
+my memories. Karl's love for me lights up my life with a glory nothing
+can ever take away. I think we do not have even our memories until we
+have earned them. I have tried to come back to my own, to take my place.
+I am trying to be of that great harmony of the world in which Karl and I
+believed, and as my spirit turns from discord and seeks harmony, I am
+given my memories, the memories of those many perfect days, and I am
+never too lonely nor too desolate to thank God that to me was left the
+scent of the roses.
+
+"Oh, Doctor--where is he now? Do you ever think of all that? No one who
+has ever loved and lost can remain secure in his materialism. I begin to
+see that the beautiful thoughts, the poems, of immortality, eternity, of
+its all coming right, have sprung from the lonely hearts of great lovers.
+For they would not have it any other way--they could only endure it by
+having it so, and, ah, Doctor--far greater than any proof of science or
+logic, is there not proof in this? Lifting up their hearts in hours of
+desolation were not the men and women born for great loves and great
+sorrows granted a vision of the truth?
+
+"We do not know. None of them know. We hope and wait and long for the
+years to tell us the truth. And while we wait and hope, we work, and try
+to make our lives that which is worthy our love. That endeavour, and that
+alone, makes life bearable."
+
+After a year of silence he received this letter: "Doctor, it is finished.
+I will not tell you the things they are saying of it here, for you will
+read it in the papers. The papers here are full of it; I think I have
+never seen so much about any picture.
+
+"But it is more important that I tell you this: They are seeing it, even
+now, as I intended it should be seen--a work of love, a memorial, an
+endeavour to make it right for him. I have cared more for what the
+scientific people, Karl's own kind, have said of it, than the artists.
+They claim it as their own, say they are going to have it, get it some
+way,--_must_ have it. Do you not see how that means the fulfillment of my
+desire?
+
+"Of course you know that it is a picture of Karl. But the critics here
+call it less a portrait than the incarnation of an idea. Light and truth
+sweeping in upon a human soul--one of them expressed it. But why try to
+tell you of that? When you see it you will understand what it is I have
+tried to do. And you shall see it soon. After it is exhibited here they
+want it in Vienna, and I cannot refuse, for Karl loved Vienna, and then a
+short time in London, and then I come with it to America, and to Chicago.
+I am bringing it home, Doctor, for even though it find final resting
+place in that great temple of science in Paris, I have the feeling, in
+taking it to Chicago, that I am bringing it home. And the first day it is
+exhibited there I want you and me to go to it together, as Karl would
+like that we should.
+
+"I am so tired that I do not believe I shall ever be quite rested again.
+For the last three months I lived with the picture, my heart and mind
+knew nothing else. But the day I finished it my strongest feeling was a
+regret that it was finished, a yearning to go on with it forever. For
+doctor, I painted my heart, my life, everything that I had within myself,
+everything I had taken from Karl, into that picture. I am lonely now
+without it, for it made my life.
+
+"It has revived Karl's whole story. They tell it here--oh so lovingly. I
+heard one man from the Institute telling it all to a younger man as they
+stood before it yesterday. I have moved them to a new sense of Karl's
+greatness; it has been my glorious privilege to perpetuate him, make sure
+his place, _reveal_ him--for that is what I have sought to do. Was not
+life good to me to give me power to do that thing?
+
+"We shall be together in Chicago very soon--you and Karl and I. For as
+the days go on Karl comes closer. I hope, most of all, that the picture
+will bring him very close to you."
+
+That was three months before, and to-day he had this note from her, dated
+Chicago:--"Yes, I am here, and the picture is here. The public exhibit
+does not open for a few days, but the picture will be hung this morning,
+and we may see it this afternoon. I shall be there at three, waiting for
+you."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XLIII
+
+
+"AND THERE WAS LIGHT"
+
+He spent the intervening hours restlessly; the hands of his watch moved
+slowly; his duties occupied only a small portion of his mind.
+
+He was at the Institute at just three, and they directed him where to go.
+His heart was beating fast as he walked down the corridor. The hand which
+he laid upon the door-knob shook a little.
+
+He opened the door, and a woman came toward him with outstretched hand.
+
+It was Ernestine--but the three years had done much.
+
+Older--greater--a more steady flame--a more conscious power--grief
+transmuted to understanding--despair risen to resolution--she had gone a
+long way. He looked at her in silence--reading, understanding. It was all
+written there--the story of deep thinking and deeper loving, of battles
+and victories, and other battles yet to fight, the poise which attends
+the victor--yes, she had gone a long way. And as she spoke his name, and
+smiled a little, and then could not repress the tears which his presence,
+all that it meant, brought, he saw, shining through her tears, that light
+of love's own days.
+
+She turned and walked to the other side of the room, and he knew that she
+was taking him to the picture.
+
+She watched his face as he took it in, and she knew then that she had
+done her work.
+
+For a long time he said nothing, and when at last he turned to her, eyes
+dim, voice husky, it was only to say: "I can say--nothing. There are--no
+words."
+
+He turned back to the picture, she standing silent beside him, reading in
+his face that with each moment he was coming into more perfect
+understanding.
+
+For she had painted Karl's face as it was just before he went into the
+silence. She had caught the look which illumined his face that day on his
+death bed when she told him what she had done. She had painted Karl as he
+was in that moment of perfect understanding--the joy which was uplift,
+the knowledge which was glory. She had perpetuated in her picture the
+things which Karl took with him from life. It was Karl in the supreme
+moment of his life--the moment of revelation, transfiguration, the moment
+which lighted all the years.
+
+It was triumph which she had perpetuated in the picture. She was saying
+to the world--He did not achieve what he set out to achieve, but can you
+say he failed when he left the world with a soul like this?
+
+He saw that it was what she had done with light which made the picture,
+from the standpoint of her art, supreme. The critics said that no one had
+ever done just that thing with light before--painted light in just that
+spirit of loving and understanding it; less light, indeed, than light's
+significance. They said that no one before had painted the kind of light
+which could make a blind man see. For he was blind--the picture told
+that, but it seemed no one had ever had light quite as understandingly as
+he had it there.
+
+"You feel it, doctor?" she asked at last, timidly. "You see it all?"
+
+He nodded. It seemed so far beyond any word of his.
+
+But she wanted to talk to him about it. "You see what it has meant to me?
+Why I loved it and lived for it? Oh doctor--I wanted to show that he was
+greater than all the great things he sought to do! The night this picture
+came to me it set my blood on fire, and at no moment since, no matter how
+tired or lonely or discouraged--have I lost my love for it--belief in it.
+It seems so right. It seems to stand for so many things. They call it a
+masterpiece of light--and isn't it fine--great--right, that Karl's
+portrait should be a masterpiece of light?"
+
+For a long time he was lost to it. It was as she said--right. To the
+blind man had come the light; to the man of science the light of truth,
+and to the human soul, about to set out on another journey, had come the
+perfect understanding of what had lighted the way for him here.
+
+When he turned to her at last she was looking at the picture with such
+love in her eyes as he had never seen. Her lips were parted--tremulous;
+there were tears upon her cheeks; her whole face quivered with love and
+longing. He saw then, in that one glance before he turned away, that time
+and death held no sway over such a love as this.
+
+"I did not mean to," she faltered. "But I have not seen the picture
+myself for a long time, and your being here--"
+
+She broke down there, and he summoned no word with which to answer her
+sobs.
+
+"Dr. Parkman,"--raising a passionate face--"I want you to know that if
+this were the greatest picture the world had ever seen--if it were a
+thousand times greater than anything the world had ever known--I would
+throw it away--obliterate it--gladly--joyously--for just one touch of
+Karl's hand!"
+
+"Yes," he murmured, more to himself than to her, "and if you were not
+like that you never could have done it."
+
+"What it cost!"--he heard her whisper. "What it _cost_!"
+
+He told her that it had ever been so. That the great things were paid for
+like that. That so many of the things which had lived longest and gone
+deepest had come from broken hearts and souls tried almost beyond their
+power for suffering. He told her that the future would accept this, as it
+had the others, without knowing of its cost, that a myriad of broken
+hearts had gone into the sum of the world's achievement.
+
+In the half hour which followed, as they sat there, speaking sometimes of
+Karl, more often silent, some things seemed to pass from the man's heart,
+other things to come. And as at the last he rose to go, for he felt she
+would like a little time alone, he said, and his face and his voice gave
+much which the words missed: "Ernestine, you have done more than you
+know. For me too--you have made it right."
+
+She sat a long time before her picture, dreaming of Karl. She whispered
+his name, and he seemed to answer with, "Liebchen--brave liebchen--you
+have been good to me."
+
+To her too the hour brought new light. It came to her now that she had
+won a victory for them, not because she had painted a great picture, but
+because she had brought them back to that world harmony from which they
+seemed for a time to have gone. She had won, not through the greatness of
+her achievement, but through having made it right with her own soul. The
+picture itself was a thing of canvas and paint; it was the spirit out of
+which it grew--his spirit and hers--was the thing everlasting. She was
+sure that Karl too knew now that it was having the spirit right which
+counted. The "perhaps" of his letter was surely answered for him now.
+
+And out of this closeness to the past there opened to her a little of her
+own future--things she would do. For she must work,--theirs a love which
+made for work. There was much more to paint, much to show how she and
+Karl loved the world, what they held it worth,--and all of it to speak
+for their love, glorify, immortalise it.
+
+She dreamed deeply and tenderly--the past so real to her, Karl, their
+love, so great.
+
+Now she must go. To-morrow many others would come. Artists would come to
+pronounce her work good, wonder how she had done this or that. Doctors
+and the university men would come, proud to speak of Karl, claim him as
+their own. But ah--who would understand the tears and heart's blood out
+of which it had come? Who would know? Who could?
+
+"Karl," she murmured at the last--eyes dim with loving tears--"dear
+Karl,"--dwelling with a long tenderness upon the name--"did I indeed
+bring you the light?"
+
+
+
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, THE GLORY OF THE CONQUERED ***
+
+This file should be named 8664.txt or 8664.zip
+
+Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance
+of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing.
+Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections,
+even years after the official publication date.
+
+Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til
+midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement.
+The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at
+Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
+preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
+and editing by those who wish to do so.
+
+Most people start at our Web sites at:
+https://gutenberg.org or
+http://promo.net/pg
+
+These Web sites include award-winning information about Project
+Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new
+eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!).
+
+
+Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement
+can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is
+also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the
+indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an
+announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter.
+
+http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext05 or
+ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext05
+
+Or /etext04, 03, 02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92,
+91 or 90
+
+Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want,
+as it appears in our Newsletters.
+
+
+Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
+
+We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
+time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours
+to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
+searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our
+projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value
+per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2
+million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text
+files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+
+We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002
+If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total
+will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end.
+
+The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks!
+This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
+which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users.
+
+Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated):
+
+eBooks Year Month
+
+ 1 1971 July
+ 10 1991 January
+ 100 1994 January
+ 1000 1997 August
+ 1500 1998 October
+ 2000 1999 December
+ 2500 2000 December
+ 3000 2001 November
+ 4000 2001 October/November
+ 6000 2002 December*
+ 9000 2003 November*
+10000 2004 January*
+
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created
+to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people
+and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut,
+Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois,
+Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts,
+Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New
+Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio,
+Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South
+Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West
+Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming.
+
+We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones
+that have responded.
+
+As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list
+will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states.
+Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state.
+
+In answer to various questions we have received on this:
+
+We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally
+request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and
+you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have,
+just ask.
+
+While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are
+not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting
+donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to
+donate.
+
+International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about
+how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made
+deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are
+ways.
+
+Donations by check or money order may be sent to:
+
+ PROJECT GUTENBERG LITERARY ARCHIVE FOUNDATION
+ 809 North 1500 West
+ Salt Lake City, UT 84116
+
+Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment
+method other than by check or money order.
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by
+the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN
+[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are
+tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising
+requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be
+made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+You can get up to date donation information online at:
+
+https://www.gutenberg.org/donation.html
+
+
+***
+
+If you can't reach Project Gutenberg,
+you can always email directly to:
+
+Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com>
+
+Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message.
+
+We would prefer to send you information by email.
+
+
+**The Legal Small Print**
+
+
+(Three Pages)
+
+***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START***
+Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
+They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
+your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from
+someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
+fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
+disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
+you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to.
+
+*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK
+By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
+this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
+a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by
+sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
+you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical
+medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
+
+ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS
+This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks,
+is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart
+through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project").
+Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
+on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
+distribute it in the United States without permission and
+without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
+below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook
+under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
+
+Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market
+any commercial products without permission.
+
+To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable
+efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
+works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any
+medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
+things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
+disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer
+codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
+But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
+[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may
+receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims
+all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
+UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
+INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
+OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of
+receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
+you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
+time to the person you received it from. If you received it
+on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
+such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
+copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
+choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
+receive it electronically.
+
+THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
+TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
+PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
+
+Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
+the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
+above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
+may have other legal rights.
+
+INDEMNITY
+You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation,
+and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated
+with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
+texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including
+legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the
+following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook,
+[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook,
+or [3] any Defect.
+
+DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
+You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by
+disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
+"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
+or:
+
+[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
+ requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
+ eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
+ if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable
+ binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
+ including any form resulting from conversion by word
+ processing or hypertext software, but only so long as
+ *EITHER*:
+
+ [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
+ does *not* contain characters other than those
+ intended by the author of the work, although tilde
+ (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
+ be used to convey punctuation intended by the
+ author, and additional characters may be used to
+ indicate hypertext links; OR
+
+ [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at
+ no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
+ form by the program that displays the eBook (as is
+ the case, for instance, with most word processors);
+ OR
+
+ [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
+ eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
+ or other equivalent proprietary form).
+
+[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this
+ "Small Print!" statement.
+
+[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the
+ gross profits you derive calculated using the method you
+ already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
+ don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
+ payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation"
+ the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were
+ legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent
+ periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to
+ let us know your plans and to work out the details.
+
+WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
+Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of
+public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed
+in machine readable form.
+
+The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time,
+public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses.
+Money should be paid to the:
+"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or
+software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at:
+hart@pobox.com
+
+[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only
+when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by
+Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be
+used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be
+they hardware or software or any other related product without
+express permission.]
+
+*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END*
+